Becoming Film Literate - The Art and Craft of Motion Pictures (PDFDrive)
Becoming Film Literate - The Art and Craft of Motion Pictures (PDFDrive)
Becoming Film Literate - The Art and Craft of Motion Pictures (PDFDrive)
Vincent LoBrutto
Westport, Connecticut
PRAEGER London
Library of Congress Cataloging-in-Publication Data
LoBrutto, Vincent.
Becoming film literate : the art and craft of motion pictures / Vincent LoBrutto ;
foreword by Jan Harlan.
p. cm.
Includes bibliographical references and index.
ISBN 0-275-98144-4 (alk. paper)
1. Motion pictures. 2. Cinematography. I. Title.
PN1994.L595 2005
791.43—dc22 2004028099
British Library Cataloguing in Publication Data is available.
Copyright © 2005 by Vincent LoBrutto
All rights reserved. No portion of this book may be
reproduced, by any process or technique, without the
express written consent of the publisher.
Library of Congress Catalog Card Number: 2004028099
ISBN: 0-275-98144-4
First published in 2005
Praeger Publishers, 88 Post Road West, Westport, CT 06881
An imprint of Greenwood Publishing Group, Inc.
www.praeger.com
Printed in the United States of America
46. Birth of a Nonfiction Film Style • The Thin Blue Line 305
47. Experimental Narrative • 2001: A Space Odyssey 312
48. The Essay Film • Weekend 319
49. Screen Violence as Metaphor • The Wild Bunch 326
50. Independent Filmmaking • A Woman Under the Influence 333
Glossary 341
Bibliography 349
Index 371
This page intentionally left blank
FOREWORD
ing the cinema. Million Dollar Movie allowed me to see Hollywood clas-
sics like my beloved King Kong (1933) in many encore broadcasts in a
week's time reinforcing that a good film not only holds up but continues
to reveal its jewels with each viewing. Charles Champlin's television cin-
ema series in the 1970s solidified my belief that film was truly an art.
Richard Schickel's The Men Who Made the Movies series began my lifelong
love affair with the films of King Vidor and contributed to my knowledge
of Ford, Hitchcock, Capra, and others. Jonas Mekas personally sold me
my copy of Brakhage's Metaphors on Vision, and his dedication to the art
of film has motivated my passion for experimental film. In the two classes
he taught that I attended before he was fired by the loud voices of the ig-
norant, Jack Smith taught me that conflict between music and image is a
valuable cinematic lesson. During my salad days there were revival the-
aters that furthered my understanding. They include the Regency, the
Thalia, and Elgin theaters. Dan Talbot's New Yorker Theater was a uni-
versity in New Wave and revolutionary films of the 1960s and 1970s. The
film program at the Museum of Modern Art was my second home dur-
ing my film school years. The Whitney Museum and Anthology Film
Archives broadened my perspective of film history. The New York Cul-
tural Center educated me to the Bs of Don Siegel and XXXs of Russ Meyer.
The New York Film Festival provided an ongoing exposure to cutting-
edge world cinema and the honor of seeing many of the filmmakers speak
about their work in person.
Film Forum continues to be a home for the gourmet delicacies of film-
making. Three film critics who have had the greatest influence on my
thinking about film are Manny Farber, Stanley Kauffmann, and Jonathan
Rosenbaum. My heartfelt appreciation to American Cinema Editors
(ACE) for making me a special member of their fine and vital organiza-
tion and bestowing on me the honor of associate editor of their magazine
CinemaEditor. This role allows my master classes to continue with every
interview and encounter I have with filmmakers. So many film publica-
tions nurtured my insatiable thirst for film knowledge. The most influ-
ential in my early years were Filmmaker's Newsletter, Film Culture,
American Cinematographer, and Take One. Before Borders and Barnes and
Noble, Cinemabilia, the Gotham Book Mart, the 8th Street, Strand, and
St. Mark's Bookshops were havens for readers and collectors of film lit-
erature. Joe Franklin was an inspiration by spreading his infectious un-
conditional love of the cinema on his daily television show and on
specials in which he presented motion picture greats. Editor-director
Arthur Ginsberg provided "graduate studies" during on-the-job training
xvi • Acknowledgments
in the five stimulating years I worked with him. I also extend my appre-
ciation to Jack Lorenzo Schwartz for being my youngest student during
a "shot by shot" analysis of Babe when he was six months old.
As always and especially for a book about film education, my respect
and eternal thanks go to the founder and chairman of the board of the
School of Visual Arts, Silas Rhodes, President David Rhodes, and Vice
President Anthony Rhodes; Reeves Lehmann, chairman of the Depart-
ment of Film, Video, and Animation at SVA, for his unconditional sup-
port of my work and for providing me with the bully pulpit to teach the
art and craft of filmmaking; Sal Petrosino, for his friendship and for his
passion about the preservation and growth of film education; Ed Bowes,
for countless stimulating exchanges on the ever-changing medium of mo-
tion pictures; Joan Brooker, who has taught me more about cinematic nar-
ratives than any living being and for me has defined the true meaning of
deconstruction; Richard Pepperman, now colleague and friend, for being
my first editing teacher and a man who understands that you edit with
your heart and mind even before a splice is made or a button is pushed.
My colleagues at SVA over the years have broadened my perspective on
the artistic discipline we all adore. Most important, I thank all my stu-
dents past and present, who have taught me more than they can ever
imagine.
My thanks and admiration to everyone at Film/Video Arts for creating
a vital and enduring institution for the study of independent film. The
Mount Vernon Public Library continues to be an invaluable archive for
my research. My respect and thanks to the entire staff of this wonderful
archival sanctuary of learning.
Last, my gratitude to all those who write on the subject of the cinema
and continue to feed my insatiable curiosity, for fueling my spirit and
keeping me informed, film literate, and on a steady course to spread the
word.
INTRODUCTION
The purpose of this book is to educate filmgoers about the art, craft, and
lexicon of motion pictures.
A well-read or literate reader is familiar with the rules and aesthetics
of language as well as with authors, movements, genres, conventions, and
narrative strategies. Academics and scholars have dedicated serious
thought to the development of a literary canon, an organized reading list
taught in educational institutions to identify the great books of the cen-
turies. The canon changes periodically—books and authors fall in and out
of favor and fashion—but it remains a systematic learning tool that al-
lows individuals to study and to acquire knowledge concerning litera-
ture. Likewise, the well-established mediums of music, theater, and the
fine art of painting all have recognizable canons to orient students and
enthusiasts to the unique characteristics of their disciplines.
Film as a discipline is taught in many venues. There are texts that are
overviews of film's brief history of little more than 100 years, other more
comprehensive volumes are dedicated to the films of specific countries, and
there are works that chronicle a genre, style, or categories such as docu-
mentary or animation. There are anthologies of film criticism, and movies
are discussed in specialty magazines and in film societies. The American
Film Institute compiled a list of the 100 Greatest Movies of all time, which
continues to be hotly debated. There are certainly films most would agree
are necessary to acquire a knowledge of the cinema—for example, Citizen
Kane and The Battleship Potemkin (both included in Becoming Film Literate)—
xviii • Introduction
but there is no official canon of cinema for a systematic study of the partic-
ular proprieties of cinematic aesthetics, concepts, and methods. In studying
this nascent medium, the tendency has been to examine film through other
disciplines, especially through the prism of literature and theater as well as
social, political, gender, racial, psychological, and semiotic perspectives.
In the twenty-first century, children watch educational and entertainment
videotapes and spend many hours in front of the television, computer, and
movie screens. Through total immersion young people have acquired a so-
phisticated sensibility for visual storytelling, although they rarely con-
sciously comprehend the grammar and properties of the medium. The
average adult has seen hundreds, if not thousands, of films, yet many fun-
damentals of the cinema remain a mystery to the movie-going public.
To become film literate you must see films that demonstrate and em-
body the principles of cinema. Where to begin? That's where Becoming
Film Literate comes in. The objective of this book is twofold. The fifty es-
says that follow, organized in alphabetical order by film title, explore spe-
cific cinematic lessons and serve as introductions to motion pictures that
might be worthy of inclusion in a definitive canon of cinema if such a
monumental task could ever be undertaken. The focus of each essay is an
in-depth investigation of how moving pictures work. Each chapter head-
ing includes the film title and the major topic that will contribute to your
film literacy. Within the essays are many observations concerning the
inner workings of cinematic technology and the application of its visual
and aural language. To enhance the breadth of your knowledge, the
choice of films represents a necessarily wide range.
This is not a "best" list. The titles are destinations to further journeys;
there are many directors, genres, and cinematic worlds to visit on your
way to becoming film literate. At the conclusion of each essay are sug-
gestions for further screening and reading to use as a road map.
As a teacher of the art and craft of motion pictures, I have learned that
all of us inherently know more about the cinema than we can articulate.
It is a codified language that is familiar to us on the surface, but each el-
ement has expressive capabilities concerning the complexity of this pow-
erful human communication medium.
Becoming film literate involves understanding, insight, and engage-
ment with the moving images we sit in front of. The process can be fun,
inspirational, challenging, and even spiritual—enjoy the trip and get
ready for a lifetime of enlightened cinematic experiences.
Note: Words that appear in boldface type can be found in the glossary
along with other useful terms that apply to the art and craft of motion
pictures.
•
Nonlinear Storytelling
Amores Perros
Emilio Echevarria as El Chivo, a homeless man with a past, shown here with
one of his beloved dogs, are two significant characters that link three seem-
ingly disparate stories that dramatically connect over the course of the non-
linear narrative of Amores Perros. Courtesy Photofest.
the plan goes into effect, the crime is presented so the viewer can see the
specifics of each action set forth by each member of the team and what
they encounter during the heist process. An omnipresent narrator (see
narration in glossary) informs the viewer as to where and when each
scene takes place during the timeframe of the robbery as the story shifts
back and forth in time. Each scene provides specific insights about some
of the same moments in time. Intercutting the various scenes to simulate
a real-time experience would have achieved a traditional cinematic comp-
ression of continuous time. By shifting the same time period forward and
back and repeating moments in time from the point of view of various
characters, Kubrick created a nonlinear narrative—it is no longer se-
quential storytelling. The result is an existential presentation of an event
that was doomed to fail because of human error, frailty, and the nature
of greed, fear, and mistrust.
The paradigm for contemporary nonlinear storytelling is exemplified
in Quentin Tarrantino's Pulp Fiction, which led the way for other 1990s
and early twenty-first-century filmmakers. Examples include The Usual
Suspects and Memento, which unfold in a backward chronology driven by
the mental state of the main character. Tarrantino arrived at the structure
of Pulp Fiction by weaving together characters and story lines he had cre-
ated working in the tradition of Mario Bava's Black Sabbath and literary
icon J. D. Salinger's handling of the Glass family in his stories and nov-
els. The original manuscript for the Pulp Fiction screenplay ran 500 pages
as Tarrantino incessantly comingled characters and their stories as new
narrative inventions inspired him during the process. Tarrantino evolved
a circular narrative structure that brought characters back to a central
episode.
Amores Perros (2000), a Mexican film written by Guillermo Arriga
Jordan and directed by Alexjandro Gonzalez Inarritu, benefits from the
cinematic narrative experiments that came before it, but this film goes
even further in constructing complex interrelationships between three
seemingly separate stories that unfold during the 153-minute running
time.
A full synopsis of Amores Perros is a daunting task that would reveal
little of this daring adventure through time and space. Amores Perros
needs to be experienced through several screenings, each revealing links,
connections, and references that may be impossible to fully comprehend
in their subtlety in a single viewing.
The three stories concern Octavio (Gael Garcia Bernal), a young man
who is involved with competitive dog fighting, and his sexual obsession
with Susana (Vanessa Bauche), the wife of his brother Ramiro (Marco
4 • Becoming Film Literate
Perez); Valeria (Goya Toledo), a fashion model, and Daniel (Alvaro Guer-
rero), who leaves his wife and family to live with her; and El Chivo
(Emilio Echevarria), a homeless man who searches for a daughter he
abandoned long ago.
Jordan and Inarritu entered into three years of discussions that resulted
in thirty-six separate story treatments. During the writing of the script,
they explored a multitude of ways to connect the stories and characters
into a narrative that would go beyond an episodic structure into a cohe-
sive story employing movement both forward and back in time to reveal
the impact, consequences, and destiny of the major characters in the three
stories.
By manipulating time, moving forward and back, and allowing shifts
of point of view and narrative logistics, Amores Perros brings character
and plot information from one story and places it in the context of an-
other. This becomes a narrative puzzle for the viewer. The challenge pays
off because Amores Perros demonstrates that the order in which facts and
plot points are received makes a significant impression on the viewer's
perception of the story. Taken philosophically, Amores Perros demonstrates
that although life is lived in a linear fashion, we acquire knowledge and
experience action, emotions, and feelings in a chaotic order outside our
control. The mind's ability to flash back and speculate into the future is
the human experiential equivalent of what Jordan and Inarritu have
achieved with their experiments in rejuvenating the film narrative.
It is a violent car crash that brings the characters of the three stories to-
gether. Amores Perros begins with the accident from Octavio's perspective.
This is the first scene in the film, but not the beginning—or the whole—
story. Information concerning this event is revealed in story points
throughout the film, but the entirety of that single moment is crystallized
only at the conclusion of the film.
Octavio's car crashes into Valeria's car. Later it is revealed El Chivo was
a witness standing on one of the corners. To begin with this information
would be no more than establishing a story in which strangers are
brought together because of an event or action. There is nothing experi-
mental about that approach. Amores Perros is about how lives often in-
tersect without the participants knowing it. The commonalities and
contrasts of their lives provide many venues for cinematic storytelling.
There is no central protagonist in Amores Perros, but several thematic
elements run through the stories that reflect the emotional drives of all
the characters. Everyone is in love. Octavio is trapped in a forbidden love.
Daniel and Valeria try to find happiness in an adulterous relationship. El
Chivo loves his daughter, but they are estranged due to his behavior in
the past.
Nonlinear Storytelling • 5
The concept according to Inarritu is that only those who love intensely
and fully can survive the intensity of existence. This is reflected in every
story. Octavio risks everything for Susana by challenging the destructive
powers-that-be in the violent and brutal world of dog fighting. The acci-
dent threatens Valeria's professional life as a supermodel and her pas-
sionate affair and commitment to Daniel. El Chivo is a homeless man who
survives by committing contract killings because of his earlier life as a
political radical.
As the title suggests, dogs play a significant role in the lives of the char-
acters in Amores Perros. A literal translation of Amores Perros is "Dog Love"
but the double meaning of "Love's a Bitch" is more revealing. Octavio's
dog is a champion fighter who earns him money but also puts him in
danger when Octavio is duped into a con that results in a violent con-
frontation culminating in the tragic crash. Valeria's precious dog Ritchie
falls into an open hole in the wooden floor of their apartment. This turns
her life and relationship with Daniel into turmoil. El Chivo lives with a
pack of dogs. When he comes into possession of Octavio's dog and nurses
the wounded canine back to good health, the dog's killer instincts moti-
vate the animal to kill all of El Chivo's loving canine companions.
Audiences have been conditioned to understand and anticipate tradi-
tional genre storylines and the familiar patterns of three-act narrative
structures. In The Thirty-Six Dramatic Situations by Georges Polti, first pub-
lished in 1921, the author establishes that all narrative plots throughout
the history of literature, the stage, and cinema can be traced to just thirty-
six dramatic situations. This understood, there are no new stories; but cin-
ematic structure can lead filmmakers to new solutions to visual
storytelling. Nonlinear storytelling provides the filmmaker with new
story structures and an alternate means to traditional situations. The au-
dience is challenged and active participation is achieved. A nonlinear
story requires the imagination of the creator and audience to live up to
the myriad narrative choices the medium of motion pictures has the po-
tential to express.
Of Further Interest
Screen
The Killing
Memento
Mishima
Mystery Train
Pulp Fiction
6 • Becoming Film Literate
Read
The Art of Dramatic Writing by Lajos Egri
The Screenwriter's Workbook by Syd Field
Story: Substance, Structure, Style, and the Principles of Screenwriting by
Robert McKee
The Thirty-six Dramatic Situations by Georges Polti
H
Transformation of the
American Comedy
Annie Holl
The American film comedy has a rich legacy: Charlie Chaplin, Buster
Keaton, Harold Lloyd, the Marx Brothers, W. C. Fields, Bob Hope, Jerry
Lewis, and, of course, the slapstick and screwball genres. By and large
the humor emerged out of story and situation. The films were often
crafted for the skills of the performer, but plot was the narrative engine.
The prehistory of the comedy film renaissance that took place during
the 1980s and 1990s is traceable to the work of Mel Brooks and Woody
Allen in the 1960s and 1970s. The humor in their films was not powered
by story construction but instead extrapolated concepts, ideas, and eth-
nic points of view from the art of stand-up and sketch comedy.
Before Annie Hall revolutionized the romantic comedy form in 1977 and
transformed film director Woody Allen into an internationally respected
auteur (see auteur theory in glossary), he was a hysterically funny and
very bright young topical comic. Woody Allen's roots as a television and
short story comedy writer along with his distinctive work as a stand-up
comic inform much that he has accomplished as a prolific and innovative
film director.
From these beginnings Allen created his screen persona as a neurotic,
New York anti-intellectual intellectual obsessed with sex and death.
Woody Allen is the nebbish as ladies' man, a walking encyclopedia of
one-liners filled with a dim, depressed life-view, who dispatches endless
highbrow references to express his fears and hostilities. The Allen hero is
lovable because he has such an inflated but harmless sense of his mas-
8 • Becoming Film Literate
Diane Keaton as Annie Hall and Woody Allen as Alvy Singer, dressed in their
iconic outfits and standing on an iconic Manhattan sidewalk during the late
1970s in Annie Hall, a film that both defined the Me Decade and reinvented
the romantic comedy. Courtesy Photofest.
culinity and, like the antihero who emerged during the 1960s and 1970s,
is sexy and cool, and has an ego too larger-than-life for his own good.
Annie Hall marks a clear delineation between the wordsmith comic who
directed Take the Money and Run, Bananas, Everything You Always Wanted
to Know about Sex but Were Afraid to Ask, Sleeper, and Love and Death and
the cinematic artist who was established with this Oscar-winning land-
mark.
The early films were very funny, based around a premise and com-
prising sketches. What they lacked in craft and directorial vision they
made up for in personality and originality. Annie Hall set out as an ex-
periment in personal, semiautobiographical cinema. Anhedonia was its
first title, a term describing an individual who cannot experience plea-
Transformation of the American Comedy • 9
violently with every pass of the coaster. His turbulent family life was like
living in the eye of a natural disaster.
Alvy is constantly confronted with conflict. He loves the streets of Man-
hattan but is perpetually agitated. Even the temples of intellectual com-
fort, the art movie theaters, aggravate Alvy. A fan invades his privacy
seeking an autograph and shouts out his celebrity spotting. An Ingmar
Bergman film has just started when Annie is a late arrival. He cannot enter
a film once it has begun and suggests they have coffee for two hours.
When Annie refuses they go to see Marcel Ophuls's The Sorrow and the
Pity, a four-and-half-hour documentary about Nazi-occupied France they
have both seen. On yet another pilgrimage to the cinema, Alvy becomes
frustrated with a pontificating man on line who claims to know every-
thing about communications theorist Marshall McLuhan. Alvy puts the
nuisance in his place by pulling the author of The Medium Is the Massage,
out from behind a lobby display. Alvy is self-persecuted by anti-Semitism.
In a signature shot suggested by Gordon Willis, Alvy and Rob (Tony
Roberts) take a long walk. They start at infinity (the furthest distance the
camera can "see") as the malcontent Singer recounts one of many per-
ceived verbal attacks. He is convinced he has heard the phrase "Jew eat,"
not "Did you eat?" as the two men come closer and closer to the camera
lens. At dinner with Annie's Waspy family Alvy is so self-conscious he
imagines that Grammy Hall (Helen Ludlam) imagines him in full Hasidic
garb. The East Coast/West Coast culture wars are graphically depicted
by a scene of Christmas in L.A. and a Hollywood party filled with shal-
low types typified by a young Jeff Goldblum on the phone in distress be-
cause he has forgotten his mantra.
Annie Hall is jammed with as many cultural references as a Jean-Luc
Godard film. They include Beowulf, Kafka, Uri Geller, Jack (Nicholson)
and Anjelica (Huston), Sylvia Plath, Norman Rockwell, Adlai Stevenson,
Leopold and Loeb, Death in Venice, Truman Capote, Groucho Marx, Mas-
ters and Johnson, the Manson Family, Henry Kissinger, Fire Island, and
The Denial of Death by Ernest Becker. Allen arms Alvy's world with am-
munition to define the characters, fuel the nonstop pungent one-liners,
and layer the film with the director's deep-seated and well-observed view
of the reality he finds himself embracing.
Annie Hall is a romantic comedy in which Annie and Alvy must con-
duct the rise and fall of a relationship as they deal with their past in a
present where cocaine snorting is trendy, therapy and personal transfor-
mation is required, and the roles of the traditional boy- and girlfriend
have been radicalized in the aftermath of the 1960s liberation revolutions.
Transformation of the American Comedy • 11
Alvy directly addresses the camera in the tradition of Brecht, Godard, and
Woody Allen's patron saint Ingmar Bergman in order to tell us who he
is. The neurosis of the morose, depressed, and sarcastic comic is a famil-
iar one, especially to those audience members who, like Alvy, turned forty
during the 1970s. Alvy travels in time to his childhood classroom, where
he points out the genesis of his oversexed obsessions and presents the fu-
ture of his young mates. This constellation of 1970s stereotypes, includ-
ing a white middle-class methadone addict, a blue-collar business owner,
a suited Brooks Brother, a leather fetishist, and a rabbinical supplier, are
added to the mix to jab at the generation's spiritual quest. The latter is
ridiculed throughout Annie Hall as Alvy skewers cults, the human po-
tential movement, and New Age gurus.
Allen takes Annie through her past darkly as she tries to come of age
from what he calls her Norman Rockwell existence to a cosmopolitan
woman who reads well, studies acting, and takes action on her dream to
become a cabaret singer. Annie is Alvy's light—her beauty, energy, and
zest for living is better than Valium for his jangled psyche.
At first the opposites attract. He wears Ralph Lauren and black spec-
tacles; she wears oversized man-tailored shirts, pants, tie, vest, and hat
(an ensemble that started an actual fashion trend). Allen created his char-
acters from his former real-life romance with Keaton. They are the soul
of Alvy and Annie with just enough poetic license to encourage Allen's
inventive sense of comic exaggeration. In a scene often misidentified as
a split-screen shot accomplished in the laboratory, Alvy and Annie are
shown in their respective therapy sessions. He is in a dark wood-paneled
Freudian environment and she in a comfortable, airy, and light space talk-
ing to an off-screen female therapist. This scene was actually shot and
performed live on an ingenious set designed by Mel Bourne that allowed
for the funny contrasts to flow naturally from Allen and Keaton without
optical interference.
Alvy nurtures Annie's cultural development. He is supportive and en-
couraging to a point. Annie gets Alvy to go to the country, and in her
presence he experiences the most fun his depressive nature will allow.
They are immediately attracted to each other, and the awkward insecuri-
ties of the dating game are materialized by a rooftop chat of getting-to-
know-you small talk as their self-doubting inner thoughts show up in
subtitles.
The majority of their time together and of the film's running length is
the romance, enjoying the city, wrestling with lobsters and spiders, mak-
ing love, talking endlessly about their lives, and pursuing careers.
12 • Becoming Film Literate
Annie Hall is a love story of its time. Annie and Alvy separate. He is
too possessive and anal and most happy when he is miserable. She has
found the person she wants to be and no longer yearns to be in a New
York state of mind. The end comes at an outdoor cafe in L.A. The joys of
their relationship are reprised in a montage. They are both better off for
having had each other in their lives. Back in the Apple, Alvy is outside
the Lincoln Center complex. A voiceover joke about a man who tells his
psychiatrist that the man's brother thinks he's a chicken sums up Alvy's
wistful observation on the need for companionship. The doctor asks why
the man continues the relationship with the delusional brother and he
replies, "But I need the eggs."
What influenced the transformation of Woody Allen from comic film-
maker to an-important auteur with the release of Annie Hall? The creative
teams and members of the ever-growing acting ensemble have made last-
ing contributions to the films of Woody Allen. After the editing room re-
structuring, and, it is fair to say, editorial rewriting of Annie Hall, Allen
began a process that involved writing, shooting, editing, rewriting,
reshooting, and completion in postproduction. The budget and schedule
were adjusted to accommodate this unconventional system. Rosenblum,
Willis, and Bourne were followed by other significant craft members.
Allen often still appears as a performer in his films supported by a Who's
who of fine, well-trained actors. Through a directorial apprenticeship in
which he searched for his voice, Woody Allen was a writer and performer.
Many hailed him as an artistic genius with the arrival of Annie Hall. That
term artist can be subjective. One thing is certain: On Annie Hall Woody
Allen came of age as a film director.
Of Further Interest
Screen
Chasing Amy
High Anxiety
Manhattan
The Producers
There's Something about Mary
Read
Woody Allen: A Biography by Eric Lax
The Unruly Life of Woody Allen: A Biography by Marion Meade
Transformation of the American Comedy • 13
When the Shooting Stops . . . the Cutting Begins: A Film Editor's Story by Ralph
Rosenblum and Robert Karen
Woody Allen: A Life in Film by Richard Schickel
Method in Madness: The Comic Art of Mel Brooks by Maurice Yacowar
B
Tableau Narrative Structure and
Sound Design
Apocalypse Now
Apocalypse Now (1979) takes place at the apex of U.S. involvement in the
Vietnam War. Captain Willard (Martin Sheen), a man conflicted by duty
and virtue, is assigned a confidential mission to hunt down and termi-
nate with extreme prejudice Colonel Walter Kurtz (Marlon Brando), a
former rising military star operating outside the purview of the military-
industrial complex.
The central metaphor of Apocalypse Now resonates in its title: the con-
frontation of good and evil, the quest for a spiritual path and an inquiry
into eternal truths. These themes address war, morality, and, for director
Francis Ford Coppola, the very foundations of moviemaking as they ex-
isted. He set out to create a film about America's military participation in
Vietnam that would travel through what Joseph Conrad called the Heart
of Darkness to examine and question the ethical code of the United States
by employing an emerging cinematic language that rebelled against the
notion of the "well-made" studio film.
Apocalypse Now was a culmination of directorial expression and excess
during a new golden age known as the American New Wave during the
1970s when the film director was superstar. A new generation of film-
makers took over Hollywood and transformed what had largely been en-
tertainment into personal statements with lofty narratives and aesthetic
goals.
The screenplay was written by John Milius (screenwriter of Magnum
Force, The Life and Times of Judge Roy Bean; director of Conan the Barbarian,
Tableau Narrative Structure and Sound Design • 15
"The horror, the horror" of war. The provocative and evocative images of
Francis Ford Coppola's Apocalypse Now, as well as the narrative's application
of Joseph Conrad's Heart of Darkness, were the armature for dreamlike narra-
tive tableaus and a sound design that propels the viewer into the hell of the
Vietnam War as seen through a filter of drugs, operatic emotionality, and
madness. Courtesy Photofest
Willard and that the out-of-control production was his own private trip
into the belly of the beast. In reality the director was actually behaving
more like Kurtz operating out on his own, risking his sanity, career, pos-
sessions, and even his family.
Apocalypse Now is a series of narrative tableaus positioned in sequen-
tial order. We are introduced to Willard as he begins to unravel mentally
in a hotel room; the officer is given his orders, a boat and crew are at his
disposal, and he is escorted to his point of departure. Willard then em-
barks on a journey upriver to the Kurtz compound deep in the jungles of
Cambodia. Each scene block of the odyssey is a saga unto itself. The crew
progresses into an increasingly surreal set of circumstances until Willard
reaches what Jim Morrison of the Doors quantified as "The End." The
structure is linear without parallel storytelling, flashbacks, or flashfor-
wards. Like Dante's Inferno, it is a descent into hell. Coppola doesn't drive
the story downward but horizontally—it is a cinematic trip upriver to
Hades.
Cinematographer Vittorio Storaro (The Conformist, Last Tango in Paris,
Dick Tracy) utilizes light, color, composition, and movement to illustrate
the story and visualize motifs and the emotional actuality of the charac-
ters—their time and place. Storaro's cinematography reproduces reality
of the moment and space through diaphanous layers of light.
The images of Vietnam are illuminated with a sense of empirical truth.
Storaro photographed Apocalypse Now in the anamorphic widescreen for-
mat to capture the horizontal axis of the sky, the jungle, and the river that
is the conduit of this road movie traveling by boat. Techno Vision in Italy
had just developed lenses with the optical properties to duplicate the high
level of definition seen by the human eye. This registers in the brain's
storage bank and is filed along with selective memories of a given period.
The light in Apocalypse Now produces glare, contrast, and saturated col-
ors, which embody the immediacy of the tumultuous 1960s.
Lateral tracking shots evoke the film's central metaphor. Throughout
Apocalypse Now the camera often follows a character—most notably
Colonel Bill Kilgore (Robert Duvall) as he briskly leads his men and
Willard to his helicopter in a prelude to an air attack. Framed in a full
shot in a straight-on profile, the camera tracks right to left locked into the
speed of Kilgore's confident stride. The trajectory of the camera move-
ment not only defines the powerful charisma of the character, but the tab-
ular direction is a gesture that continues to evoke a visual representation
of the theme defining Willard's pilgrimage toward a confrontation with
the other half of his psyche mirrored in Kurtz—his destiny is cinemati-
cally constant and inevitable.
Tableau Narrative Structure and Sound Design • 17
film, Willard imagines the sound of a turning hotel ceiling fan into a syn-
thesized blade thwarp that distinguishes his dream-state. This is then
blown out of his consciousness by the audio of an actual helicopter that
flies over the building, thereby returning the psychically burned-out of-
ficer to the material world of Saigon.
Throughout the film, narration puts us inside Willard's thoughts as he
tries to reason the purpose of his journey. This inner voice is up close and
resonates as if it were emanating from inside his head. It allows the
viewer to experience Willard's twisted cognitive condition.
During the helicopter battle Kilgore plays a tape of Wagner's Ride of the
Valkyries, which blares out of speakers mounted on the helicopter. The tri-
umphant horn melody and the heavenly choral voices signify power and
victory and bring associations of Nazi invasions and the superiority of a
master race. The perspective of source and score interchange and inter-
act with sounds of gunfire, helicopters, explosions, radio transmissions,
and shouting voices of the combatants, which constantly shift to produce
a hyperdramatic, cine-operatic encounter between sound and image.
To create the exterior ambiance of Kurtz's compound, Murch blended
realistic Southeast Asian jungle sounds that had been recorded for the
motion picture Lord Jim, music and singing of the Mung people of Cam-
bodia taken from ethno-musical records, Vietnamese dialogue spoken
from various depths in a hidden valley, and a track recorded at the San
Francisco Zoo bird room.
The interior of Kurtz's lair is depicted as a dank, wet ruin. There are
the sounds of seeping water and echoed drips from various parts of the
dark location that acoustically outline the space. Jungle inhabitants are
represented by cricket sounds and the suction-cupped fingers of a Philip-
pine lizard known as a gecko.
Coppola and his team of film editors—supervising editor Richard
Marks (Broadcast News, Dick Tracy, As Good as it Gets), Jerry Greenberg (The
French Connection, Kramer vs. Kramer, Scarface), Walter Murch, and Lisa
Fruchtman (Children of a Lesser God, My Best Friend's Wedding, Dance with
Me)—struggled incessantly to find a fitting conclusion for Apocalypse Now.
After trying every available possibility inherent in the raw footage, they
arrived at the concept that after Willard's ritualistic killing of Kurtz, he
reads the man's typewritten diary and finds the message "Drop the
bomb—exterminate them all!" written in scrawl. The Doors' song
"The End" is heard at the beginning and end of the film. As sung by the
Dionysian rocker Jim Morrison, the modal, tribal ode is an oedipal drama
that deliberates patricide. Its presence establishes a preordained affinity
between Willard and Kurtz. Willard then emerges from the cave carrying
Tableau Narrative Structure and Sound Design • 19
the diary, throws down the murderous knife, and is acknowledged by the
tribe as their new leader. Willard rejects this and leads Lance, the only
survivor of his crew, back to the boat. They turn the vessel around to
travel the river once again. They receive radio contact asking for confir-
mation but Willard shuts it off. We hear Kurtz repeat Conrad's prophetic
words, "The horror, the horror." The fruitless search for a logical ending
to a film about the Vietnam War is the consummate metaphor of
Apocalypse Now. The war and the film can never truly be resolved and
must lie within a conflicted American heart.
Of Further Interest
Screen
Burden of Dreams
The Deer Hunter
Fitzcarraldo
Full Metal Jacket
Hearts of Darkness: A Filmmaker's Apocalypse
Read
Novels into Film: The Metamorphosis of Fiction into Cinema by George Bluestone
Audio-Vision: Sound On Screen by Michel Chion
Notes by Eleanor Coppola
The Apocalypse Now Book by Peter Cowie
The Conversations: Walter Murch and the Art of Editing Film by Michael Ondaatje
D
The Body as Cinematic Landscape
L'Avventura
The figures of Gabriele Ferzetti as Sandro and Lea Massari as Anna become
part of the architecture and landscape in Michelangelo Antonioni's
UAvventura. Courtesy Photofest
Struggling to stay apart from each other, Sandro and Claudia become
emotionally entangled while they search for Anna in various towns and
receive rumors and leads that never result in finding Anna. When Clau-
dia eventually submits to her feelings toward Sandro, he becomes disin-
terested and Claudia catches him sleeping with another woman. The
conclusion finds Sandro emotionally broken. Claudia stands behind him
and puts her hand on his head signifying a commitment to him out of
the pain they share and endure. Anna is all but forgotten by the time
L'Avventura ends. Claudia has traded places with Anna, a metaphysical
process that has evolved throughout the course of the film.
Many of the themes expressed in L'Avventura recur throughout Anto-
nioni's body of work. The individual is alienated from the environment
and is unable to experience pure intimacy. There is conflict between the
ancient and modern worlds. The body is part of the physical landscape.
Emotions are contained within a human figure whose texture and archi-
tecture is flesh and bone, part of the universe of sky, earth, water, animal,
22 • Becoming Film Literate
outside on the piazza. At first she appears to be alone but the camera
moves to reveal men on large stone steps staring at her. Claudia walks
away and a tilt-up reveals men above her glaring down. Swarms of men
on the ground surround her. The men are of all ages and physical ap-
pearances. No matter, they all ogle Claudia in a chauvinistic and threat-
ening manner. There is a sense of danger as Claudia becomes the vortex
of the mob's attention. As Sandro comes out of the building, Claudia es-
capes and runs away from all the men, including Sandro. She finds haven
in a shop where she orders paint. Sandro follows and the two reunite to
continue what began as a search for Anna, then became a search for com-
panionship and love.
Sandro is all for the hunt. He does everything in his power to have a
relationship with Claudia. She is in pain over the disappearance of her
friend. Although she is attracted to Sandro, Claudia finds it morally
wrong to be with him. Eventually there is no more talk about Anna and
Claudia falls in love with Sandro. When this occurs, Sandro loses inter-
est. He is an angry and damaged soul, full of perversity. When he sees
an artist's pen-and-ink drawing of an architectural detail, Sandro knocks
the bottle over and ruins the sketch. The act is not committed directly but
perversely by swinging his long key chain over the ink until the keys
eventually make contact with the bottle. The young artist is furious. San-
dro says it was an accident but when the boy's friend breaks up a fight
between the two, Sandro brags about how many fights he had as a young
man. As he maintains his superiority a long procession of boys in black
religious garb files by, reminding Sandro of the confining religious monar-
chy that presides over his world. When Sandro leaves Claudia in a hotel
room to rest, he again brags about his youth and his stamina. Now that
he has Claudia, Sandro is restless and free to roam. Prowling the party
below, while Claudia lies fitfully in bed, Sandro gets involved with an-
other woman. In the remaining minutes of L'Avventura, Claudia, worried
about Sandro, finds him on the couch with the woman. The final scene,
in which the jilted Claudia walks over to Sandro seated on a bench, his
psyche broken, and places her hand on his head, concludes with the only
true human contact in the film. The ending is ambiguous. Claudia and
Sandro are destined to be together, joined by Anna, but what the future
holds for them is unexplained. The viewer is left with emotional devas-
tation and a final image, a long shot of the two engulfed within the land-
scape.
Antonioni, like Hitchcock with Psycho (see chapter 34), which was also
released in 1960, takes his lead actress out of the movie early in the story.
L'Avventura also appears to be a mystery, but Hitchcock shifts his film to
The Body as Cinematic Landscape • 25
Of Further Interest
Screen
American Gigolo
L'Eclisse (Eclipse)
Landscape in the Mist
La Notte (The Night)
The Sacrifice
Two Lane Blacktop
Read
The Architecture of Vision: Writings and Interviews on Cinema by Michelangelo An-
tonioni, Marga Conttino-Jones, G. Tinazzi, C. Di Carlo, editors.
That Bowling Alley on the Tiber: Tales of a Director by Michelangelo Antonioni
Antonioni: The Poet of Images by William Arrowsmith, Ted Perry, editor.
Antonioni or, The Surface of the World by Seymour Chatman
Passion and Defiance: Film in Italy from 1942 to the Present by Mira Liehm
B
Editing—Russian Montage
The cinematic term montage is erroneously generalized and used all too
freely to indicate rapid-paced editing, or it is tossed around encased in
the more nebulous phrase "MTV editing." The most significant definition
of montage concerns the theories and practice of early Russian filmmak-
ers including Sergei Eisenstein (1898-1948; The General Line, Alexander
Nevsky, Ivan the Terrible), Vsevolod Pudovkin (Mother, The End of St. Pe-
tersburg, Storm Over Asia), Alexander Dovzhenko (Arsenal, Earth, Aero-
gard), and Lev Kuleshov (The Extraordinary Adventures of Mr. West in the
Land of the Bolsheviks, The Death Ray, Dura Lex/By the Law).
Films at the dawn of the cinema were composed of a single shot. The
pioneering Lumiere brothers set up their camera and recorded an event
such as workers leaving a factory or the arrival of a train at a station.
Eventually, filmmakers began to experiment with shot-by-shot visual sto-
rytelling. Among those responsible for this development are Edwin S.
Porter with The Great Train Robbery and D. W. Griffith, whose work led to
the creation of a cinematic language that utilized angles, shot size, com-
position, and a number of other elements to forge a story during the ed-
itorial process. Working with these principles, the Russians created a
powerful visual grammar that employed the graphic dynamics of each
shot which they edited into montages.
Sergei Eisenstein was the most consequential filmmaker of this move-
ment. His achievements on The Battleship Potemkin, October, and Strike,
along with dense intellectual writings on his theory of montage published
Editing—Russian Montage • 27
One shot—one montage unit—from the Odessa Steps sequence in The Battle-
ship Potemkin. Sergei Eisenstein's theory of collision transformed powerful im-
ages into more than their sum worth. Courtesy Photofest
as the books Film Form and Film Sense, created the basis for Russian mon-
tage. The subject as practiced by Eisenstein is complex. The presiding con-
cept was the result of a collision effect between shots, each designed for
their graphic, narrative, social, and optimum political purpose. Classical
Hollywood editing was based on continuity and the matching of shots to
link images seamlessly.
The Battleship Potemkin (1925) is the central work for understanding the
power and aesthetic methods of the Russian school of montage. The dra-
matic structure is partitioned into five parts. Part One, "The Men and the
Maggots," deals with a revolt by the sailors of the battleship Potemkin
against the brutal captain and his officers. When the men are forced to
eat meat rotten with maggots, a breakdown in social order occurs. Crash-
ing waves on the shore poetically signal turbulence on the ship. A sailor
wakes up the sleeping crew and begins to rouse them with passions of
28 • Becoming Film Literate
revolt. The sailors lying in hammocks are lit in a lazy but oppressive light.
As the man speaks, a flurry of reaction shots signal the building anger.
Eisenstein used the conflict of the physical and emotional to create ac-
tion. Performers and characterizations are not traditionally developed but
quickly rendered with physical types and a synthesized reaction that rap-
idly travels to the kinetic emotive issues of the story.
The next morning, hanging meat crawling with bugs is the impetus for
a calamitous confrontation within the class structure of the ship. The doc-
tor and captain are clearly cruel disciplinarians who take a hard line
against the men. Eating the food they serve becomes a question of loy-
alty. In a series of images Eisenstein develops several themes. Multiple
angles of the ship's long guns being cleaned represent power and order.
The soup with the diseased meat boils furiously in pots. The sailors eat
canned goods to sustain themselves. The dining room is set up with ta-
bles hung from long rods that force them to swing back and forth. This
movement creates tension and is a hanging metaphor for those who
would eat the deadly meal. The men peer down from the deck. The tex-
ture of light is altered by metal grids, providing a sense of doom and the
urgency for the action they must take. The montage accelerates as the men
refuse to eat; the soup boils, dishes are washed, the faces of the kitchen
crew grow angrier, a plate inscription, "Give us this day our daily bread"
culminates in rage—the plate is smashed.
The next act, "Drama in the Harbor," is in reaction to the events and
strong sentiments of the first act. Angles on a bugler set the scene. The
officers and sailors assemble in formation. A repeated high-angle master
shot is the core of the montage here. It orients the viewer and graphically
presents the formality of the procedure and the consequences of the men's
refusal to eat. Close-ups isolate key characters and quickly define their
attitude. For Eisenstein, officers with mustaches and glasses have an ar-
rogant air of bureaucracy and dominance over the men they govern. The
movement of the men is presented with carefully composed shots that
emphasize the graphic patterns of the developing discord. Intercutting
sets up the multiaction that stems from the confrontation. Shots of men
spreading the word to assemble by the gun turret are montaged with the
forceful orders of the angry captain supported by his officers. An old man
with long flowing hair and beard, wearing biblical dress, and wielding
an oversized metal cross, stands at the top of a staircase looking down at
the tense proceedings. He is not identified but appears to be a religious
figure overseeing spiritual matters. Later during the rebellion he tries to
bring peace but his cross is knocked to the ground by the mutineers and
becomes a symbol of a hatchet. As the rebellious sailors who are to be ex-
Editing—Russian Montage • 29
ecuted are covered with a tarp, a group of marksmen file out, forming an
angle that creates dynamic visual tension. As the order to shoot is given,
a chaotic fight breaks out. Eisenstein choreographs this in detail not un-
like a contemporary action film. In a rapid montage, guns are pulled out
of a rack, there are shots of feet going down steps, and officers are thrown
overboard. The men dance and rejoice in their victory over the tyrants.
This is intercut with the leader of the rebellion shot and hung on a rope.
The men learn what has happened and pull him up. The action progresses
quickly. The fallen leader is carried by the crew and they put him in a
small boat, and black and white smoke fills the air. On his body is a can-
dle and sign that reads "Killed for a plate of soup." As the funeral vessel
travels to the harbor the pace slows down.
Throughout The Battleship Potemkin the montage pace modulates ac-
cording to the emotional content of the action, an important principle
often ignored by current practitioners of the style. This is not fast editing
purely for the sake of quick pace to keep the drama moving, but is care-
fully designed visual storytelling orchestrated to unfold a narrative in a
kinetic, didactic, and ultimately visceral manner.
Part Three is "A Dead Man Calls for Justice." The narrative tone and
editorial rhythm change dramatically. A montage sets the mood. A ship
is on a misty sea. The sun reflects off the ocean, old ships are in the water,
and birds rest on a buoy, reflecting a peaceful image not transformed into
a melancholy mood until it is in the context of the watery funeral cortege
in progress. On land the body of the dead hero is laid out in a tent with
a black ribbon. Ships are in the port. One by one, people come to honor
him. Grief and righteous anger build. There are intercuts to the dead man.
In context with shots of the mourners, the emotional intensity builds. The
image of the senseless murder of a man who sacrificed himself for a nas-
cent movement is rousing to the gathering throngs. Each cut advances the
call to action. The viewer experiences these feelings though the relation-
ships created by the montage, which intensifies in breadth of shared emo-
tions as the stirring crowd grows. The shot of the deceased man is from
the point of view of someone sitting just outside the tent looking in. To
embody the temper of the grieving, there is a shot taken from inside the
tent on the mourners outside. This is held for a long duration to estab-
lish the intense grief they experience. Here Eisenstein used the outpour-
ing from the swelling crowd and the graphic power of the staging, not
montage, as an opportunity to absorb emotions and to ready for the ac-
tion that will result from this communion with their martyr. An iris shot
widens to reveal a long flight of stone steps, then masses of people filing
toward the body appear on the steps. A procession pays respects. These
30 • Becoming Film Literate
Of Further Interest
Screen
Earth
The End of St. Petersburg
Natural Born Killers
October
Straw Dogs
The Strike
Read
Montage Eisenstein by Jacques Aumont
Sergei Eisenstein: A Life in Conflict by Ronald Bergan
Film Form: Essays in Film Theory by Sergei Eisenstein
The Film Sense by Sergei Eisenstein
Nonindifferent Nature: Film and the Structure of Things by Sergei Eisensten
Eisenstein at Work by Jay Leyda and Zina Voynow
H
Italian Neorealism
The relationship between the characters and their environment was a key el-
ement of Italian neorealism. The reality of seeing the honest faces of nonac-
tors and professional performers stripped of artifice was heightened by a
carefully planned cinematic design in which the frame enclosed what ap-
peared to be the real life of wartime and post-World War II Italy. Courtesy
Photofest
proper meal. Bruno can't use the knife and fork as required, so he eats
with his fingers. Antonio introduced the experience as a treat, but after
he has Bruno total up figures for what he would earn with the lost bike,
he again becomes obsessed with finding it as the only way for his family
to be happy. The great plaza surrounding a soccer stadium becomes a
moral challenge to Antonio. The stadium represents the national sport
and is filled with people from Rome's society. Antonio is on the outside
as bike riders race by him. Hundreds of parked bikes are a temptation for
him to cross the line and become a thief himself.
The directorial approach to this film is as conceptual and controlled as
any dramatic fiction film. The Bicycle Thief is not an example of a docum-
entary style applied to fiction such as is brilliantly realized in The Battle
of Algiers (Gillo Pontecorvo, 1965). The distinction between The Bicycle
Thief and traditional drama lies in the use of nonactors and in the devo-
tion to a narrative that reflects and embraces unvarnished realism. The
entire cast is completely believable. Casting was a painstaking process.
De Sica's performers were from the working class being portrayed on the
screen. They not only had the look of authenticity, but were able to take
direction, repeat actions, and transmit their internal truths to the camera.
Whereas trained actors will use technique to indicate the emotions, feel-
ings, and action of characters they are playing, nonactors have life expe-
rience and a physicality that is their own—not an artistic creation.
The visualization of The Bicycle Thief includes camera placement and
coverage that emphasizes the growing distance between Antonio and
Bruno. The boy is constantly trailing behind his father, unable to keep up
because Antonio is so determined that he is unaware of the presence of
his son. Later this becomes even more dramatic when Antonio slaps his
son in the face. The shot dynamics and blocking reveal Bruno's deep hurt.
The boy has been so loyal, and now he is emotionally upset to be rejected
by his father. Bruno walks as far away from Antonio as is physically pos-
sible within the frame. The graphics and perspective lines of these shots
support the guilt of Antonio and the indignant Bruno.
When Antonio first gets his bike out of hock, he leaves it on the street
and asks a small group of boys to watch it as he goes up to a fortune-
teller his wife wants to repay for their good luck. The composition gives
the impression that the bike may be stolen. Tension is achieved and we
are relieved when the bike is still there upon Antonio's return. There are
false alarms when Antonio thinks that he has found the bike, but his eyes
have deceived him; they are expressed by way of the camera and editing.
People and circumstance get in Antonio's way to prolong the suspense.
To visually project the determination with which Antonio tracks down
Italian Neorealism • 37
the old man he believes knows who stole his bike, De Sica has the father
and son follow the old man into a facility dedicated to tending for the
poor. As a barber shaves the old and scruffy man, Antonio and Bruno
sidle up next to him in a full shot and also in a two-shot that is intercut
with the man's reaction. The camera and character choreography of the
sequences in which Antonio and Bruno hunt down the thief and the old
man are planned, blocked, and visualized to simulate or create the illu-
sion of realism.
De Sica uses dramatic technique no differently than a director like Al-
fred Hitchcock or John Ford, and dramatic techniques are employed in
the unfolding of the narrative. The establishment of Antonio's dismissive
attitude toward the fortune-teller at the beginning of the film, before the
bike is stolen, pays off at the end when Antonio and Bruno return to her
for help as a last hopeless measure. The woman's advice—if you don't
find it today, you will never find it—builds up the audience's expectation
and highlights the tragedy when the day ends without success.
De Sica employs the visual power and simplicity of silent cinema.
When Antonio's wife, Maria (Lianella Carell), hocks her marriage bed
sheets tucked in a bag, as the clerk takes them a tilt-up reveals shelves to
the ceiling of hundreds of the same. This one shot poetically communi-
cates the dire situation of the Italian working class. The intercutting be-
tween Bruno, who has been ordered by his father to go home by bus, and
Antonio, who has decided he will steal a lone bike propped up against a
wall, is pure visual storytelling. As soon as Antonio makes the fateful
grab, the owner appears. After a chase Antonio is harassed and beaten by
locals. The man has pity when he looks at the humiliation Antonio has
suffered and the shame on Bruno's face. This masterfully directed se-
quence ends with a shot that defines the difference between American
and international cinema. Both father and son walk off and are lost in the
crowd as the sun falls. They continue to walk away from the camera.
There is no next shot, no last minute twist—this is life as it is. In reality
happy endings are rare. The bike is lost forever, but Bruno and Antonio
have come together. The family is strong—the struggle for work and sur-
vival goes on.
Italian neorealism was a powerful statement to attest that the language
of cinematic storytelling could be used for realistic drama beyond literary,
theatrical, or Hollywood cinema. The ramifications and legacy of Italian
neorealism have been wide-ranging. Elia Kazan and Sidney Lumet were
influenced by the movement, as were John Cassavetes, Martin Scorsese,
and Nick Gomez. The Panic in Needle Park, Midnight Cowboy, Mean Streets,
and many other films would not have existed without Italian neorealism.
38 • Becoming Film Literate
Notes
1. David O. Selznick (1902-1965) was an independent Hollywood producer
who administered total control over the films he produced for his company,
Selznick International. Famous for his endlessly detailed memos and as the man
who brought Alfred Hitchcock from England to America, Selznick is best known
for his epic production of Margaret Mitchell's novel, Gone with the Wind.
Of Further Interest
Screen
Boy
Miracle in Milan
Umberto D
When Father Was Away on Business
The White Balloon
Read
Vittorio De Sica: Director, Actor, Screenwriter by Bert Cardullo
Miracle in Milan by Vittorio De Sica
Popular Film Culture in Fascist Italy: The Passing of the Rex by James Hay
Italian Film by Marcia Landy
Zavattini: Sequences from a Cinematic Life by Cesare Zavattini
B
Production Design
Blade Runner
Blade Runner, directed by Ridley Scott, is adapted from the novel Do An-
droids Dream of Electric Sheep? by Philip K. Dick (author of Man in the High
Castle, Time Out of Joint, and Vaiis). The title is derived from one of William
S. Burroughs's lesser-known literary works, Blade Runner: A Movie. The
production later learned of another book titled Blade Runner, by Alan E.
Nourse. Both titles were acquired so the film could legally use the phrase
and apply it to the story.
In the film a blade runner is a hunter contracted by law enforcement
to track down and kill genetically created replicants considered to be
criminals because they pose as human. The story takes place in Los An-
geles during November 2019. Rick Deckard (Harrison Ford), a former
member of the L.A.P.D. Blade Runner unit, is ordered by Captain Bryant
(M. Emmet Walsh) to locate and terminate with extreme prejudice four
escaped replicants: Zhora (Joanna Cassidy), a snake-charming exotic
dancer; Leon Kowalski (Brion James), a ground-floor worker at the ge-
netic engineering company Tyrell Corporation; Pris (Daryl Hannah), a
pleasure model; and Roy Batty (Rutger Hauer), a top-of-his-class combat
model. During a meeting with Eldon Tyrell (Joe Turkel), Deckard meets
Rachel (Sean Young), a replicant who is unaware of her status. As he
hunts down his prey, Deckard falls in love with Rachel. At story's end
Deckard has completed his assignment and learns that the state of being
human is far more complex than the black and white, right-and-wrong
existence he had been living.
40 • Becoming Film Literate
Harrison Ford, as Rick Deckard, hunts down replicants in Blade Runner. The
Ridley Scott film, production designed by Lawrence G. Paull, combines ele-
ments of film-noir, retro-fitted, and ancient architecture to render a cinematic
environment that is a universe in and of itself. Courtesy Photofest.
is human?", was a man for our times in the real and imagined twenty-
first century.
Ridley Scott, who had achieved great success with Alien, conceived and
planned Blade Runner as mass audience entertainment. He insisted on an
uncomplicated narrative to create a platform for the Dickian theme of
challenging the nature of what it is to be human. The replicants who are
aware of their creation express programmed emotions but seem to be
human in their reactions and behavior. They are criminals who seem to
think and act on their feelings. Rachel does not have knowledge of her
creation and appears to have the capacity to love. The perfect application
of another woman's memories through cloning makes her not just a copy,
but someone with the capacity to act out of present experience. She chal-
lenges Deckard to compare his detachment and limited emotional range
with replicants and questions his humanity. Ultimately, Blade Runner de-
fines a human by thought, deed, action, and compassion, not birthright.
Blade Runner is a neonoir. It takes place in 2019 but is very rooted in
1940s culture, style, and social interaction. Deckard is crafted in the mold
of the hard-boiled detective; Rachel is a femme fatale. The film takes place
at night, and the world of Blade Runner is doom-laden. Film noir (see
chapter 18) was a critical term assigned to postwar films with these and
other fingerprints. They were all photographed in black and white. Cre-
ating a color noir in the 1980s changed the convention. This new move-
ment was coined neonoir and is defined by its relationship to that
historical period in film, but in the neonoir the content and aesthetics of
film noir are applied to a narrative taking place in the present or, in the
case of Blade Runner, in the future. The neonoir story has an emotional
basis in the cultural past, but the visualization reflects recent aesthetic
trends. Blade Runner has also been called a future noir, a category it es-
tablished by placing the film's time frame in the twenty-first century
while still embracing the noir and neonoir credo.
The content of a narrative is most often expressed by the plot and char-
acters of a film. Ridley Scott is a visualist, a director who communicates
through images and sound to tell a motion picture story. He kept to his
promise of an accessible narrative that could be understood by a general
audience, but he used the armature of the detective yarn to tell a multi-
faceted story. To read the film, the viewer must understand the visual lan-
guage Ridley Scott employs. Every shot in Blade Runner is filled with
elements that contribute, comment, and expand on the story. To fully ex-
perience Blade Runner, the audience must comprehend not just dialogue
and plot, but the meaning imparted by the camera, light, sound, and,
most acutely, the intricate and densely complex production design.
42 • Becoming Film Literate
The fusion of the layered art direction and complex presence of shift-
ing bands of illumination create a fully realized world. The reality of
many places, time periods, and geographical influences are omnipresent.
This visual diversity creates a city with its own character, history, and pur-
pose. We see an environment in which catastrophe has altered the Earth.
The population has left Earth for other worlds. Los Angeles is dark, de-
cayed, and burning. Those who are left are the underbelly of society.
Asian culture dominates. This is a third-world city.
Blade Runner takes place at night. The city is illuminated by twinkling
lights, fires that spout out between buildings throughout the dense sky-
line, and countless large electric signs that advertise high-tech companies
such as Atari and TDK from giant displays. The streets are under con-
stant police surveillance; beams of light search everywhere. Some of the
grids of the city are overcrowded; many others are empty. The light pat-
tern, color, and texture are captured through a constant presence of rain,
and a permanent choking smog that shrouds the city.
To execute the visualization of Blade Runner, Ridley Scott used a tech-
nique he calls layering. For Scott, design is more than sets; the process
includes hair, makeup, costumes, visual effects, lighting, props, architec-
ture, color, and texture. These elements contribute to the overall atmos-
phere and have their specific purpose in transmitting information and in
eliciting an emotional and psychological impulse.
The design team for Blade Runner was far more extensive than on the
traditional motion picture. In addition to his background as a director in
feature films and advertising, Ridley Scott was an experienced art direc-
tor in commercials. The production designer Lawrence G. Paull (Back to
the Future trilogy, Romancing the Stone, Escape from L.A.) was a trained ar-
chitect and city planner who followed his dreams to design movies by
landing a position in the 20th Century-Fox art department. Visual futur-
ist Syd Mead was a corporate designer for Ford Motor Company and later
ran his own firm before contributing to the design of many films, in-
cluding Star Trek: The Motion Picture, Tron, 2010, Aliens, Short Circuit, and
Strange Days. Special photographic effects supervisor Douglas Trumbull
(2001: A Space Odyssey, The Andromeda Strain, Close Encounters of the Third
Kind), costume designer Charles Knode (Never Say Never Again, 1492: Con-
quest of Paradise, Braveheart), makeup artist Marvin G. Westmore (Breaking
Away, Project X, Deuces Wild), and hair stylist Shirley Padgett (The Driver,
Romantic Comedy, The Osterman Weekend) were all contributors to the lay-
ers of visual detail that produced the look of Blade Runner.
The mission was to create a total environment—a city built on a sound
stage and back lot. Scott and Paull began by conceptualizing and then
Production Design • 43
planning in detail every aspect of the Los Angeles of 2019, even those be-
yond the scope of the screenplay. Only then could they design and con-
struct what was specifically needed to accomplish this on film and to
supervise, delegate, and collaborate with the entire design team.
Paull had just returned from his first trip to Milan, Italy. The designer
was struck by the fascist influence of the city built by Benito Mussolini
with the support of Adolf Hitler, whose chief architect was Albert Speer.
Paull observed that buildings in Milan were built right up to the curb.
Narrow streets were covered with large arcades. The streets on the stu-
dio back lot were also narrow—not constructed to full size. Paull applied
the lessons of Milan to the Blade Runner text. In the story, the middle class
has left Earth for off-world colonies. The population of the city of Los An-
geles is composed of the dregs that remain. The working class supplies
the revenue for the unemployed and homeless. The city is dilapidated.
When systems break down, they are discarded. Buildings are retrofitted.
The city is dark, overpopulated, and poisoned with acid rain; the minor-
ity population is transient, uneducated, and speaks as if in the story of
the tower of Babel.
The early work of French cartoonist Jean Giraud, known as Moebius,
was a major influence on the city design of Blade Runner. Scott and Paull
found the concept of video street monitors that broadcast public infor-
mation and traffic signals in one of his drawings. Giraud created his own
comic strip in 1956 at age eighteen, the result of growing up immersed in
a world of comics, science fiction, and fantasy. In 1963 he appeared as
Moebius in Hari Kiri, an underground satirical magazine, and later be-
came one of the founding members of the magazine Metal Hurlant, which
became Heavy Metal in America. Scott was intrigued with the sexually
charged, dangerous futuristic world of Moebius, which became another
layer in the visual universe of Blade Runner.
Frank Lloyd Wright, the dominant American architect who believed
buildings should reflect their environment, was another major influence
on Blade Runner. Deckard's apartment was based on Wright House on Do-
heny Drive in Los Angeles. Paull did not design the set on the layout or
look of the Wright House but extracted the concept of that home as a cave.
Paull envisioned Deckard's apartment as a womb. The rooms are laid out
in a linear order. Walls are bracketed out in a series of vaults. There is a
sixteen-by-sixteen poured concrete block with design work from Wright's
designs in the early 1920s. Gothic vaults in a high-rise building reveal
broken surfaces that jut out. Recessed lights projecting down complete
the cave metaphor.
The Bradbury building was used for the residence of J. F. Sebastian
44 • Becoming Film Literate
have eroded; and the nature of being human has been complicated by
media and computer overload, New Age religions, a break with tradi-
tional lifestyles, aberrant behavior, extreme makeovers, and the wide-
spread use of recreational and psychotropic medication.
Of Futher Interest
Screen
Alien
The Matrix
Minority Report
Star Wars
2001: A Space Odyssey
Read
Ridley Scott by James Clarke
Do Androids Dream of Electric Sheep? by Philip K. Dick
Retrofitting Blade Runner: Issues in Ridley Scott's "Blade Runner" and Philip K.
Dick's "Do Androids Dream of Electric Sheep?" by Judith B. Kerman
Future Noir: The Making of Blade Runner by Paul M. Sammon
Divine Invasions: A Life of Philip K. Dick by Lawrence Sutin
D
Dream State
6/ue Velvet
Dennis Hopper, a respected art collector and authority as well as the actor
who plays the villainous Frank Booth in Blue Velvet (1986), classified di-
rector David Lynch as an American surrealist. Surrealism is an art and lit-
erature movement that began in 1924 when writer Andre Breton
published a manifesto defining it as a "super-reality" forged by combin-
ing reality with the dream state. Surrealism embraces thoughts, ideas, and
perceptions considered strange, illogical, and irreconcilable. A surrealist
work springs not so much from imagination or life experience, although
it may appear to, but from the deep well of the subconscious mind.
Freud's theory that dreams were a manifestation of submerged thoughts
and feelings served as inspiration for many of the founding practitioners
of surrealism. After flourishing for two decades as a dominant aesthetic,
the classical period of surrealism ended when the majority of the Euro-
peans who created and practiced this art-of-the-irrational emmigrated to
the United States. The Communist doctrine and social upheaval of the
European continent was reflected in surrealism but seemed ill-suited to
America as a young country where democracy was based on sound ra-
tional principles. All that changed during the Vietnam era of the 1960s,
when the American Dream experienced nightmares of its own. David
Lynch is a reporter from the front lines, but his sources are not fact-
based—they come from the dark side of his eagle scout persona.
As a boy, David Lynch was encouraged to draw and paint by his
mother, who refused to buy him coloring books, and by his father, a gov-
Dream State • 47
Voyeurism and the nightmare underworld hidden from civilized society is the
stuff of a cinematic dream state created in David Lynch's Blue Velvet. Here
Kyle MacLachlan as Jeffrey Beaumont, peers through the slatted door of a
closet as he witnesses the horror and deviant behavior human beings are ca-
pable of. Courtesy Photofest.
ernment worker who brought home reams of blank paper. David drew
images that represented a post-World War II world: ammunition, air-
planes and Browning Automatic water-cooled submachine guns. The ed-
ucation of David Lynch was extensive. After attending art schools in
Washington, D.C., and Boston, he went on to the Pennsylvania Academy
of Fine Arts and was a fellow at the American Film Institute, where his
work as a painter led him to express his emotional life through the cin-
ema.
It is through his work as a fine artist that David Lynch can best be un-
derstood. Although he was blessed with an idyllic childhood in a small
town in Montana, Lynch has always taken an extremely close look at the
perfect world in which he lived. He saw black pitch oozing out of a beau-
tiful cherry tree and millions of crawling red ants. The titles of Lynch's
paintings from the 1980s and 1990s, a time in which he created the dis-
48 • Becoming Film Literate
way Harvey Keitel served that purpose for Martin Scorsese in Mean
Streets. MacLachlan has similar physical characteristics to Lynch, but
there is an uncanny sense that this good-looking, well-groomed young
man appears as if he is an alien from another planet. Throughout his life,
people in and out of the film industry have questioned whether Lynch is
just visiting from another planet, possibly Mars. Strangeness is impossi-
ble to define in a human being, but we know it when we see it. David
Lynch is weird and when he met MacLachlan while casting his produc-
tion of Frank Herbert's Dune, he knew he found a leading man in his own
image.
Sound is fifty percent of the cinematic experience. David Lynch has a
full command over the atmospheric and psychological impact sound de-
sign can bring to a film. Working with Alan Splet (Eraserhead, The Black
Stallion, Henry and June), Lynch created an aural environment to support
the altered reality of the visuals. Hyper-realistic exterior sound effects,
like the crickets heard while Sandy makes her magical entrance, heighten
the surreal nature of Blue Velvet. Dorothy's apartment building has a
buzzing electric sign and a low wind that can be heard through the walls.
The hissing of the sexual stimulant gas Frank inhales transforms him from
a bad man to a manic state of evil beyond human control.
Music is a transcendent force in Blue Velvet. When Ben (Dean Stockwell)
lip-synchs to the Roy Orbison song "In Dreams" and is lit by the harsh
light of a hand-held work lamp, the degenerate party of large-sized
women with dyed hair and Frank and his gang become the demented
cast of an American musical staged in hell. The love Frank experiences is
not pure; it is motivated by violent sex and power over his sick domain.
The focus transitions to how Jeffrey and Sandy fall in love during these
evil proceedings. Jeffrey begins as a boy and grows up when infatuated
by the unbalanced desires of an older woman in emotional pain. At a
teenage house party, a surfing instrumental quickly fades away. Jeffrey
takes Sandy to a slow dance. A song begins. Although the other kids
dance in the background, it plays only for Sandy and Jeffrey. They kiss
and pledge their love. The song, "Mysteries of Love," with lyrics by
David Lynch, music written by Angelo Baldamenti (Parents, The City of
Lost Children, Mulholland Dr.), and sung by Julee Cruise, is a spiritual rev-
elation. Cruise has an ethereal voice, healing Blue Velvet with the sounds
of an angel. The mystery becomes one of falling in love as the wind blows
and a couple kisses forever. After Frank and the conspiracy of his crimi-
nal world are defeated, another ear appears. It is attached to Jeffrey. He
is home with his family and his Sandy. The song continues. Dorothy is
reunited with her true love—that of a mother for her son. Sandy repeats
52 • Becoming Film Literate
the line that encapsulates Blue Velvet: "It's a strange world." A mechani-
cal bird eats a bug. The camera pans up to the blue sky, which becomes
the texture of blue velvet. The film has come full circle.
This dream called Blue Velvet has many dimensions. The power of love
and the light of love that comes out of the darkness is the overarching
theme. It lifts the ending above the netherworld doom inhabited by Frank
Booth and his malicious coterie. The lament of the title song repeats. This
has not been a dream. Blue Velvet is the reality within the reality of life—
and that is a true mystery.
Of Futher Interest
Screen
Eraserhead
Eyes Wide Shut
Meshes of the Afternoon
Mulholland Dr.
Twin Peaks (television series)
Read
David Lynch by Michel Chion
Blue Velvet by Charles Drazin
The Interpretation of Dreams by Sigmund Freud
The Complete Lynch by David Hughes, Jim Smith, and James Clarke
Memories, Dreams, Reflections by Carl Gustav Jung
The Passion of David Lynch: Wild at Heart in Hollywood by Martha P. Nochimson
B
The Period Film as Mirror for the
Present
When Bonnie and Clyde was released in 1967, it incited a dual controversy.
The film was graphically violent, bloody, and employed slow-motion
photography to further heighten the explicit damage done when crimi-
nals and cops shoot each other. What really inflamed critics and movie-
goers was Bonnie and Clyde's portrayal of the couple who led the Barrow
gang. As portrayed by Faye Dunaway and Warren Beatty, Bonnie and
Clyde were celebrities. The male antihero had been born over the course
of the decade as exemplified by Paul Newman in The Hustler and Hud,
but Bonnie and Clyde were superstars. As the ad copy for the film pro-
nounced, "They're young, they're in love, they kill people." Bonnie and
Clyde were sexy. They were heroes to the common folk—and they were
also cold-blooded killers. This was a love story for a new generation in a
country where the assassination of the young, vital president Kennedy
was the beginning of a long descent into a late twentieth-century national
nightmare.
In retrospect, Bonnie and Clyde marks a turning point in American film-
making. Throughout the 1960s the studio system was collapsing. Warner
Brothers, the studio best known for its gangster cycle in the 1930s and
1940s featuring James Cagney, Humphrey Bogart, and Edward G. Robin-
son, was in the process of being sold off when it distributed Bonnie and
Clyde. Mogul Jack Warner, distracted by the coming end of his reign, left
the film in the hands of producer Warren Beatty and director Arthur Perm.
54 • Becoming Film Literate
Warren Beatty and Faye Dunaway portray the infamous depression era bank
robbers Clyde Barrow and Bonnie Parker. The Arthur Penn film placed the
action in the story's authentic time period while making a socio-political
comment on a changing, rebellious, and ever-violent America in the late
1960s. Courtesy Photofest.
From Psycho (see chapter 34), which began the decade, through films
such as The Apartment, The Misfits, The Manchurian Candidate (see chapter
27), Dr. Strangelove, Seconds, Cool Hand Luke, and The Graduate, American
movies were breaking away from the aesthetic conventions that had gov-
erned them for decades. Their mission was not foremost to entertain, but
to reflect the social and political climate of their times. The audience de-
mographics had changed. Movies had largely been created for families
and mature adults to escape the drudgery of their everyday lives. By 1967
a new under-thirty generation demanded to be heard in every aspect of
American life—the movies would become a platform for that coming rev-
olution. Easy Rider, released two years later in 1969, is often credited as
the beginning of the American New Wave. When studied in the manner
of an archeologist carefully examining the contents of a dig from an an-
cient time, Bonnie and Clyde is a motion picture by which many serious
American movies can be understood. Bonnie and Clyde is the Rosetta Stone
of baby boomer cinema.
The Period Film as Mirror for the Present • 55
In art, context is everything. Bonnie and Clyde is based on the true story
of Clyde Barrow and Bonnie Parker, who were bank robbers during the
1930s. The intent of screenwriters Robert Benton and David Newman
(There Was A Crooked Man, What's Up Doc?, Superman), producer-star War-
ren Beatty, and director Arthur Penn was to make a film that mirrored
American life in 1967, not a depression-era gangster movie.
Bonnie and Clyde are antiestablishment figures. They despise the gov-
ernment, the financial establishment, and law enforcement—the mili-
tary-industrial complex of their time. Like hippies and many young
people of the 1960s, Bonnie and Clyde were rebels. They rebelled against
all bureaucracies. Bonnie and Clyde only trusted people of their own age.
Elders in power, like Sheriff Frank Hamer (Denver Pyle), were to be de-
fied, ridiculed, and brought down by a revolution that returned power to
the people. The banks were rich—the people were poor. Peace was not
the way. Only violent action could change the world. After the revolution
they could live their lives, but first Bonnie and Clyde had to destroy
everything that was wicked.
They began their revolution with brazen action, stating their demands
backed with the authority of the gun. Clyde is principled; he will attain
his goal through force of personality and ideals. When their driver C. W.
Moss (Michael J. Pollard) turns a getaway into a comedy of errors, Clyde
kills a man. Just as peaceful hippies became radical activists, Bonnie and
Clyde, like the Students for a Democratic Society (SDS) and the Weather
Underground, rediscover themselves through a violent act.
Bonnie and Clyde are dimensional characters. Psychological impulses
are on the surface and drive their ambitions and behavior. Clyde craves
respect and attention. He is a Robin Hood out to liberate the oppressed
masses. Clyde is sexually aroused by fame and the will to be known—he
thrives on notoriety. He is physically repulsed by intimacy with a woman
and announces that he is not a lover boy, but he is attracted to Bonnie be-
cause she is the other half of his legend. For Clyde, sexual energy is chan-
neled into his rebellion against authority. Release comes with the blasts
of his guns. In a central shootout between the gang and the law, Clyde
expresses his manhood firing two guns that blaze and thrust forward.
Bonnie is a small-town waitress. She is an ambitious woman, bursting
to spring from the monotony of her imprisoned life. Bonnie needs a cat-
alyst to liberate herself and to become the careerist she longs to be. Fate
intervenes as she trashes around her room, naked and emotionally
starved. Clyde Barrow is outside the window stealing a family car. Bon-
nie sees Clyde as a way out of small-town U.S.A. The thrill of crime
arouses her aggressive sexual impulses to a fever pitch. When she is phys-
56 • Becoming Film Literate
and Clyde, who were not married, Clyde's older brother Buck (Gene
Hackman), Buck's wife Blanche (Estelle Parsons), and the young C. W.
Moss, who was brought into the fold because he craved adventure and
was captivated with antiestablishment fervor. The brothers are close, ex-
plosive, and constantly physically engaged, like the Kennedy brothers
Jack, Bobby, and Ted playing football on the White House lawn. The
women are worlds apart. Blanche, who comes from a religious back-
ground, is incessantly shrieking with fear. Bonnie is tough and aggres-
sive; she sees Blanche as a liability. It has been suggested by many critics
that C. W. and Clyde share homoerotic feelings. The wayward boy cer-
tainly idolizes Clyde but is not strong enough to be his own man. This
family is as dysfunctional as the ones they left. Buck is irrational and
doomed to die young, and the same fate goes to the star-crossed lovers
Bonnie and Clyde. Blanche and C. W. both sell out the family by naming
names, she to the sheriff, he to his father.
Thematically, Bonnie and Clyde created a new paradigm for the Ameri-
can film. Stylistically, it broke away from traditional Hollywood conven-
tions by creating a visual style that would lead to a new aesthetic model
for young filmmakers. Director of photography Burnett Guffey (The
Harder They Fall, All the King's Men, Birdman of Alcatraz) was sixty-two
years old when Bonnie and Clyde was released. He had been working in
Hollywood since 1924, when he had contributed additional photography
to John Ford's silent film The Iron Horse. Over the years Arthur Penn has
commented on the difficulties he had in working with the seasoned pro,
whom he felt was slow and set in his ways. This may not have been an
ideal collaboration on a personal basis, but artistically Guffey imbued
Bonnie and Clyde with the perfect visual environment and atmosphere to
parallel what was taking place in America at the time. Social and politi-
cal change came first in the 1960s. When the youth revolution began, the
old world still existed. Guffey's photography echoes turn-of-the-century
and early twentieth-century American painters. There are references to
the art of Andrew Wyeth and the depression-era still photography of
Dorothea Lange, Walker Evans, Margaret Bourke-White, and Arthur
Rothstein. This lonely, crumbling America, with the etched faces of the
abandoned, was the ideal environment for Bonnie and Clyde, two young
kids who were out to change the world but were doomed from the start.
The contrast of these two forces of nature against a great nation in ruins
is poetic and daring. It places Bonnie and Clyde in their own time but as
two people who dared to be different like their hippie, yippie, pot-
smoking, war-protesting sixties counterparts.
Production designer Dean Tavoularis (The Godfather; Apocalypse Now;
58 • Becoming Film Literate
Tucker: The Man and His Dream) read the script and, as he said in an in-
terview in Production Design and Art Direction by Peter Hedgui, he im-
mediately conceptualized the story as one about "two renegades rebelling
against the world they lived in." He also proceeded in a realistic fashion
by recreating the era from architecture to details of peeling paint and the
elements of aging and time. When photographed by Guffey, the look of
Bonnie and Clyde attained a lyrical realism.
Instead of a dramatic underscore, Bonnie and Clyde features the au-
thentic bluegrass guitar and banjo music of Lester Flatt and Earl Scruggs.
Their "Foggy Mountain Breakdown" captured time and place while also
sonically supporting the manic energy of the rebellious couple in action.
The costumes by Theodora Van Runkle (The Godfather, Part II, New York,
New York, Peggy Sue Got Married) appear to be period accurate but are ex-
aggerated to create stars out of Bonnie and Clyde. Their clothing is a state-
ment against the norm at the time. While America rebelled against suits
and ties, and long puffy dresses, the fashion of Bonnie and Clyde started a
commercial trend of its own and was featured in department stores as the
film took hold across America.
The truly subversive aspect of Bonnie and Clyde is the audacious edit-
ing of Dede Allen (Slaughterhouse Five, Dog Day Afternoon, Henry and June).
Penn and Allen moved away from traditional scene structure to give
Bonnie and Clyde the frenetic energy of the inner life of the characters and
their living-for-the-moment lifestyle. Penn did not shoot conventional
coverage—master shot, two-shots, close-ups, and so forth—and Allen ed-
ited the film to capture two objectives: story and character. No entrances,
no exits (what Allen, in an interview for my book Selected Takes: Film Ed-
itors on Editing, called "gezuntis and gezatus"). Bonnie and Clyde is su-
percharged with what came to be known as the "energy cut"—where the
emotion and action is distilled to its very essence. The current editorial
term for this approach is called compression. For Dede Allen, editing is
not an intellectual exercise—she cuts to move a film forward and breaks
many rules about matching action by creating continuity out of the soul
of each moment in a film. Instead of fading a scene out and then fading
the next scene in, Allen either cuts to black and then fades the next scene
in, or fades out to black and then cuts to the next scene. Penn's direction
to Allen was to propel the film as driven by the lives of Bonnie and Clyde.
Allen went through the film repeatedly, accelerating the pace each time.
As stated in Selected Takes, during this process she broke what she con-
sidered to be "her own rigid cutting rules about story, character, and how
a scene plays." The result was an innovation in feature film editing.
Bonnie and Clyde established that the American film could reflect the
The Period Film as Mirror for the Present • 59
Of Further Interest
Screen
Badlands
Natural Born Killers
Thelma & Louise
They Live by Night
Thieves Like Us
Read
The Sexiest Man Alive: A Biography of Warren Beatty by Ellis Amburn
Medium Cool: The Movies of the 1960s by Ethan Mordden
The Strange History of Bonnie and Clyde by John E. Treherne
The Bonnie and Clyde Book, compiled and edited by Sandra Wake and Nicola
Hayden
Arthur Penn by Robin Wood
IB
Expressionism in Cinema
Few films throughout motion picture history have had more influence on
the avant-garde, art, and student cinema than did the German silent film
The Cabinet of Dr. Caligari, directed by Robert Wiene (1880-1938) and first
shown in 1919. This seventy-five-minute black-and-white film is a primer
of expressive cinema and remains a source of fascination concerning the
abstract, emotional, and psychological possibilities of the medium.
The Cabinet of Dr. Caligari is an archetypical example of German ex-
pressionism, a film movement that evolved from the expressionist art
movement in painting. Expressionism grew out of the use of a vivid non-
naturalistic color palette that characterized the Fauvism movement. 1 Ex-
pressionism was more openly neurotic and morbid in its approach to
subject and theme. The French practiced expressionism, but the German
expressionist movement lasted longer and was a dominant art form from
around 1905 to 1930. The Germans were more spontaneous and reached
daring degrees of emotional extremes.
In expressionism traditional notions of realism are tossed aside for the
exploration of distortion and exaggeration in shape and form, as opposed
to figurative representation. Expressionism is abstract in nature, gro-
tesque in its depiction of social and political power, and urgent in its au-
thority to express the fervent emotions experienced by the artist.
German Expressionism began before World War I when a group of bo-
hemian artists who all shared a sense of imminent disaster formed Die
Briike (The Bridge) in Munich. Led by Ludwig Kirchner, they were in-
Expressionism in Cinema • 61
Hand painted sets, distorted perspective, and a highly stylized acting style
are the principal components of cinematic expressionism in The Cabinet of Dr.
Caligari. Courtesy Photofest.
that announce the beginning and end of each act. A scene in which two
men sit on a bench anchors the nightmarish narrative. As a woman in a
trance glides by, the younger man tells his companion that she is his fi-
ancee. As he talks about the strange events that have occurred, the story
shifts to a flashback.
A diabolical looking man sporting a black stovepipe hat and black
rimmed spectacles (Werner Krauss) exhibits Cesare the Somnambulist
(Conrad Veidt) at a fair. The twenty-three-year-old gaunt man dressed in
black has been in a dream state for his entire life. Brutal knife murders
begin to occur. It is learned that this evil and cunning man is the direc-
tor of a mental institution. After gaining access to his library research, it
is revealed he has studied the history of Dr. Caligari, who had a som-
nambulist under his spell who was ordered to commit murder. As the
men are in the director's office and read this information in a book, the
scene is still a flashback being told by the man on the bench from the
opening scene. From investigation of the book there is another flashback
showing how the man known as the director became Dr. Caligari and
placed Cesare under his control. This sequence is a flashback within a
flashback, a narrative device used by Stanley Kubrick in Killer's Kiss and
by Oliver Stone in JFK. In The Cabinet of Dr. Caligari, the tiers of story-
telling from present to flashback to a second generation of flashback
plunge the viewer into a deeper nightmare level of time and space.
After a return to the recognition of the director's evil plan, the missing
Cesare is found, and the director, now Caligari, is straightjacketed and
shut in a cell. The story then returns to present day. Cesare is still alive
and sleepwalking. Jane (Lil Dagover), the young man's fiancee, is also in
a trance. The director appears, the lover is held down, screaming that he
is not crazy and that the director is Caligari. The man is put in a straight-
jacket. The director dons his glasses and is again Caligari, who states the
man is delusional for thinking that he is the mystical Caligari. The film
ends with Caligari's proclamation that he knows how to cure the man.
The narrative logic of The Cabinet of Dr. Caligari is distorted as if it were
a nightmare. It can be seen as a parable portraying a world in which evil
is a constant presence winning over the struggle for rationality. The ex-
pressionist style is prevalent throughout The Cabinet of Dr. Caligari, in-
cluding the opening scene. If the story were just a nightmare, there would
be a stylistic separation between scenes of the real world and the dream
world, and the narrative would be resolved when the sleeper awoke.
Weine, like the German expressionist painters, was reflecting his emo-
tional reaction to the world around him, which draws the viewer into a
trance state from which there is no awakening through the duration of
Expressionism in Cinema • 63
the film. In many ways The Cabinet of Dr. Caligari is a horror film with the
mad scientist figure, a monster, murder, and an atmosphere of relentless
fear. A social or political read of the film reveals an analogy to the moral
and physical breakdown of Germany at the time, with a madman on the
loose reeking havoc on a distorted and off-balanced society, a metaphor
for a country in chaos.
The direct link to the German expressionist art movement is evident in
the sets by Walter Reinmann (Algol, Adventures of a Ten Mark Note, Eter-
nal Love), Walter Rohrig (The Last Laugh, Faust, Rembrandt), and Hermann
Warm (The Phantom, The Passion of Joan of Arc, The Runaway Princess), and
are largely painted in that style. The Cabinet of Dr. Caligari was designed
in a series of tableaus, including the fair outside town, streets, the direc-
tor /Caligari's office, a police station, and interiors where the characters
reside. With the exception of a prop or key element of furniture, which
are also expressionistic in nature, these scenes are painted onto backdrops
and architectural elements are defined by studio constructions.
The painted backdrop was prominent in international art direction in
early cinema. Hollywood continued the practice for decades. In The Cab-
inet of Dr. Caligari, the production designers moved beyond traditional
use. These are not primarily backgrounds but total environments. The tra-
ditional background painting was either rendered in a realistic or im-
pressionist style within the confines of figurative reality. Reinmann,
Rohrig, and Warm created an environment that was physically distorted
in perspective, form, dimension, scale, and representation. The images de-
picting locations of, and within, the town are presented in straight,
curved, and angled strokes of bold, black paint. Gray and white are em-
ployed not to create the illusion of a color palette but to envision confined
and hard-edged dimensions and shadows. Light and shadow, tradition-
ally applied by the chiaroscuro of the cinematographer's art of lighting,
is achieved by the art of the brush and paint. The lines create a vortex of
danger. The inner logic of the design is not related to realism but is an
emotional response to the terror Caligari and Cesare represent to this so-
ciety. There are numbers written onto walls implying a metaphysical com-
munication and sharp angles that defy architectural purity and order.
This extreme visualization immediately comes to life as the film opens.
As a totality, The Cabinet of Dr. Caligari is a complete world realized in a
manner that unifies theme, plot, characterization, production design, and
cinematography. The plot is a story of malevolent deceit in which a mad-
man achieves the power to control another to commit murder. The themes
concern the spiritual and moral tampering with man's will. The sleep-
walking Cesare can be seen as a metaphor for those without a mind of
64 • Becoming Film Literate
their own and follow the path of others. The psychology of the film ex-
amines the potential evil powers of the mind, the nature of sanity, and
the thin-line relationship between stability and chaos. Wiene and his de-
signers understood that realistic locations and conventional design con-
cepts could never visually express the living, paranoid, nightmare world
of the narrative.
Every element in the film addresses these issues. The costumes are stark
and are as distorted as the environment in silhouette and contour, and in
their relationship to the body. The makeup design is highly exaggerated,
garish, and grotesque. Hair is essential as a design element, especially Ce-
sare's jet-black, spiky, jagged locks. The Cabinet of Dr. Caligari is about the
unreality of reality in tumultuous times. It is grounded by the engrossing
story. The viewer yearns to know the story of the man on the bench. As
it unfolds, the plot envelops the viewer and the expressionist sets come
to life to create the environment of the film.
The acting style is as emotionally over the top as the narrative and vi-
sual style of The Cabinet of Dr. Caligari. The behavior of the characters rep-
resents the actors' emotional responses to the expressionistic environment
and the situations in which they find themselves. Staging and movement
of the actors responds to the hysteria of Caligari's machinations and to
the fun-house labyrinth that appears to be the reflection of a crazy mir-
ror, not an orderly village. The characters exist in and respond to the
twisted streets, rooms with radically offset windows, doors that are not
squared, and chairs that are too tall. Buildings are clustered and inter-
connected by a cubist take on architecture in the city where they reside,
which has been transformed by evil.
From a directorial standpoint, The Cabinet of Dr. Caligari is more the-
atrical than cinematic. There is very little interscene editing. With little
exception one scene follows another without intercutting. A sequence
such as the fair is accomplished in two shots. One is a painted set of the
street fair and the city in the background. Then a cut to another angle,
deep into the fair, reveals Caligari standing in front of a painted tent that
displays Cesare. There are some close-ups and isolation shots within a
scene, but by and large everything is photographed from a straight-on
angle. So the result is like watching a play on a proscenium stage. Cam-
era angles were not employed to change the perspective, move the story
editorially, or simulate verisimilitude. All of the temporal dynamics are
designed and painted onto and into the set.
By extrapolating from painting and theater, The Cabinet of Dr. Caligari
brought a pure form of art to the cinema. Robert Wiene's avant-garde ex-
periment became more than a social-political statement or a genre trend.
Expressionism in Cinema • 65
Notes
1. Fauvism was a European avant-garde painting style developed from the turn
of the twentieth century until World War I. It is characterized by an arbitrary use
of vivid, non-naturalistic colors utilized for an emotional and decorous impact.
The most significant artist of the Fauvist school was Henri Matisse, who em-
ployed vivid contrasting colors from 1899 and broke away the traditional de-
scriptive use of color in 1904. Fauvism was influenced by neoimpressionism and
inspired the creation of German Expressionism.
2. Max Reinhardt was an innovative German theater director known for his
bold use of scenic design, lighting, and visual effects. He became a sensation in
1905 with an imaginative staging of Shakespeare's A Midsummer Night's Dream.
Reinhart was one of the prime architects of the German expressionist style in the-
ater and film. During the 1920s and early 1930s, he trained many great German
directors and actors, including F. W. Murnau, Paul Leni, Ernst Lubitsch, William
Dieterle, Otto Preminger, Conrad Veidt, Emil Jannings, Louise Rainer, and Mar-
lene Dietrich. Max Reinhardt immigrated to the United States in 1933 and is con-
sidered to be a major influence on twentieth-century drama for his contributions,
which expanded the creative influence of the director.
Of Further Interest
Screen
Dr. Mabuse the Gambler
The Golem
The Hands of Orlac
Nosferatu
Waxworks
Read
Expressionism by Wolf Dieter Dube
Haunted Screen: German Expressionism in the German Cinema by Lotte Eisner
66 • Becoming Film Literate
Casablanca
Left to right: Humphrey Bogart (Rick), Claude Rains (Captain Louis Renault),
Paul Henreid (Victor Laszlo), and Ingrid Bergman (Ilsa) in the quintessential
Hollywood Studio movie, Casablanca. Every shot of the film follows the con-
ventions of the invisible continuity system created and largely sustained by
the major Hollywood studios. Courtesy Photofest.
tory of how the studios created their productions, and it emphasizes the
system itself rather than film directors. Film thought had been dominated
by the auteurists (see auteur theory in glossary) from the Cahiers du
Cinema group that became the French New Wave and their American
cousin Andrew Sarris, whose landmark work The American Cinema: Di-
rectors and Directions 1929-1968 prevailed for years with its notion that the
director was the author of a film. Bordwell, Staiger, Thompson, and
Schatz finally broke that romantic myth. The Hollywood studio film was
manufactured and governed by a system that was bigger than any indi-
vidual, however extraordinary many directors from the era were. The
studio system operated from a strict paradigm to manufacture the cin-
ema product. Cereal, soup, and other consumer products are produced
Classical Hollywood Film Style • 69
montage, forged by Slavko Vorkapich (montages for The Good Earth, Mr.
Smith Goes to Washington), Robert Florey (The Life and Death of 9413—A
Hollywood Extra, Sky Scraper Symphony), and Siegel's work in the Warner
Brothers' montage department, helped to create and adapt the highly po-
litical aesthetic of Russian cinema to quickly cover the passage of time of
a specific event in Hollywood entertainment. Here, immigrants flee their
countries as the Nazi machine expands its domination. Superimposed
(see superimposition in glossary) over an animated map, their journey is
traced to Casablanca, as newsreel shots of the masses leaving home in
search of freedom unfold. The montage ends with a wide shot of
Casablanca. An art-directed building and sky are in the background as
the camera pans down to reveal a teeming street of vendors and people
from all walks of life. The packed narrow street is designed to look make-
believe—the way it is imagined by someone who will never actually go
there. Everything in the full frame was put there by the system: costumes,
props, architecture, hair, and makeup. The exotic is made palatable for
entertainment.
Atmosphere and plot work hand in hand. A French officer gives orders
over a phone establishing Casablanca as a place swarming with under-
ground figures arranging illegal transport out of the country. This is trans-
mitted in a single shot followed by a quick-cut action sequence of
suspects—a term that gets repeated with variation throughout the film—
being rounded up. It ends with a resistance member shot and captured.
As he is brought into headquarters, the dramatic music reprises "La Mar-
seillaise."
Gunplay in Casablanca is bloodless. People are shot in the tradition of
the American Western—there is a loud gunshot and a body responds that
it has been hit, but the pain and gravity of gun violence is romanticized.
Casablanca is filled with a large cast of character actors, extras, and spe-
cific types. A stodgy, rich couple are pickpocketed by a petty thief who
lifts the man's wallet while providing more exposition about what the
Nazis are doing in cahoots with French officials. Extras are dressed as var-
ious character types from many countries. They play their emotions
broadly to communicate that they are desperate to flee the country.
Rick's Cafe Americain is first established when a plane flies above it
and then lands. The crowd in the street watches the plane with anxiety.
What is a piece of action also sets up the main location of the film. At the
airport there is a huge stone archway that looks like a cutout of the Taj
Mahal dome. This motif is used throughout Casablanca to establish the ex-
otic locale to American audiences.
Classical Hollywood Film Style • 71
Captain Louis Renault (Claude Rains) escorts Nazi chief Major Hein-
rich Strasser (Conrad Veidt) from the airport. As the contingent marches
forward, the scene is structured in several shots to keep it moving edito-
rially. In a European film, this would be one continuous shot as they walk
and discuss ridding Casablanca of infiltrators.
Characters are defined by their actions. Throughout the film, Renault
is a bad good guy; he is on whatever side the wind blows and like many
Hollywood characters he has a tough exterior, a glib mouth, and a good
heart. Rick (Humphrey Bogart) appears to be a hard-bitten tough guy but
later rescues a young couple and secures their passage to America. Re-
nault tells him he's an old sentimentalist. There is even one two-shot that
includes good and bad by framing Ilsa (Ingrid Bergman) on one side and
Major Strasser (Conrad Veidt) on the other.
Ingrid Bergman is the source of romance and lost love in Casablanca.
Her beauty is captivating and is further enhanced by delicate glamour
lighting that highlights her hair and eyes. There is a softness to her close-
ups that allows the audience to fall in love with her.
The nightclub is a staple of studio musicals, comedies, dramas, and
crime films. It is always a place for fun, frivolity, shady business, sexual
escapes, and a means of transporting the average Joe and Jane from their
humdrum nine-to-five existence to the nightlife. In Casablanca Rick's place
is all that and is also the hub of intrigue, the meeting place to escape the
Nazis. It is filled with colorful characters, heartbreak, the law, the occu-
pying presence, and above all, it is the platform for one of cinema's great-
est love stories.
There is a backroom in the club. Hollywood loved the allure of the se-
cret gambling palace; only those who dare can be admitted—those who
live by the night and are willing to risk everything. The door is guarded
at all times and only Rick allows passage, another one of Casablanca's
metaphors for escape to paradise.
Sam (Dooley Wilson) is an African American entertainer who sings
popular songs and accompanies himself on the piano. Music intercut (see
intercutting in glossary) to entertain and as a background to the devel-
oping story is a tried-and-true Hollywood convention. As Sam performs,
distinct character types at various tables make deals for phony visas. The
character actors were well known to audiences by face, and by name to
film buffs. The ethnic stereotypes, Sacha (Leonid Kinskey), a Russian bar-
tender, and Carl (S. Z. Sakall), a German waiter, were easily identifiable
to the public. And because these stock characters were under contract,
they often played the same or similar parts from film to film.
72 • Becoming Film Literate
really happened at the train station, they both confront the past and pres-
ent. They kiss and then there is a cut to the Nazi beacon seeking out and
hunting down all traitors.
When two people engage in a conversation, it is covered by the cam-
era in a shot-reverse shot. This can be done in single shots of each char-
acter or in a form of two-shot called the over-the-shoulder shot, in which
the back of the other character is off to the appropriate side when we see
the person speaking or reacting. Other angles are employed to keep the
flow moving, but the shot-reverse shot principle was the reigning rule
for dialogue scenes throughout the studio era. This technique removed
the presence of the camera for the audience and implied a total cinematic
space where the two characters were actually standing in front of each
other.
The studios wanted their movies to be entertainment, so while the plot
and subplots are developing, there are moments of comedy. While the
camera is following one line of action, it stops to eavesdrop on a comic
exchange between a French and a Italian officer. The relationship between
Rick and Captain Louis Renault (Claude Rains) is layered with quips that
reveal the cynicism of these two men who deep down are very loyal to
the cause against the Nazis. For an especially good line there will be a cut
to a close-up to highlight the moment.
Before we ever meet Victor Laszlo (Paul Henreid), the famed resistance
hero, and his wife, Ilsa Lund, the mysterious beauty who was once going
to give her heart to Rick, we have a vivid word picture of them as sev-
eral characters speak about them. When they finally make their entrance
into Rick's, it is a moment of high drama. A series of close-ups of key
characters link their reactions to the appearance of these legends.
The screen writing technique of backstory, in which we learn what has
happened before the film started, was a popular narrative device during
the studio era. Renault tells Rick he knows his past life as a brave resist-
ance fighter. By telling Rick about himself, Rick understands that Renault
knows he isn't just a callous nightclub owner who takes advantage of oth-
ers and uses his place for deals. The viewer is also let in on information
not known to everyone. A selected few know when a resistance member
is about to be arrested by the Nazis. We hear privileged conversations
that give the audience superiority over the majority of those in the club,
who are shocked when the arrest occurs minutes after we know it is about
to take place.
During the war years, the studios presented a strong antifascist phi-
losophy in their films. Although Casablanca is primarily a romantic en-
74 • Becoming Film Literate
Night brings despair. Rick sits alone in the club, drinking himself into
submission. The surveillance beam from across the street pierces the dark-
ness. Sam tries to lighten his boss's mood, but only enduring the pain of
the song will do. A flashback ensues. We see the happy lovers and learn
the backstory of their romance. Life in Paris is depicted with sharper im-
ages; the song, now an instrumental theme, plays; newsreel footage of the
occupation brings stark reality. We learn how "As Time Goes By" became
their song. At a Paris club the two lovers plan to meet and take a train to
freedom; Sam is at the piano and plays the tune. When they kiss, the
sound of German guns explode. As they embrace they knock over a glass
of champagne, a visual symbol for what is to come. It is raining at the
train station, another tried-and-true convention for Hollywood drama.
Rick waits but Ilsa doesn't arrive. A letter from her is read. The insert
shows her handwritten apology in pen. The rain makes the ink run. To
the audience this is a representation of Ilsa's tears. A fade to black ends
the scene and the pain of Rick's memory of desertion.
The famous last scene takes place at the airport. It is night and there is
a dense fog, giving the illusion that we are seeing more than is really
there. Rick becomes the hero and gives up the girl so that she can go on
to America with her husband, a true hero. In turn, for the first time Rick
becomes whole, also a true hero. He is welcomed back to the fight by the
tricky Renault. What will happen to these men? A Nazi officer was mur-
dered. Somehow they will both survive. It is the beginning of a beautiful
friendship, a metaphor so rich with meaning it could only be in a film
made by the Hollywood dream factory, in which a film reinvents itself in
meaning to each passing generation and with each viewing, as time goes
by.
Of Further Interest
Screen
Bringing Up Baby
Dinner at Eight
The Maltese Falcon
Stagecoach (1939)
Yankee Doodle Dandy
Read
The Classical Hollywood Cinema: Film Style & Mode of Production to 1960 by David
Bordwell, Janet Staiger, and Kristin Thompson
76 • Becoming Film Literate
The Making of Casablanca: Bogart, Bergman, and World War II by Aljean Harmetz
The Casablanca Companion: The Movie Classic and Its Place in History by Richard E.
Osborne
The Casablanca Man: The Cinema of Michael Curtiz by James C. Robinson
The Genius of the System: Hollywood Filmmaking in the Studio Era by Thomas
Schatz
IB
Surrealism in Cinema
Un Chien Andalou
Since the birth of cinema, one form or another of dramatic realism has
dominated the content of motion pictures. The traditional principle of vi-
sual storytelling is a narrative that unfolds one shot at a time, relating one
image to the next in a manner that is considered logical to the audience.
Un Chien Andalou (An Andalusian Dog), a sixteen-minute black and
white film created in 1928 by Salvador Dali and Luis Bufiuel, struck out
in a daring, different direction. 1 Dali and Bufiuel were deeply involved in
the surrealist movement and applied the tenets practiced by painters and
writers to Un Chien Andalou. Their intention was to shock the audience.
They designed a series of images out of their dreams and fantasies that
had no specific or cogent meaning to them or to the viewer.
Artists and adventurous cinema-goers were astounded by the
medium's ability to adapt to a non-narrative form. Dali and Bunuel in-
terrelated movement to surrealist imagery and experimented with shot-
by-shot relationships as well as with scene-by-scene connections that
were elusive but, upon multiple viewing, appeared to have an internal,
antirepresentational logic.
The images, action, and behavior that comprise Un Chien Andalou were
developed during a three-day discussion between Dali and Bunuel. The
film has recurring images: live ants crawling on the palm of a human
hand, graphic black-and-white stripes, and religious garb. Sexual im-
pulses, the repression of religion, the symbolic transference of people and
objects through an action, and the viewer as an active witness to the rap-
78 • Becoming Film Literate
Arguably the most disturbing moment in cinema history. A man slices open
the eye of a woman in the Luis Bunuel/Salvador Dali surrealist classic, Un
Chien Andalou. Courtesy Photofest.
idly unfolding events are themes that form the structure of Un Chien An-
dalou. No single image in the film is totally abstract in nature. Each shot
contains a recognizable object, human action, place, or thing. Most nar-
ratives concern tangible ideas. A traditional narrative presents visual im-
ages that illustrate and relate to the content of the text. The quantitative
result is a plot that can be discerned by the audience. The intent of the
filmmaker has a clear and specific purpose. Plot becomes the means to
follow and understand a story. The surrealists had an entirely different
agenda. The images in a surrealist painting are identifiable but the con-
text is in opposition to reality.
Luis Bunuel is the first character in Un Chien Andalou. He sharpens a
straight razor, an ordinary act in itself. It is night, identified by the image
of a full moon and a linear-shaped cloud to the right. During these first
Surrealism in Cinema • 79
quence of shots creates this illusion. They are both transfixed on the ants.
He looks to her briefly, then back to the stark and shocking image. There
is a dissolve to a man's underarm, then a tight shot of a furry texture,
then a transition to a man probing a detached hand in the street with a
stick. This turns out to be an iris shot, and the black area widens to re-
veal a crowd around him. As a policeman clears the crowd, we realize it
is an androgynous-looking woman poking the hand. This theme of what
you see is not what you see is the key to Bunuel's strategy. Bunuel's mise-
en-scene follows the pattern of presenting a recognizable image and then
revealing that the context is not what the viewer believed it was. This is
a hallmark of the surrealist approach. After several dramatic low-angle
shots of the crowd looking down at the hand, there is a shot of the woman
and the man at the terrace windows looking down. Bunuel follows tra-
ditional principles of eye-line match and screen direction. His interscene
editing appears to follow Hollywood rules, but the order of shots disori-
ent the viewer and there is little conventional logic in actions and the se-
quence of events. A police officer picks up the striped bag and gives it to
the woman as the two look on from above. In a high-angle point of view,
the policeman clears the crowd and only the woman remains. Logically
there would be a cut to the window to connect the point of view with the
character whose view was shown, but Bunuel cuts to another angle of the
woman in the street and then to the man staring down. The woman
clutches the bag as if it has import to her. Cars speed by her. The man
witnesses her being run down by a car; she is left in the street with the
bag next to her. The sequence is created in detail with points of view of
the rushing car, the woman's face in fear, and the reaction of the witness
in the window. A small crowd begins to form around her.
Inside the apartment the man and woman react. Suddenly, the man be-
comes sexually aroused and stalks her around the room as a tango plays
on the soundtrack. They move up and down against a wall. He grabs her
breasts and fondles them. She fights him off and then submits. His hands
on her clothed breasts dissolve to his hands fondling her naked breasts.
A low-angle close-up shows him in a hyperecstatic state and a bloody
drool leaks out of his mouth. As he continues to fondle her naked breasts,
they dissolve into her naked buttocks. She finally gets away from him
and they chase through the room, which is crowded with furniture struc-
tured by box shapes. She threatens him with an axe. After a sequence of
intercutting their reactions, two ropes hauling two grand pianos with a
dead animal head on top of them weigh him down. Two priests attached
to the ropes are also part of this burden. The man pulls this bizarre rig to
get closer to the woman, who can be seen in the corner of the room. This
Surrealism in Cinema • 81
reveals another man standing on a beach. She runs from the hall shot into
the beach shot. He shows her his watch. They kiss and walk off down the
beach in what seems to be a classic Hollywood happy-ending shot, but
the camera then picks them up from a reverse angle as they continue to
walk as lovers. They find the articles of clothing from the early n u n / m a n
scenes. They kiss and walk off again as if now this will be the happy-
ending shot. A black card appears that reads "In Spring." The final shot
of Un Chien Andalou reveals the man and woman lifeless, buried to their
waists in sand.
It would be all too simple to impose meaning on the symbols and re-
curring themes of Un Chien Andalou. The filmmakers present death and
reincarnation, or reappearance, as an ongoing theme. Gender bending is
represented by the man dressed as a nun, the man who is revealed to be
a woman, and the transference of the woman's underarm hair to the
man's beard. The crowds who gather after each occurrence indicate a fas-
cination with accidents and death. Un Chien Andalou also breaks down
environmental boundaries. Transitions are eliminated so the characters
can be outside and then inside within a cut. The communication between
shot-reverse shot is devoid of traditional logic. Bunuel restructures this
cinematic principle to refashion reality. Viewers expect one shot to lead
to a next, but their sense of logic is controlled by the surrealist code to
defy rational explanations.
Un Chien Andalou is a landmark of alternate cinema. Dreams and fan-
tasies become the content. It was the beginning of Bunuel's long and bril-
liant career. With Surrealism as his method, the director savaged sexual
mores, organized religion, and social codes. Un Chien Andalou has been
inspiring film students since the 1960s. What Dali and Bunuel achieved
is reflected in the careers of David Lynch, Tim Burton, and David Cro-
nenberg. Un Chien Andalou is more than just a provocative film short to
be programmed before the main event. It is a significant work of art, per-
fect in the shadow world it creates and magical in its use of cinematic
grammar, which was never quite the same after its appearance.
Notes
1. Salvador Dali (1904-1989) was a Spanish painter whose flamboyant personal
style and gift for self-promotion made him the most famous and recognized artist
in the surrealist movement. His work employed a meticulous classical technique
to create images in a dreamlike, hallucinatory manner. Among his most celebrated
works are sexual subjects featuring his muse—his wife Gala. After collaborating
Surrealism in Cinema • 83
with Bunuel on Un Chien Andalou, the two men created L'Age d'or (1930). Dali also
contributed a dream sequence to the Alfred Hitchcock production of Spellbound.
Of Further Interest
Screen
L'Age d'or
Ballet mecanique
The Blood of a Poet
Brazil
Wild at Heart
Read
Luis Bunuel: A Critical Biography by Francisco Aranda
What is Surrealism? by Andre Breton
My Last Sigh: The Autobiography of Luis Bunuel by Luis Bunuel
An Unspeakable Betrayal: Selected Writings of Luis Bunuel by Luis Bunuel
Dada and Surrealist Film by Rudolf E. Kuenzli
IB
The Authorial Voice
Citizen Kane
Citizen Kane (1941) might just be the great American movie of the twen-
tieth century. This ambitious and innovative allegory, directed by Orson
Welles (1915-1985) when he was only twenty-six years old, forged a bold,
new cinematic language to atomize the life of Charles Foster Kane, a man
who had, and then lost, everything because he could only offer or receive
love on his own terms.
Citizen Kane opens with the final moments in the life of Charles Foster
Kane (Orson Welles) and provides a clue to the mystery of why his flam-
boyant and extravagant life ended in loneliness. Through a series of dis-
solves the camera climbs up a number of fences that seclude a castlelike
mansion set back on a lofty hill. As images of the massive estate slowly
continue to fade in and fade out of one another, a private zoo, canal,
bridge, and golf course are revealed. In the night fog, one gothic window
is illuminated. The changing views get ever closer; then suddenly the
light is extinguished. Now inside a bedroom, snowflakes pass through
the air, a glass globe depicting a winter home setting is dropped out of a
dying hand. The man's lips fill the screen as he utters his final words—
"Rosebud."
"News on the March," a self-contained sequence, meticulously follows
the form and style of a "March of Time" newsreel segment. 1 The movie
news obituary of Charles Foster Kane traces the creation and grandeur of
his Xanadu manor, the global impact of his passing, his rise as a news-
paper tycoon, the empire he built, the origin of his fortune and political
The Authorial Voice • 85
sway, his personal and private life, a failed run for governor, the decline
during the Great Depression, old age, and, finally, isolation without inti-
macy. A resonant announcer narrates (see narration in glossary) with
flowery prose, fashioning Kane as larger than life. Shots are quickly
wiped off (see wipe in glossary), replaced by the next. The dissolve, iris
(see iris shot in glossary), fade-in and out of black transitions—all struc-
ture and maintain the sequence at a brisk pace. Title cards and animated
maps display information, multiplying the scope of Kane's influence.
Footage is over- and underexposed and scratched to achieve archival au-
thenticity.
The sound of the closing musical fanfare grinds to a halt. A group of
media men in a private screening room have been watching an incom-
plete version of an enigmatic life. Bright beams of light stream in from
the projection room portals and paint the men in degrees of shadow and
86 • Becoming Film Literate
silhouette. The boss wants to know what made Kane tick. Their voices
blare and overlap in the confined space. He assigns Thompson (William
Alland), one of his reporters, to learn the significance of Kane's last words.
The inquiry begins at a nightclub owned by Susan Alexander (Dorothy
Comingore), the second Mrs. Kane. During a lightning storm, the camera
travels over a roof, then looks down through a rain-drenched skylight at
the inebriated and despondent young woman. She refuses to talk to
Thompson, who throughout the film is photographically and metaphor-
ically in the dark about the key to Kane's psyche.
The memorial library of Kane's guardian, Walter P. Thatcher (George
Coulouris), features large vaulting chambers emphasized by cinematog-
rapher Gregg Toland's (Wuthering Heights [1939], The Grapes of Wrath, The
Long Voyage Home) masterly use of deep-focus photography.2 This tech-
nique is applied all through Citizen Kane to sharply situate Kane and his
minions in relationship to his grand environment. After the stern cura-
tor's voice booms through the air, Thompson reads Thatcher's diary, as
a heavenly shaft of light illuminates the pages. As the lens dances across
Thatcher's prose remembrance of when he first met Kane as a boy, there
is a dissolve to Charles playing with his sled in the snow in 1871.
The scene in which Thatcher arrives at Mrs. Kane's boarding house in
Colorado is choreographed in three distinctive takes. Charles continues
to frolic in the snow. The camera pulls back to reveal the mother (Agnes
Moorehead), and Thatcher arguing with the father (Harry Shannon)
about sending the boy off for a better life now that Mrs. Kane has inher-
ited a large fortune. After signing the papers at the opposite end of the
room, the camera follows her back to the window, which she opens. There
is a cut to Mrs. Kane's face as she looks out at her son. As the adults leave
the building to explain the situation to the boy, the camera glides back as
they talk out in the snow. Charles takes an immediate dislike to Thatcher.
He is disobedient, knocking him to the ground with his sleigh. The father
swings at the boy to administer corporeal punishment, but the child is
protected by his mother. The final shot pans down from a close-up of Mrs.
Kane to the defiant child. She has justified her decision.
During a succession of short one-take scenes from Thatcher's perspec-
tive, Charles grows up and rejects his blue chip holdings to run a muck-
raking newspaper that attacks the now exguardian's interests. Thatcher's
power over Charles is exaggerated by first an extreme low, then later a
high angle. In a closing long take, the adult Kane stands to rise over
Thatcher, signifying an exchange of authority.
The Thatcher memories end in 1929. From a fixed, deep-focus camera
The Authorial Voice • 87
angle, Kane is told that his newspaper company is bust due to the stock
market crash. As they are positioned on opposite sides of the frame,
Charles tells the old man that he always wanted to be everything the
banker hated.
Next Thompson visits Mr. Bernstein (Everett Sloan), Kane's loyal gen-
eral manager, who sits behind his desk in a high-back chair. On the wall
a large portrait of Kane hangs above a blazing fireplace. Memory and re-
flection are significant themes in Citizen Kane. The camera pushes in on
Bernstein as he recalls seeing a girl in a white dress carrying a white para-
sol back in 1896, a memory that has never left his mind. As he takes him-
self back in time, his face is reflected in the shiny top of his desk.
Bernstein tells Thompson about the early days at the Inquirer. This
flashback covers how Kane took over as publisher and turned the staid
office into the nexus of expose journalism. Perry Ferguson's (The Best Years
of Our Lives, The Stranger [1946], The Secret Life of Walter Mitty) art direc-
tion for this set included a full ceiling that added to the verisimilitude
while providing another dimension of spatial delineation. As the first
issue is put to bed, Kane swears to "A Declaration of Principles," which
he personally signs for the front page, proclaiming his commitment to
stand up against all special interests for the right of every decent citizen
to read an honest newspaper.
The growth of the Inquirer is visualized by a shot of Kane admiring a
framed group photograph of the world's greatest newspaper staff, who
work for his competition the Examiner. The camera pushes in tight until
only the men can be seen. Kane then walks past them. It is now six years
later and they work for the Inquirer. A new portrait is snapped, the men
come to life, and a celebration begins.
The reporter interviews Jedediah Leland (Joseph Cotten), a former old
friend and associate of Kane now living in a hospital. His first flashback
depicts the dissolution of Kane's marriage to Emily Monroe Norton (Ruth
Warrick), the niece of the president of the United States. In just six brief
vignettes at the breakfast table, they progress from newlywed lovebirds
to two people who no longer speak to each other. They begin seated close
together, but by the last installment they are on opposite ends of the long
table. Their talk concerns Charles spending too much time at the Inquirer
and his political attacks on Emily's uncle. At first nothing comes between
them, but with each change of scene, flowers, table settings, and finally
the newspaper itself block off communication as both read silently—he
the Inquirer, she the Chronicle.
The film returns back to the hospital, and Leland introduces the flash-
88 • Becoming Film Literate
back of how Kane met Susan Alexander through her throbbing toothache.
After he literally charms the pain out of existence, Kane is captured by
her vocal serenade.
Kane runs for governor against party boss Jim Gettys (Ray Collins).
During a political rally, Kane gives a fiery oratory against his opponent
as he stands at a podium in a giant hall filled with people. Behind him is
a massive poster portrait with KANE written on top. The dynamic pro-
portionality and thunderous properties of his voice reverberating in the
space demonstrate Kane's limitless ambition, which is shattered by a
scandal that finishes his marriage and gubernatorial desires.
Kane marries Susan, builds an opera house, and puts all of his energy
into making her a singing star. The first of two versions of her debut is
shown from the front, looking at her on stage. As she croons weakly, the
view rises straight up above the stage, her sour voice gradually evapo-
rating. We travel high into the rafters where two stagehands watch and
listen in disdain. Silently one turns to the other and holds his nose to in-
dicate his opinion—she stinks. 3
Leland, now the drama critic of the Chicago office, has fallen asleep
over his typewriter, where he has begun to write a devastatingly bad no-
tice of Susan's performance. Charles and Leland have not spoken in years.
To prove his integrity, Kane finishes the review as Leland intended, sig-
nified by a micro-close-up of him typing the word "weak" a letter at a
time, the metal typeface banging the message with each stroke. The inci-
dent terminates Leland's job and his relationship with Kane. Welles, with
his editor Robert Wise (The Hunchback of Notre Dame [1939], The Devil and
Daniel Webster, The Magnificent Ambersons [1942]), who went on to become
a notable director on his own, then returns to the hospital. On the right
wall Kane continues to type Leland's critical attack on Susan; left of the
frame the elderly Leland concludes his story to Thompson. The memory
image fades into a dark blank wall returning to present time.
Thompson returns to Susan's club where she consents to an interview.
Her flashback portrays Kane's persistence in turning Susan into a singing
success at any cost. The opening night performance is presented for the
second time, now from Susan's perspective on stage looking directly out
to the audience. Here we see how Kane takes her failings personally. He
is humiliated at the negative reception. Standing in the dark he applauds
wildly to generate praise to no avail. As the lights come up, he is morti-
fied to be the only one still clapping.
When Susan asserts herself against continuing a singing career, Kane
stands over her, seated on the floor. An extreme high-angle shot looking
down at Susan in fear finds her cast in his long, dark shadow. A Holly-
The Authorial Voice • 89
Notes
1. Created by producer-director Louis de Rochemont and Roy E. Larsen of
Time, Inc., The March of Time was a newsreel unit that utilized documentary and
cinematic recreation techniques to present news and entertainment items to movie
audiences. Each edition, delivered to theaters once a month from 1935 to 1951,
employed bravado showmanship as a deep-voiced narrator led the viewer
quickly through the news, illustrated with maps, diagrams, and text. This influ-
ential cinema series shaped political views editorializing on impacting events
such as the Great Depression and controversial figures of World War II such as
Adolf Hitler, Benito Mussolini, and Japan's Tojo.
2. Deep-focus photography produces images with a depth of field that allows
the foreground, middleground, and background in sharp focus. This style of cin-
ematography requires a smaller aperture and greater amounts of light than in tra-
ditional shallow focus shots. The aesthetic results of deep-focus photography are
a realistic relationship between the scene and the viewer that allows the eye to
participate in exploring the planes of design and action within the shot. There is
less reliance on editing and more emphasis on composition, staging, and move-
ment within the frame.
3. This was long believed to be a single continuous shot that began on the opera
stage and then craned upward above the stage into the rafters and eventually to
a catwalk where the two workmen were standing. Scholarship by Robert L. Car-
ringer in The Making of Citizen Kane and by others revealed this was a visual ef-
fects shot. An optical printer was employed to join shots made on separate sets
to create the illusion of a single continuous upward camera movement.
The Authorial Voice • 91
Of Further Interest
Screen
Blood Simple
Dr. Strangelove or: How I Learned to Stop Worrying and Love the Bomb
The Magnificent Amber sons
Nixon
Velvet Goldmine
Read
Citizen Welles: A Biography of Orson Welles by Frank Brady
The Making of Citizen Kane by Robert L. Carringer
The Citizen Kane Book: Raising Kane by Pauline Kael
Orson Welles: A Biography by Barbara Learning
Citizen Kane: The Fiftieth Anniversary Album by Harlan Lebo
m
Shot Structure
The Crowd
Why is the black-and-white silent film The Crowd still as relevant and vital
today as it was at its original release in 1928? Inspired by early German
expressionist films (see chapter 10) and the reality of a competitive Amer-
ica ripe with opportunity, King Vidor (1894-1982) set out to tell a story
of a couple dealing with love, the responsibilities of marriage, and find-
ing a place in the world. The cycle of life never changes. Audiences may
want to be entertained, but longevity lies in the cinematic ability to por-
tray the human condition with honesty and compassion, and without pre-
tense.
John (James Murray) and Mary (Eleanor Boardman) meet, fall in love
at first sight, marry, and have two children. Mary transforms from a flap-
per to wife and mother. John remains a happy-go-lucky dreamer who
likes to play his ukulele and think up catchy ad slogans. At his job, and
in the bustling streets of New York City, John is just one in a crowd, but
idealism nurtures his spirit. After entering a jingle contest, John wins a
cash prize. As the ecstatic couple share their joy, tragedy befalls them
when a truck fatally strikes down their little girl (Alice Mildred Puter) as
she runs across the street toward them. Depressed, John quits his job and
eventually loses Mary's confidence. John sets out to jump into the path
of an oncoming train, but the love and faith of his son (Freddie Burke
Frederick) renew his drive. He gets a job and returns to Mary, who is in
the process of leaving him. Their love match is rekindled and their little
Shot Structure • 93
Director King Vidor creates a visual metaphor that reflects the major theme
of The Crowd. His hero John Sims is just-one-of-the-crowd swept up in the
anonymity of the New York City experience. Courtesy Photofest.
family goes to the theater, where they laugh and again become part of the
crowd.
King Vidor was a master of visual storytelling. He understood that cin-
ema may go beyond the narrative accumulation of sequential images. An
individual shot unit can contain an inner structure that communicates the
themes and objectives of the story. Drawing on a craft honed throughout
the silent film era, Vidor relied on images, cinematic poetry, and the force
of emotion to communicate the veritable and compassionate narrative of
The Crowd. Shooting on location, often with hidden cameras that allowed
the actual multitudes of New York to people the background action, Vidor
captured the vitality of the city.
A production design technique called forced perspective places John
in environments that emphasize the vulnerability of an individual strug-
gling to find his way in a vast modern world. As a boy, John climbs a
long, steep stairway as he learns of the untimely death of his father, who
had promised to protect and nurture him so he could have every advan-
tage toward success. The image is a metaphor concerning the mountains
John will have to climb during his life.
94 • Becoming Film Literate
is not a slice of life—it is life as he sees it. The people who embody the
crowd are individuals who struggle to make a life in which they are
happy, self-productive, and loved. To achieve his vision, Vidor married
the populist and expressionist styles that would later inspire the postwar
style of Italian neorealism, depicted in Vittorio De Sica's The Bicycle Thief
(see chapter 6), and movies that took a candid look at American life like
Billy Wilder's The Apartment.
A naturalistic methodology was exercised in casting The Crowd and for
the performance style and manner in which the actors were directed.
Vidor knew instinctively that a recognizable movie star would shatter the
sense of realism set up in the story and the visualization approach he was
creating. For the role of John Sims, Vidor searched for a common man
who reflected the carefree naivete of his character. He eventually ran into
James Murray, an extra, who the director immediately knew was right for
the part. After Murray was convinced that Vidor was serious about put-
ting an unknown actor in the lead role, Murray didn't so much act the
part as be who audiences would identify as one of their own. His re-
markable performance sustains John's childlike innocence and relies on
expression and gesture to communicate the character's sincerity.1
For Mary, John's loving and supportive wife, Vidor cast his then
spouse, the beautiful movie actress Eleanor Boardman. To transform into
Mary, Boardman abandoned the glamour image and melodrama acting
style of the time. Vidor was aware that the actress had a tendency to walk
through a part if she wasn't engaged in the character, but Boardman de-
veloped Mary into an emotionally real woman that reflected the reality
of the situation with which she was confronted.
Design, composition, and montage create the external mood of The
Crowd. Vidor brought all his cinematic powers to dramatically present the
environmental powers that surround and engulf John and Mary. But he
concentrated on the honesty of his actors to transmit the humanity nec-
essary to engage the audience in a story that was devoid of the dramatic
artifice they expected when they visited the picture show.
The relationship of John and Mary as they react to each other and their
circumstances are captured on film in a direct manner. Photographed in
close shots without overtly dramatic lighting, angles, or camera move-
ment, Vidor allows Murray and Boardman to create and project honest
emotions that communicate straight to the audience without undue cin-
ematic interference. The editing emphasizes how the personality and be-
havior of John and Mary influence each other by establishing patterns of
shot-reverse shot that capture the nuances of their development from
first date to their lives as husband and wife. The most effective emotional
96 • Becoming Film Literate
moments are achieved by holding the camera on the actors as they react
to events that have great impact on their lives. As John and Mary go from
elation to anguish when they call from out of a window to their children
with the good news of the contest prize, which then results in their
daughter's fatal accident, the emphasis is not on what they see but on
how it affects their emotional state. When Mary deals with John storm-
ing out of the house after an argument, a long take allows the viewer to
watch as she goes through a series of specific emotions before running to
him to resolve the issue. When John is about to jump to his death out of
despair, it is the gut-wrenching look on his face that moves the audience
more than simply the juxtaposition of this shot with an angle of the on-
coming train. The intercutting heightens the drama, but it is the honesty
of Murray's performance that emphasizes John's dire situation.
Vidor takes great advantage in visualizing the metaphor of the constant
presence of the crowd that reminds John of the daunting competition he
must contend with and ultimately accept to become a complete and grat-
ified person. The crowd is there when his father dies, at work, when he
courts Mary, as he carries the lifeless body of his daughter, when he is
unemployed, and finally as he joins them in laughter at the theater as the
camera pulls back in the final shot, signifying that John now accepts his
lot in life.
The ironies presented by the crowd humble John. To impress Mary on
their first date, he ridicules a man in a clown costume earning a living as
a walking advertisement. When he can not get in the long employment
lines, he vigorously pursues that very job. The image of John in the same
role as the one he once mocked is ironic, sad, and ultimately rewarding
because it propels him to accept the realities that frustrate his quest for
happiness.
At the beginning of a century that transformed America into a melting
pot, The Crowd is a populist story fueled by the spirit of the immigrant.
John was born in America, but Vidor stages two scenes on a boat to re-
late his character to those who came to the country from other lands to
stake their claim for democracy. The first shows John traveling by ferry
to Manhattan as a passenger tells him of the challenges the city holds for
the everyman. The second is on a company excursion, when John must
tell Mary he has quit his job. The passengers waving from portholes bring
to mind the jubilation of freedom in immigrant faces. Mary's uncondi-
tional faith in John reminds us of the determination expressed by those
committed to a new life in a new world. The Crowd is a film empowered
by the timeless themes that represent the American dream.
Shot Structure • 97
Notes
1. After The Crowd, James Murray appeared in a few films, but because of
chronic alcoholism, he experienced a sharp decline in his acting career. He died
in 1936 at the age of thirty-five, when he either jumped or fell into the Hudson
River.
Of Further Interest
Screen
The Big Parade
M (1931)
Modern Times
Our Daily Bread
Sunrise
Read
King Vidor, American by Raymond Durgnat and Scott Simmon
King Vidor: A Director's Guild of America Oral History, interview by Nancy Dowd
and David Shepard
On Film Making by King Vidor
A Tree is a Tree: An Autobiography by King Vidor
The Visual Story: Seeing the Structure of Film, TV, and New Media by Bruce Block
IB
Thematic Unity
The Decalogue
ation is set up, but the exact interrelationship of the characters is not im-
mediately evident. This allows for a focus on the ethical issues, rather
than textual ideas. The majority of the characters seem to live in the same
housing complex. There are many shots taken from the point of view of
someone standing at a window looking out to the grounds and beyond.
This aesthetic choice functions on many levels. It is a practical view that
allows the camera to see what is outside a protagonist's window and the
events that occur in the street. It both establishes a point of view of the
characters and pinpoints their location in the high rise. Exterior shots link
with this spot when another character is looking up to their windows.
Characters are photographed at a window, and at times the camera be-
comes their eyes looking out at their world.
Each Decalogue episode builds in complexity on the basis of an action
that leads to reactions and a multitude of responses that culminate in a
100 • Becoming Film Literate
moral issue with no easy answers and an abundance of irony. Each story
is a progression. There is no turning back or Hollywood happy ending.
None of these films end when the viewer assumes they have concluded.
Breaking a commandent sets many emotions and feelings in play. To come
to a conclusion, Kieslowski goes down all paths after intercutting several
strands of narrative interactions. Each film ends with a fade to black, al-
most always on a face.
The color schemes of the films are cool, desaturated (see desaturation
in glossary), and contain a limited tonal color palette. Close-ups that cap-
ture deeply felt emotions are abundant as are full shots with clarity and
detail that relate the character to the environment. Kieslowski is eco-
nomical—his camera is always where it needs to be for the story.
Interscene editing is dictated by the characters and their actions. The
music by Zbigniew Preisner (To Kill a Priest, The Double Life of Veronique,
Damage) underscores emotion, not action. This is emotional and psycho-
logical, not thematic, music.
Other consistencies in The Decalogue are areas of cultural significance.
All of the films are based in Poland. Knowledge of the country's social
and political history enhances an understanding of the work, but the
human desires, strengths, and frailties are universal. There are many rit-
uals that define the European sensibility behind the stories. Preparing
water for tea or coffee is an act that appears in the majority of the films.
It often begins a day or marks the return to the home. Drinking coffee has
a pure significance in this culture. It is a beverage drunk over casual or
serious conversation, almost always served in a glass, so we can see the
brown liquid is rich with tradition. Cigarettes are constantly lit and
smoked but do not infer sexiness as in American films. They are ingrained
in the lifestyle. Often they have a symbolic meaning, as when a man about
to be executed for murder in Decalogue V is given his last smoke. He
draws the smoke deep into his lungs as if it was his last breath of life.
Cigarettes are smoked during times of crisis, intimacy, and loneliness.
Decalogue I covers the first commandment: "I am the Lord God; thou
shalt not have other gods before me." The god here is in the form of a
computer that sends messages on its own. Symbolically, it suggests that
science has replaced the protagonist's belief in a spiritual being. Krzysztof
(Henryk Baranowski), a professor, and his young son, Pawel (Wojciech
Klata), deal with the absence of their wife/mother. The father and son love
and cherish each other but the relationship lacks spirituality. When a bottle
of black ink mysteriously breaks and floods the professor's notes, he takes
it as a symbol of dire trouble. The boy has gone ice skating with the in-
struction to stay in the area the father scientifically deemed safe. Through-
Thematic Unity • 101
out the episode a homeless man sits at the snow-covered shore in front
of a frozen lake. Intercutting implies a connection between the father, son,
and indigent man. As in much of The Decalogue—and as in life—not
everything is explained. Tragedy comes at the conclusion. The boy has
fallen through the ice and has drowned. The homeless man is gone. Was
science defied because the boy went beyond the safety zone to help the
man or did the man go to the boy on his skates? The professor who be-
lieves in absolute science has had his belief system betrayed.
Poetic images set and enhance the psychological atmosphere concern-
ing death. In the text the boy asks his father about the nature and mean-
ing of death. It is visualized by a dead dog, sour milk poured into a glass
of coffee, a frozen video image of the boy on a television monitor, a bot-
tle of frozen water, and an image of the Virgin mother splashed with can-
dle wax until it appears she is crying.
Decalogue II is "Thou shalt not take the name of the Lord thy God in
vain." Dorota (Krystyna Janda), the wife of Andrzej (Olgierd Lukas-
zewicz), a critically ill man, is persistent in trying to convince a doctor
(Aleksander Bardini) to tell her whether her husband will live or die. The
moral dilemma facing them is that she is pregnant with another man's
child. If the husband can live, she will get an abortion. If he is to die, she
will have the baby and move onto another life. The doctor, who we learn
lost his family in a tragic accident, is put in the position of playing god
to decide life or death. The irony lies in the fact that Andrzej lives, the
other relationship ends, and Andrzej awakens to the news that he is to
be a father. As the episode concludes, Andrzej is talking to the doctor
about the importance of a child—this from a man who will never learn
he is not the biological father of his child, to a man who knows he can
only be a false god because his child was taken away from him by what
is commonly called an act of God.
Dorota and the doctor have a combative relationship. She, we are told,
once ran over his dog with her car. We learn about the doctor's past in
scenes taking place in his kitchen over coffee with his housekeeper. So
only the viewer learns the reason for the doctor's seemingly detached be-
havior—he is protecting himself emotionally. Dorota smokes; he does not.
At one emotional point, she has to ash her cigarette and uses the match
box. The matches instantly ignite. The flare of fire visually defines her
volatile state, signals a reaction from the doctor, and underlines the charge
between them. An answering machine in Dorota's apartment is a dra-
matic device to communicate her relationship to the lover and the call
from the doctor that she keeps expecting. The scene in which the husband
comes out of his sleep state is masterly cinematic in its structure and pres-
102 • Becoming Film Literate
entation. Dorota is at her window at night. The camera tracks down into
darkness and settles on the doctor's face. Then it pans right along the
building, which now becomes her husband's hospital room. His eyes
open and look up. There is a cut to a bug struggling to hang onto a spoon
in a glass of tea or coffee. After a long ordeal it makes it to the rim of the
glass, a poetic metaphor for the man's plight. The music playing as score
becomes source as the scene shifts to Dorota performing at a concert. She
looks out to the audience for the doctor who finally has given her a de-
finitive determination that her husband will die. Functioning again as
source, the music concludes in the doctor's office as Andrzej, now out of
danger, comes to see him.
"Remember the Sabbath day, to keep it holy" is Decalogue III. The story
takes place on Christmas Eve, a holy night and a family night. Janusz
(Daniel Olbrychski) dresses up as Santa Claus. During midnight Mass he
sees his former lover, Ewa (Maria Pakulnis), who later contacts him for
help to find her missing husband. Janusz lies to his wife to get out of the
house. During the night, he learns that her husband left her three years
ago after catching the two in bed. Ewa manipulates Janusz by saying she
will kill herself unless they spend the night together. Janusz keeps his
marriage vow holy as the commandment requires for the sabbath day and
stays faithful to his wife.
The suggestion that Ewa's husband is missing is set up right from the
opening. The camera slowly focuses on a drunk wandering into an acci-
dent. This narrative strand recurs through several scenes fortifying Ewa's
story. Kieslowski takes full advantage of the emotional stress surround-
ing the holiday, when loneliness and failed relationships can make sui-
cide an answer or a foil. The festivity of the night is captured in colored
light but dimmed by Janusz's worry that he will lose something either
way.
Decalogue IV, "Honor thy father and mother," concerns Anka (Adrianna
Biedrynska), who discovers a note left by her deceased mother that
Michal (Janusz Gajos) is not her biological father. This knowledge dra-
matically alters Anka's feelings toward him, but eventually she learns that
his love for her, as with a natural parent, is unconditional. Honoring a
mother and father goes beyond blood to true commitment.
The camera's ability to focus on elements within the frame is used to
comment on the shifting nature of reality altered by learning a situation
is not what it originally appeared to be. There are three major planes of
action in a shot—foreground, background, and middle ground—where
the characters often reside. For this episode, Kieslowski and his cine-
matographer, Krzysztof Pakulski, constantly shift the focal point, an aes-
Thematic Unity • 103
thetic choice that visualizes the shifting moral choices that confront the
characters.
"Thou shalt not kill" is Decalogue V, a harrowing depiction of a sense-
less murder followed by a hanging carried out by the state. The result of
this powerful film is an unconditional interpretation of the command-
ment. By detailing the senseless and vicious murder of an innocent
stranger and the obsession with carrying out the death penalty mandate,
the sanctity of life is offended. The power to take a life does not belong
to an individual or a group of individuals who call themselves a state.
Kieslowski and his creative team apply a different combination of aes-
thetics to this most serious episode. The overall color scheme has a yel-
low-sepia tone cast. The images are not sharp and clear but burnished.
The design is timeless and less specific than any of the other films. This
intensifies the brutality of the separate but related acts connected by a
moral code. Many parts of The Decalogue feature days that are bleak, a
combination of geographical and economic conditions. The murder of a
cab driver (Jan Tesarz) is committed by the deadening anger of Jacek
(Miroslaw Baka), a young man who lost his loving sister at a tender age.
The bleak sky is a dramatic setting for the capital crime and a metaphor
for the future of the man, his killer, and the society that rationalizes mur-
der in the name of justice while ignoring the word of the Lord.
In Decalogue VI—"Thou shalt not commit adultery"—Tomek (Olaf
Lubaszenko) falls in love with Magda (Grazyna Szapolowska), a beauti-
ful woman whom he has spied on by peeping through a telescope into
her apartment. His love is destroyed when Magda learns of his existence
and tries to consummate the relationship. The boy then ends his obses-
sion and falls out of love with her.
Voyeurism is the medium of communication here. Before the woman
becomes aware of Tomek, the boy receives erotic pleasure by viewing her
sexual exploits from afar, without interruption or intimacy on his part.
When the connection is made, the two communicate through direct eye-
line match and the viewer becomes a voyeur into both of their lives. The
adultery theme is metaphorical in nature. By watching Magda have sex
with other men, Tomek falls in love through a vicarious erotic experience.
The symbolic adultery occurs when Magda falls in love with Tomek and
violates his personal sense of commitment.
"Thou shalt not steal" is Decalogue VII. Majka (Maja Barelkowska) runs
off with six-year-old Ania, who she knows is her biological child, taking
her from her mother Ewa (Anna Polony), who took over Majka's moth-
erhood role when the teenager had a baby out of wedlock with Wojtek
(Boguslaw Linda), a young teacher at the time. Ania believes that Ewa,
104 • Becoming Film Literate
her grandmother, is her mother. Motivations are complex. Ewa was the
headmaster of a school and came up with this solution to avoid scandal
between one of her teachers and a student who was also her daughter.
Majka is convinced Ewa wanted another child but couldn't so she co-
opted Ania. Stefan (Wladyslaw Kowalski), her father, understands the rift
between the two, and Wojtek has mixed emotions about his relationship
with Majka, Ania, and Ewa.
Wojtek had long since given up his dream of becoming a writer and
runs a stuffed bear business. In Kieslowski's poetic hands, this becomes
part of the ironic fabric of the story. When Majka and Ania arrive, his
room is filled with stuffed bears. Ania falls asleep among the sea of bears.
When Majka suspects Wojtek is trying to send them back home, they
leave. Majka gives Ania a toy bear to appease the child, saying it was left
for her by her father.
The sin of stealing is double-edged. Ewa stole the baby from Majka be-
cause of social pressures. Majka stole Ania away from Eva because of her
anger. In the end Ania is reunited with her "mother," but Majka takes ac-
tion to separate herself from everyone. Stealing is a loss of incalculable
repercussions.
Decalogue VIII is based on the commandment "Thou shalt not bear false
witness against thy neighbor." Zofia (Maria Koscialkowska), a professor,
is visited by Elzbieta (Teresa Marczewska), a younger woman who con-
fronts Zofia's past by telling her that she was a Jewish child rejected by
her during the war after Zofia had first promised to adopt her. The pro-
fessor who teaches ethical issues learns of the tremendous hurt she has
caused and tries to help Elzbieta as well as to make her understand the
whole story. The price of bearing false witness is great for all involved.
Time is an important issue in this film and in all of The Decalogue. Here
the sin was committed in the past and it altered Elzbieta's sense of time
and quality of life. Both women had to spend the time of their lives with
that event interfering with the course of their existence. Kieslowski and
his editor on the series, Ewa Smal (The Contract, Korczak, Nastasja), em-
phasize gaps in the present time-line of the film with time cuts. The short-
form film often requires the compression of time, so the episode cuts out
the irrelevant and joins together the relevant. This technique is applied to
most movies, but Kieslowski does it with such articulation. He moves the
story through the moral time space, not only the reality of time past.
"Thou shalt not covet they neighbor's wife" is Decalogue IX. Roman
(Piotr Machalica), a surgeon who has long been a womanizer, learns that
he has become impotent. He implores Hanka (Ewa Blaszczyk), his loyal
and loving wife, to find a lover. When she does, Roman becomes insanely
Thematic Unity • 105
jealous. When they finally are able to come back together, he misreads in-
formation, which makes him believe she is again off with her lover. He
tries to kill himself but fails. All of these trials result in restoring their
commitment to each other. Roman's dalliances and the encouragement he
gave to his wife to seek an outside relationship almost results in the de-
struction of life and love.
The reflection of self through a mirror or other surfaces is a constant
theme of The Decalogue. It can be a moral reflection of a character taking
stock, or it can be self-confrontation. When the doctor returns from learn-
ing his fate, he wants to tell Hanka but she does not want to hear the
story. He is reflected in the bedroom mirror and then in a bathroom mir-
ror. Here, they remind him to face the truth but also represent duplicity,
which he has practiced, an illusion that will fall apart when he sets the
relationship into a tailspin by facing his wife with his version of the truth.
The final film, Decalogue X, "Thou shalt not covet they neighbor's
goods," is a black comedy. Two brothers, Artur (Zbigniew Zamachowski)
and Jerzy (Jerzy Stuhr), inherit an extremely valuable stamp collection
when their father dies. When the men learn that their father secretly in-
vested most of his life earnings into the collection and denied their
mother, they rationalize their greed. In trying to quickly cash in on their
inheritance, the brothers get caught up in a web of con artists. The result
is a twist on the final commandment, because it is the criminals who ben-
efit, and the brothers are the ones who are punished for their disrespect
of the property of others.
The irony in this episode is in the creation of the characters. Artur is a
popular punk rocker and Jerzy is a buttoned-down everyman. The broth-
ers have little in common and have not seen each other for a long time.
But the revelation that they may now be rich brings them together as sib-
lings and partners and then divides them when paranoia sets in.
Kieslowski concludes his examination of the ultimate moral code with
a light touch. The brothers haven't lost everything because they now have
a greater love for each other and a shared passion kindled by their dad's
secret obsession.
The Decalogue is not a religious film in the manner of Cecil B. De Mille's
The Ten Commandments or John Huston's The Bible, but it is dedicated to
the moral principles that govern mankind. They can be seen as ten short
films about the complexities of human interaction. The Ten Command-
ments represent the word of God. The Decalogue translates them into
human terms. It is Kieslowski's vision that penetrates all that is human
in this watershed work.
106 • Becoming Film Literate
Of Further Interest
Screen
Berlin Alexanderplatz
Three Colors: Blue
Three Colors: Red
Three Colors: White
Read
Double Lives, Second Chances: The Cinema of Krzysztof Kieslowski by Annette Ins-
dorf
Decalogue: The Ten Commandments by Krzysztof Kieslowski and Krzystof
Piesiewicz
Kieslowski on Kieslowski, edited by Danusia Stok
The Fright of Real Tears: Krzysztof Kieslowski Between Theory and Post-Theory, ed-
ited by Slavoj Zizek
IB
Mythopoetic Film
Stan Brakhage as the Dog Star Man during his mythopoetic climb to a moun-
tain top in his watershed experimental film Dog Star Man. Brakhage utilizes
mythic imagery and an avant-garde aesthetic to present the cycles of exis-
tence and man's desire for physical and spiritual ascension. Courtesy of An-
thology Film Archives.
camera gate becomes a twig twisting in the wind. Dirt on the surface of
the film as it runs through the projector transforms into dust of the earth,
particles in space. An anamorphic (see anamorphic wide-screen format
in glossary) lens bends reality seen through animal and blessed eyes. A
beating heart expresses humanity.
The nature of focus becomes an operating principle of Dog Star Man.
In traditional cinema a sharp image is a correct image. Soft focus tech-
nique has limited narrative use and is only realized in comparison with
a clearly rendered representation. 3 For Brakhage, clarity is not achieved
by the rigidity of the camera lens or proper relation of focal length to sub-
ject but in the film artist's abilities to capture light, form, and movement
through an organic function of his earner a-tool.
The Dog Star Man (Stan Brakhage) is out in an open forest. The frame
is filled with circular and equivocal shapes that expand the viewer's sight,
not square or rectangular forms that confine it. The optical elements of
the lens refract light. A zooming (see zoom lens in glossary) motion re-
peatedly creates depth from far to near, near to far. Transformation is at-
tained by dense in-camera layering of colors and textures, not always by
the collision of image through the physical editing process. The power
and energy of sexual expression merges with the power and energy of
the sun as a light and life source. The man celebrates the life of his child.
Seasons change from winter, spring, and summer, to fall. Positive and
negative printing symbolizes the yin and yang of the spirits. There is a
period of night and then a new day bursts into being.
Dog Star Man: Part 1 is thirty-one minutes and begins with a white
globe, the sky flickering with clouds passing over a tall mountain. The
man, shouldering a long wooden handled axe, and his dog slowly climb
the steep snowy mountain in a series of vignettes structured with long
fades in and out of black. The surface of the moon and the burning em-
bers return. The ice is now from his point of view as he slowly makes his
way up the hilly path and confronts the outdoor forces. The air bubbles
and dark marks from the adhesive tape splice create texture and set the
images back in time. Brakhage simultaneously reminds viewers that they
are watching a film and allows them to experience the aesthetic beauty
actualized by the early stages of the editing process.
The Dog Star Man climbs day and night. The trip is arduous, often il-
lustrated by slow-motion imaging. The pace of Part 1, like the climb, is
slow and deliberate. As the man trudges upward, he proceeds through
fire and ice, reproduction, and the bearing of the fruit of his offspring. He
encounters religion represented by stained glass imagery. His long stringy
hair and beard are at one with the bare branches of the trees all around
Mythopoetic Film • 1 1 1
Notes
1. Visible tape splices were part of Brakhage's aesthetic on Dog Star Man and
other films. The traditional completion method is to cut the negative in a check-
board A-and-B roll method by using liquid glue and a hot splicer that allows for
a seamless join between images. Brakhage printed the cut made with tape splices
so the joins can be seen, and the lines and texture caused by the tape add visual
texture and a repetitive graphic pattern that become part of the viewing experi-
ence.
2. The Bolex 16mm movie camera was developed by the Paillard S. A. Com-
pany of Switzerland in the early 1930s. The Bolex, which has been the camera of
choice for avant-garde and experimental filmmakers since the 1940s, can be op-
erated by a built-in, hand-cranked, spring-driven power or by accessing an elec-
tric motor. It is easily hand-held or mounted on a tripod, shoots from eight to
sixty-four frames per second, can photograph a single frame at a time, and per-
forms in-camera fades, dissolves, and superimpositions.
3. Soft-focus technique is an aesthetic choice in which the image is not in a
sharp focus but slightly or dramatically out of focus to soften or abstract the image
being photographed. Traditionally, soft focus is used subtly to create the atmo-
sphere of beauty and to remove age lines from an actor's face. In its more radi-
cal application, soft-focus technique attempts to explore new ways of seeing in
which shape, color, and form dominate over line and definition.
4. Pointillism is a painting technique best associated with Georges Seurat's
Sunday Afternoon on the Island of La Grande Jatte, in which small touches of pure
color create a vibrant effect when the work is viewed from a distance.
Of Further Interest
Screen
By Brakhage (Criterion DVD)
Quick Billy
Scorpio Rising
Twice a Man
Wavelength
Mythopoetic Film • 113
Read
Brakhage Scrapbook: Collected Writings 1964-1980 by Stan Brakhage
Essential Brakhage: Selected Writings on Filmmaking by Stan Brakhage
The Films of Stan Brakhage in the American Tradition ofErza Pound, Gertrude Stein,
and Charles Olson by R. Bruce Elder
Film Culture Reader, edited by P. Adams Sitney
Visionary Film: The American Avant-Garde 1943-2000 by P. Adams Sitney
IB
Political Objectives through
Cinematic Storytelling
Spike Lee (in the Dodgers shirt) as Mookie and Ossie Davis (center) as Da
Mayor in Do the Right Thing. Depicted is just one of many confrontations that
take place in a Brooklyn neighborhood on the hottest day of the summer. The
physical heat becomes a metaphor that expresses a socio-political situation
about to boil over. Courtesy Photofest.
Heat is the central metaphor of Do the Right Thing. The sun is relent-
less and the streets are sweltering. Tempers boil over—there is no escape.
The color palette is comprised of red, orange, coral, yellow, and warm
browns. Ice cold beer, an open fireplug spewing a waterfall onto loosely
dressed neighborhood children and teens, cold showers, and even ice
rubbed on a naked body can't cool off this cross-section of New York in
Bed Stuy. The costumes by Ruth Carter (Rosewood, Amistad, Love and Bas-
ketball) celebrate ethnic pride and diversity. The original music score by
Bill Lee (She's Gotta Have It, School Daze, Mo' Better Blues), Spike's father,
recalls jazz, Negro spirituals, and the poignancy of Gershwin's Porgy and
Bess.
Do the Right Thing was shot on location in Brooklyn. The production
was given a cordoned-off area where production designer Wynn Thomas
(Malcolm X, Analyze This, A Beautiful Mind) built a pizzeria directly across
116* Becoming Film Literate
from a Korean market also created for the film. A block of brownstones
went through major rehabilitation that repaired structural damage to the
exteriors and provided new paint jobs to sustain a controlled color palette
of desert colors. A radio station was built in an abandoned building so
that a large window front faced the universe of the story.
Do the Right Thing, like many of Spike Lee's films, is theatrical in style
and intention. Wynn Thomas was reminded of Elmer Rice's Street Scene
and Porgy and Bess, two theatrical works in which all the characters and
circumstances are self-contained and converge during the course of the
story. The cinematography by Ernest Dickerson (Brother from Another
Planet, Mo' Better Blues, Malcolm X) emphasizes the theatricality of the de-
sign and torrid color scheme with rays of white light, combining cool and
warm compositional areas to provide contrast that makes hot hotter. The
result is a Brooklyn that is a representation of the real world, not as dirty
and gritty but as romantic and passionate. Below the surface are miscon-
ceptions, prejudice, fear, and hate. This is a neighborhood of people who
cannot keep the larger forces of their combined histories out of their
homes and streets.
The characters in Do the Right Thing are a sampling of urban city life.
Before the sixties, neighborhoods were contained and everyone "knew
their place," but the social upheaval that began in that significant decade
sent everyone looking for liberation, self-expression, representation, and
respect. Sal (Danny Aiello) is the proprietor of Sal's Pizzeria. Sal is old-
school, decent, and hard-working. His business is not a pizza place or a
pizza joint; it is a pizzeria. He takes pride in the food that has fed the chil-
dren and people of Bed Stuy. The neighborhood has changed since he first
opened decades before. His clientele were once Italian Americans who
shared his ethnicity and values. Now, the young blacks of Bed Stuy are
expressing their own culture. Sal tries to handle potential clashes with
dignity, but he is the boss with rules that cannot be broken. Sal represents
a white man who, when pushed beyond control of his turf, will resort to
primal instincts to protect his own—his family business. Sal has two sons.
Pino (John Turturro) is an angry racist. He openly displays his hostility.
He wants Sal to sell the pizzeria and open one in their neighborhood,
where they would be with their own kind. Pino admires Eddie Murphy,
Prince, Michael Jordan, and other black celebrities. His racism convinces
him that these men are not black. Vito (Richard Edson), his younger
brother, is low in intelligence and self-esteem. Vito does have a good heart
and does not harbor hatred. He freely associates with blacks in the neigh-
borhood and abhors the violence between the races. Da Mayor (Ossie
Davis), like Sal, is of the old school, but too much alcohol has eroded his
Political Objectives through Cinematic Storytelling • 117
everything. They want respect and they hate foreigners running stores in
their neighborhood, but they are mostly talk. The police, Officer Ponte
(Miguel Sandoval) and Officer Long (Rick Aiello), are indifferent, even
hostile, to Charlie (Frank Vincent), an Italian American man who is guar-
anteed safe passage with his "antique" Cadillac but is set up by the local
kids who flush him down with a Johnny pump geyser. The officers are
doing their job, but they show brotherhood to Sal and hatred toward the
corner men, and are responsible for the murder of Radio Raheem.
Mister Sefior Love Daddy (Samuel L. Jackson) is an ultra-cool black disc
jockey who watches the day from his microphone. Sitting in the window,
Love Daddy is super smooth, preaches love, embraces the totality of black
music, soul, R&B, rap, traditional jazz, fusion, pop, and everything in be-
tween. His roll call of respect toward the performers of this music is a
salute to black culture and is scenarist Lee's message that culture should
be embraced, not fractured. Love Daddy is involved but aloof; the day
after the melting pot boils over he is back with his rap call for love.
A series of characters make up the diversity of communities struggling
to live together in Bed Stuy. A group of black youths talk the talk but are
looking for their way. They eat and hang at Sal's. They can be cruel, as
young people can be to their own, especially to Da Mayor, whom they
taunt and disrespect. They are waiting for a leader, an incident to define
their future. The Hispanic group likes to drink beer, they stick to their
own, and they dance their own dance to Latin rhythms. When it is time
to stand up, they stand against Sal and the police although they may share
more history with them than they are willing to admit. The Korean gro-
cery owner, Sonny (Steve Park), and his wife Kim (Ginny Yang) work
hard at their business. They mistrust the blacks and the blacks outwardly
display hostility toward them. The owner is anti-Semitic. When sides
need to be taken, he is "black" rather than white. This is business, and
fear protects an owner's livelihood. Smiley (Roger Guenveur Smith) is a
mentally challenged black man who carries pictures of Dr. King and Mal-
colm X whereever he goes. He is a loner who is acknowledged by every-
one but only taken seriously by Buggin Out, who manipulates him into
radical action. Tina, Mookie's girlfriend and mother of his child, wants
her man to be a man—take care of his family, be responsible and avail-
able to her.
Spike Lee is as even-handed as is humanly possible toward his char-
acters, given the rage, hatred, and prejudice that engulf them. Lee has im-
bued his characters with pride, self-knowledge, and the will to follow
their emotions regardless of the cost. The result is an honest look at what
is tearing urban America apart. He offers no clear-cut answers; things
Political Objectives through Cinematic Storytelling • 119
happen because they are the destiny of a country that would like to do
the right thing but is unwilling to look at the problem through the eyes
of each neighbor.
Do the Right Thing is a dramatic film based on close observation of real
events concerning racial unrest. The 1986 incident in which a black man
was murdered by white youths in Howard Beach simply because he
asked for directions to a pizza place that the mob claimed as their turf
was the flash point that inspired Lee to write the film. Claiming rights to
turf is a theme that transforms this family neighborhood into a battle
zone. A young black girl draws a happy house and a joyful sun in white
chalk on the street. Bed Stuy is home, but whose home is it? The whites
moved out long ago. Sal has stayed; he built the tin ceiling old-world
pizzeria with his own hands, but he is convinced he does not have any
other place to go. His white neighborhood is too competitive, and besides,
the people of Bed Stuy have grown up on his food. In Sal's Italian Amer-
ican culture, food is the great healer, a mode of communication, a way of
sharing love. The neighborhood has long since transitioned into a black
community. When a white yuppie, Clinton (John Savage), buys a brown-
stone, he represents gentrification and threatens the young blacks who
claim it as their own even though Clinton tells them this is America. The
corner men resent the fact that there are not any black-owned businesses.
They can't fathom why the Koreans are successful entrepreneurs, but
their righteous criticism becomes just another rap. Sal's is the designation
of the turf war. Sal owns the pizzeria. He runs it his way. His Wall of Fame
celebrates his heroes who happen to be Italian Americans. When Buggin
Out demands Sal put black faces on the wall, the fuse is lit.
Do the Right Thing is honest and truthful but prismatic in its point of
view. All audience members are reflected in the drama and will see right
and wrong in their own way. The answer to prevent disaster is Love
Daddy's call to chill out and love each other, but that has not been the
rule in American's urban areas. For their own reasons, Smiley, Buggin
Out, and Radio Raheem bond in solidarity. They each have an axe to
grind. They demand their rights but do not walk into Sal's with the pre-
meditated determination to destroy. "Fight the Power" is blasting. Sal's
rule is there is no music in his restaurant. When the line in the sand is
drawn, Sal makes the first move and smashes Raheem's precious boom
box with a. baseball bat, a traditional Italian American equalizer. To the
black men, Sal has symbolically murdered the radio, but he has done
something more primal. His anger toward the disrespect caused by the
music tears away his last layer of control—with deep and florid rage Sal
shouts, "Nigger." The bystanders are outraged and the trio is incensed.
120 • Becoming Film Literate
Notes
1. Blaxploitation films were low-budget movies made in the 1970s that starred
African American performers and featured action, sex, and violence. The films
tapped a market that had been ignored by the Hollywood establishment. Blax-
Political Objectives through Cinematic Storytelling • 121
Of Further Interest
Screen
The Battle of Algiers
Get on the Bus
JFK
Jungle Fever
Z
Read
Spike Lee Interviews, edited by Cynthia Fuchs
The Cineaste Interviews: On the Art and Politics of the Cinema, edited by Dan Geor-
gakas, Lenny Rubenstein
Do the Right Thing by Ed Guerrero
Reel to Real, Sex and Class at the Movies by bell hooks
Do the Right Thing: The New Spike Lee Joint by Spike Lee with Lisa Jones
Political Film: The Dialectics of Third Cinema by Mike Wayne
m
Film Noir
Double Indemnity
A man on crutches shown in silhouette walks slowly and straight into the
camera. We do not know who he is. When we do meet him, he has no
trouble walking on his own two feet, but later we learn of a broken leg,
an accident on the job. We see the man, Mr. Dietrichson (Tom Powers),
get into his car on crutches. He is murdered while driving to catch a train.
As part of a plan to collect on a life insurance policy he has unwittingly
signed, his killer boards the train wearing similar clothes and walking
with crutches. Who did we see in the opening—the man, his killer, or the
ghost of the dead man, tracking down the doomed Walter Neff (Fred Mac-
Murray), an insurance agent obsessed with lust and greed?
This presence of a moral conscience in pursuit begins Billy Wilder's
(1906-2002) Double Indemnity (1944). It is what we see while the credits
run. The movie begins before the beginning.
Double Indemnity is a film noir. This overused, misunderstood term has
a specific reference and meaning that continues to blur when applied in
broad strokes by contemporary critics and the public. It has become a
common label given to any film that embraces crime as a theme or deals
with subject matter from the dark side of the human personality. The der-
ivation of film noir is French. Its precursors are serie noire and fleuve noire,
two critical terms used to categorize translations of the American hard-
boiled detective fiction of Dashiell Hammett, Raymond Chandler, James
M. Cain, Horace McCoy, and others. After the start of World War II,
French film critics discovered many narrative and thematic tendencies of
Film Noir • 123
Fred MacMurray as the doomed Walter Neff in Double Indemnity. This land-
mark film noir contains the designating properties of the "dark film" style:
low key lighting, expressive camera angles, a femme fatale (played by Barbara
Stanwyck), and a relentless sense of the hopeless fate of the protagonist.
Courtesy Photofest.
that literary fiction form in particular American movies. The literal trans-
lation of film noir is black film—motion pictures that are both physically
dark in application of aesthetic properties and dark in content.
Disillusionment, loss of identity, paranoia, guilt, McCarthyism, and the
nuclear threat all contributed to the vision of an obsessed America shaken
by world war. The soldiers returning from overseas were in a period of
readjustment. There was an overwhelming alienation in urban life.
Freudian anxiety and the predestined fate of existentialism replaced mom
and apple pie.
Although film noir eventually evolved into neonoir, future-noir, and
noirs aplenty over the decades, the classic period as designated by the
French runs from just prior to World War II to just after the Korean con-
flict. Because film noir is not a standardized genre, critics differed in pin-
124 • Becoming Film Literate
world of greed and obsession. Knowing the path of Neff's destiny stim-
ulates our curiosity to take what Keyes repeatedly calls a nonstop trip to
the graveyard, traveling, as promised throughout by Neff and his femme
fatale, straight down the line.
Once Walter, in flashback, takes the bait from the two-timing Phyllis,
the narrative constructed by the screenwriters leads Walter and Phyllis
and their illicit plot to devastation and destruction. Their plan was to beat
the system—the screenwriters made sure that the dark side of human na-
ture and not justice would be responsible for their demise. This is an ex-
istential destiny set in motion by Walter and Phyllis.
Supporting Keyes's metaphor, the story unfolds like a ride from which
the passengers can not get off. The dialogue is tough, spit out with con-
viction. The characters are cynical. No one is likeable. This is not Holly-
wood where dreams come true and there is always a happy ending, nor
is there moralizing about evil. This is a cinematic representation of an
America that has lost its way. Optimism has been replaced with cynicism
and despair. There is a deadpan, macabre sense of humor as the charac-
ters crack wise. Double Indemnity oozes with sex that is delivered with in-
nuendo and symbolism rather than through graphic depiction. When
Phyllis shoots Neff with one shot but is unable to finish the job, she em-
braces him and for the first time really tells him that she is in love with
him. Neff bitterly returns his sentiments with two quick bullets as the mo-
ment plays like a final orgasm.
Present time in Double Indemnity takes place as Walter continues to
record his confession. It is the exposition of what has happened before
the film started. The flashbacks show what has occurred in a linear se-
quence. At intervals we return to Walter in the office, a reminder that time
is running out as he tells the story from his point of view. This narrative
of a doomed man moves ahead until it catches up with the here and now.
When that moment arrives so does Keyes, and the present is finally al-
lowed to move forward.
The bond between the two men takes an ironic twist. Neff tells Keyes
that he is heading to the border to avoid the gas chamber. Keyes replies
that Neff will not make it to the elevator. Fate has caught up with Neff.
Keyes doesn't have to lay a hand on his colleague and friend. The moral
conscience represented by Keyes signals the end of the line for Neff, who
collapses right outside the office. As Keyes reverses a match-lighting rit-
ual established through the film between the two men, Walter tells the
master fraud investigator that Keyes was too close, just across the desk,
to see his guilt. "Closer than that, Walter," Keyes replies. The last words
126 • Becoming Film Literate
of Double Indemnity are spoken by Walter Neff: "I love you too." Keyes
was the one person Neff could trust. Phyllis Dietrichson deceived him.
Walter Neff was guilty of double murder and the moral crime of decep-
tion. He deceived Keyes, the man he most respected. Neff was also guilty
of self-deception. The wisdom of his mentor, Barton Keyes, taught him
that no one could get away with a murder that robbed the pockets of the
system. Walter Neff submitted to the urges of the night. The fool he suf-
fered faced him in the mirror.
The cinematography by John Seitz (The Lost Weekend, Sunset Boulevard,
The Big Clock) provides the contrast of light and shadow that gives Double
Indemnity the darkness of night and the glare of truth. The application of
lighting goes beyond the verisimilitude of natural and artificial illumina-
tion. The light is a visual representation of the film noir. This is a world
that has lost a moral compass. The dark allows the criminal code to flour-
ish. The light streaming through Venetian blinds does not cleanse the
inner world of Walter Neff. It paints him with black stripes, reminding
us that he is a man headed for prison. The Dietrichson home gets darker
with each appearance until the final murder, when the light is dim and
murky like the soul of Walter Neff. As she begins to reveal her cold-
blooded intentions, Stanwyck's face and figure are gradually diffused by
light and soft focus until she is one of the shadows waiting in the dark.
Throughout the film, Wilder and Seitz composed shots that juxtapose a
character with a place to hide from another. Phyllis is positioned hiding
in a hallway behind the open door of Neff's apartment as Keyes tells Wal-
ter about his suspicion of her. Walter stands in the back of Keyes's office,
trying to avoid Mr. Norton (Richard Gaines), the only person who could
prove that Neff was on the train posing as Dietrichson while he is ques-
tioned by the investigator.
The production design by Hans Dreier (The Great McGinty, Ministry of
Fear, The Blue Dahlia), Hal Pereira (Shane, Funny Face, Rear Window), and
set decorator Bertram Granger (The Lost Weekend; Sorry, Wrong Number;
Peyton Place) is anchored in Neff's office. There are custom-made file cab-
inets with long rows of small drawers designed to store and organize the
individual policy records. All the data and facts of each claim are secured
here, a vault of records that Neff has attempted to scam but has failed.
The rays of a banker's lamp cut through the night. Neff has sealed his
fate by talking into a dictaphone, a machine that records his memo, a con-
fession that now is evidence. The image is of a man being grilled under
the hot lights. This is not a police interrogation room, but Walter's place
of work. Neff has cracked and is spilling the beans, but he does the job
himself. An ashtray is the source for smoke; everybody smokes in a film
Film Noir • 127
noir—it defines the characters and fills the air with a dense atmosphere
during the confessional.
The Dietrichson home is spacious and done in a Spanish style. There
are heavy door panels, an iron-railed staircase, and white stone arches.
For Neff the estate is a palace of sinful pleasure, his escape from his bor-
ing, low-rent life. For Phyllis it is a prison where a bad marriage confines
her existence.
Walter and Phyllis have clandestine meetings at a food market to plot
the murder and its aftermath. Rows of shelves are stacked to perfection
with canned goods. The top pyramids of cans, as well as all the others,
have their labels facing out. Precisely stacked, they frame the doomed
couple, trapped in their own private tomb.
The interior of the insurance company provides a visual subtext to the
narrative. The space is huge, exaggerated in scale to express the power
and might of companies that collect money readily but dole it out very
carefully. The office is a two-level set. The main floor is structured by uni-
form desk setups where the employees do the detail work of the com-
pany. The space is open—there is no privacy. The upper level is a balcony
that runs around the entire office. This is where the powerbrokers can
keep watch. The brass are physically on top while the workers toil below.
The managers have instant access to their spacious offices and a bird's-
eye view of the bureaucratic operation.
Double Indemnity is a model of the film noir style, universally consid-
ered one of the best of the cycle. It is also a great movie that happens to
be a film noir. Too often films are judged, understood, and analyzed using
narrow criteria concerning genre, personal opinion, and the politics of
aesthetic and narrative issues. A great film expresses its intent through
visual storytelling and by translating the text through the film crafts.
Double Indemnity should be studied because it defines film noir, utilizes
cinematic language to tell a compelling story, and because, as with all im-
portant works of art, its magic is timeless.
Of Further Interest
Screen
Kiss of Death (1947)
The Lady from Shanghai
Night and the City (1950)
Out of the Past
The Postman Always Rings Twice (1946)
128 • Becoming Film Literate
Read
Somewhere in the Night: Film Noir and the American City by Nicholas Christopher
Film Noir: The Dark Side of the Screen by Foster Hirsch
Dark City: The Lost World of Film Noir by Eddie Muller
More Than Night: Film Noir in its Contexts by James Naremore
Film Noir: An Encyclopedic Reference to the American Style, edited by Alain Silver
and Elizabeth Ward
IB
The Personal Film
8%
alyze 8'/2 to the frame. Fellini pokes fun at both of these responses toward
the cinema throughout 8%.
In 8%, Guido, like Fellini, is surrounded by journalists and photogra-
phers—the paparazzi (a term coined in Fellini's La Dolce Vita with the
character Paparazzo). They demand to know his views on God, nuclear
war, and death, and badger him with endless questions concerning the
"meaning" of his films. Everyone wants a part in Guido's new film. Many
address the camera directly as if they are speaking to Fellini next to the
camera. Federico Fellini began as an Italian neorealist (see chapter 6) and
then departed from that style by exploring his dreams and fantasies.
Fellini adored the circus and cartooning. The outrageous spirits in his
characters are like caricatures come to life.
The movie within 8ll2 is never made, but it is the subject of the entire
film. Dream sequences and Guido's fantasies are clear references for the
story-line of the film stuck in preproduction. These fantasy sequences are
triggered by the people in Guido's life and signs, symbols, and actions
that mentally transport him into a Fellini-esque world—a delightful blend
of surrealism, theater of the absurd, low comedy, metaphysics, and the
bunkum of a carny huckster.
Most films about filmmaking concern the power and control possessed
by the moneymen. The glamour, backstage politics, sex, romance, and the
contrast between the glitz and desperation of moviemaking are often the
focus of the narrative. The physical process of making movies is usually
a backdrop for the drama played out through the interrelationships of the
characters. The movie being made is often uninteresting or not plausible.
8]/2 is about the process of making a film seen through the reality experi-
enced by the director. That is what makes 8V2 so daring. To Guido, the
movie and his life are so interconnected he cannot completely separate
them. At the time of making 8V2, Fellini was suffering a creative block and
was trying to understand himself, his method of making films, and the
extreme reactions he received from the public, critics, and the press.
The director of a film is the constant center of attention—everyone
wants something from him or her. There is always someone in the direc-
tor's face asking for favors, looking for answers—wanting something the
director does not always have to give. The director's mind is continually
in the movie. Film directors have strong needs. They demand constant
companionship—in Guido's case, an endless series of women from his
mother, to his wife, to his mistress, to aspiring actresses and hangers-on
who would like to know him.
8% is presented totally from Guido's point of view. The audience sees
his world through confused sensibilities. His past and present life become
132 • Becoming Film Literate
Of Further Interest
Screen
Alex in Wonderland
All That Jazz
Fellini's Roma
Jo Jo Dancer, Your Life is Calling
Juliet of the Spirits
Read
The Cinema of Federico Fellini by Peter Bondanella
Fellini's Films by Frank Burke
I, Fellini by Charlotte Chandler
Fellini on Fellini by Federico Fellini
Federico Fellini by Christopher Wiegand
20
Fantasia
control. Mickey tries to stop the broom, which is flooding the sorcerer's
lair with pail after pail of water, by chopping it up with an axe, but hun-
dreds of broom clones come to life and create a flood of biblical propor-
tions. The master finally arrives with the power to end the procession
started by his apprentice, who disrespected the gift of magic. To conduct
the segment, Disney approached famed conductor Leopold Stokowski,
who was dedicated to expanding the popularity of classical music to the
masses. In addition to his accomplishments as a conductor, Stokowski
was well-known to radio audiences, and his distinctive facial profile com-
manded respect as a musical authority and celebrity.
The enthusiasm of the two men led Disney to take a bold and un-
precedented step. Instead of one short subject, he would commit the Dis-
138 • Becoming Film Literate
name was synonymous with animation, there were many other pioneers
with other aesthetic and narrative concerns as their mission. Winsor
McKay and Max and Dave Fleischer had a less conservative, more ad-
venturous approach to animation. In the early 1920s, Hans Richter, Fer-
nand Leger, and Walter Ruttmann were avant-garde filmmakers who
experimented freely with the medium. Disney was adventurous, but the
risk of failure loomed as a high cost of maintaining his empire and the
respect of his audience. Disney had created an animated universe of cute,
cuddly animals and figures. He was fiercely loyal to American ideals. A
man in conflict, the artist in Disney knew no boundaries; the business-
man, however, guarded his sacred investment in the studio and what it
stood for.
There was no precedent for Fantasia, only a prehistory of animation,
live action, and the concert hall format. No one had combined them in
the way Disney and his collaborators envisioned. They were starting from
scratch and writing their own rules.
Everything emanates from the concert film concept. The viewer is po-
sitioned in an imaginary concert hall. The seats are our movie theater
chairs or the home sofa. In front of our view, chairs and music stands for
the orchestra surround a conductor's podium. Fantasia begins as if the
audience is seated politely waiting for the program overture. It is not es-
tablished whether this is a day or evening performance. It is almost like
a concert performed in cyberspace—necessary elements are in place; oth-
ers, like windows or the architecture of the hall, are not. Before a blue
background the musicians assemble and begin to warm up. The atmo-
sphere is serious but amiable. The musicians are in silhouette, most in
dead black while a thin layer of light penetrates others. They are in con-
cert dress. Tuning and warm-up exercises proceed in an airy and con-
vivial manner. This is a concert for everyone. Deems Taylor makes his
entrance and explains that he will be our host. Taylor explains that there
will be three types of presentations: a distinct story interpreted by the
artists from a narrative within the music, others in which the artists paint
representational pictures of what the music stirs in them, and to open
the program, the most challenging—music for its own sake with absolute
music and abstract images to accompany it. Maestro Stokowski enters
and takes his place at the podium. The opening piece is Toccata and Fugue
In D Minor by Johann Sebastian Bach. The lighting changes on the con-
ductor; a pink ball forms behind him. Color fields of subtle light pour
over the sections of the orchestra. The tympani drums are struck with a
mallet and the instruments emit light. This happens to the French horns
140 • Becoming Film Literate
ian dance, ice skating, and bubbles. The sequence is a celebration of na-
ture in all its grace and beauty, achieved with gentle humor and delight.
Each segment was assigned to a different team, part of the Disney factory
method. The results are nuanced in line, color, figure, and abstraction.
The Sorcerer's Apprentice is the most celebrated sequence in Fantasia. It
is both cute and spooky. We encourage Mickey's impish curiosity, but our
worst nightmares are realized as the army of possessed brooms becomes
the ultimate Halloween scare. Before Fantasia, Mickey was a star—now
he is an icon—a master Hollywood performer like Paul Muni, Bette
Davis, Fred Astaire, and Judy Garland.
Stravinsky's The Rite of Spring, which caused a music hall riot when it
premiered in 1913, is interpreted by the audacious Fantasia team as the
evolution of the earth. Film critic and Entertainment Tonight regular
Leonard Maltin recalls public schools showing just this segment on a
16mm projector in science class as a legitimate educational tool. The
growth of life as it evolves is exhibited as science, not the imaginative in-
terpretation of the artist. A single cell becomes amphibious life; then the
dinosaurs before the dawn of man appear. As creation evolves, the ocean
and the cosmos form and volcanoes erupt from the bowels of the earth.
The dinosaurs act out the survival of life—a story to be repeated end-
lessly by man throughout human history.
A fifteen-minute intermission is announced; it is a time to stretch, ab-
sorb, and prepare—a civilized ritual of the theater. A curtain closes. The
title Fantasia appears. The curtain opens for the second portion of the pro-
gram. The musicians again take their places. This time the warm-up is a
spontaneous jazz improvisation that begins with a bass riff.
Deems Taylor introduces us to the soundtrack. To make a connection
between the music and how it is delivered from the optical track on the
film, there is a demonstration of what sound looks like.1 Colors and wave
patterns change; it is humorous and entertaining but close enough to the
truth to be educational. The Disney artists found another way to display
the relationship between music and images. These sounds and the pat-
terns they make on the soundtrack are the ingredients for limitless pos-
sibilities that can be achieved by the marriage of sound and motion
pictures. Musical instruments that produce both high and low timbre dis-
play what they look like, in color, hue, and undulating shape.
Beethoven's The Pastoral Symphony is visualized as Mount Olympus.
This mythology play features centaurs, unicorns, Bacchus, Apollo, Zeus,
and Morpheus. The sequence is graceful, painted in delicate watercolors,
majestic, idyllic, and symmetrical. There is no central story here—we ex-
142 • Becoming Film Literate
perience the passage of time and weather, rain, thunder, clearing, sunset,
the moon, and a time for sleep.
Dance of the Hours by Amilcar Ponchielli is a musical war-horse that the
Disney crew decided to send up. This ballet is danced by ostriches, ele-
phants, hippos with tutus, and crocodiles. It is satire, but the artists stud-
ied and drew real dancers in preparation for the piece and we come away
with a real respect for classical dance. The segment is about movement
and interaction.
The powerful conclusion of Fantasia is the combination of Modeste
Moussorgsky's Night on Bald Mountain and Franz Schubert's Ave Maria—
the profane and the sacred, evil and good. This is adult animation. It be-
gins with a depiction of a winged creature presiding over skeletons and
ghosts he has commanded from graves. It can be read as the devil in
Hades, but the sequence is primal, not biblical. Daring imagery includes
naked female bodies, skulls, flames, and molten lava. A series of chimes
send the bad spirits away. We rise to the sky as Ave Maria takes over from
the maniacal Night on Bald Mountain. Day breaks. There are clouds, then
a procession of the faithful carrying yellow globes of light as they steadily
move across the land and over a bridge; the scene is reflected in a pool
of water. As the procession moves through tall elegant woods, the trees
become a cathedral. We are lifted above, see shafts of blue light, and move
into a beautiful garden. The focus shifts our eyes to a blue sky and the
sun rises—then the image fades to black. Fantasia has concluded; we are
shaken with its beauty. We do not have to leave the concert hall or go
anywhere—the music and the images are within us.
Notes
1. An optical track is a photographic recording of sound that is printed on the
edge of a release print next to the picture area. A bulb in a projector scans the
light and converts it to sound that is amplified during the screening of a film.
Of Further Interest
Screen
Akira
American Pop
Gerald McBoing Boing
Pinocchio
Toy Story
Animation and Music • 143
Read
Animation: The Whole Story by Howard Beckerman
Animation: From Script to Screen by Shamus Culhane
Chuck Amuck: The Life and Times of an Animated Cartoonist by Chuck Jones
The Animation Book: A Complete Guide to Animated Filmmaking, from Flip-Books to
Sound Cartoons by Kit Laybourne
The Animator's Survival Kit by Richard Williams
El
An American Musical
42nd Street
Before there was Bob Fosse, or Joe Gideon, his on-screen persona in All
That Jazz, there was Julian Marsh and Pretty Lady in the black-and-white
musical 42nd Street (1933). Marsh (Warner Baxter) is Broadway's greatest
musical-comedy stage director. He signs a contract to direct Pretty Lady,
a deal the producers make because they are convinced Marsh's name on
the dotted line will ensure a hit. Marsh is edgy, short-tempered, and des-
perate. He should be rich and living off the wealth of his success, but Wall
Street has drained all his cash. It is the early 1930s, the Great Depression
has taken its toll on the country. The Broadway musical distracts Ameri-
cans from their pain and is an escape for a nation in despair. Pretty faces,
leggy blondes, catchy tunes, snappy dance numbers, and uplifting fan-
tasies are just the ticket.
Marsh is bitter over the "gulch" that is Forty-second Street, which has
emotionally, physically, artistically, and financially sucked him dry until
all he has left is a good suit and a stiff brim hat. Accessorized with a life-
time supply of cigarettes, this is Marsh's uniform as a hard-driving, tyran-
nical director who will deliver a hit show by any means necessary.
42nd Street finds Julian Marsh at a low point in his life and career. He
agrees to direct one last show—an all-or-nothing gamble. In addition to
heading toward financial ruin, Marsh has a history of nervous break-
downs. His doctor advises against the new assignment. Marsh is a Type
A perfectionist who exists in a constant state of agitation. No singer,
dancer, or crew member is ever good enough for Marsh. He is warned by
An American Musical • 145
Warner Baxter—as the driven, half-crazed, disheveled, mortally ill, and the-
atrical genius Julian Marsh—demands discipline and perfection as all eyes of
his Broadway musical troupe listen in fear and anticipation. The two rows of
dancers maintain a precision of depth perspective in 42nd Street—the para-
digm for New York, and the backstage American musical. Courtesy Photofest.
his physician that another mental collapse might trigger a fatal heart at-
tack. Marsh rolls the dice and turns Pretty Lady into a Broadway hit—a
toe-tapping entertainment wrapped in the delirium of the times that takes
place in New York, the city that gives Marsh his razor's edge.
42nd Street is a New York movie filmed on a Hollywood sound stage.
The pulse of the city is established during the opening credits. The Vita-
phone Orchestra plays the theme music as if they had been up all night
smoking, drinking, and carousing. The music is raw, hard, brassy, and
played at a tempo just short of overdrive. There are shots of the city,
mainly defined by a wide view jittering with excitement, and a montage
of street signs, including the most famous one in America: Forty-Deuce—
the boulevard of broken dreams, where careers are made and shattered.
On Forty-second Street hope is turned into fame if the swarming crowd
stops moving just long enough to acknowledge a diamond in a mountain
of coal. There is always someone next in line on Forty-second Street.
Like the N.Y. to L.A. musical within All That Jazz, Pretty Lady combines
146 • Becoming Film Literate
glamour with grime. After a cute "Shuffle off to Buffalo" number con-
cerning newlyweds and precision dance choreography, sex, and sophis-
tication, the title song becomes a production number that goes beyond
entertainment to a dance that celebrates the glory and danger of the city
that never did sleep. A backdrop brings the street to the stage so show-
biz can mingle with the dangers and manic energy of the Great White
Way. Peggy Sawyer (Ruby Keeler), the kid who comes back a star, taps
her heart out and then we jump to the top of a cab—we are on Forty-
second Street. A subway entrance leads to the underground terrain of the
city; a barber and a nanny with a baby do their jobs to the pounding song
that pays tribute to the toughest real estate in America. Immigrants close
up their fruit and vegetable carts to play golf; shoes are shined to the beat
of dancing feet. A woman is mauled by her man through the window of
a seedy hotel. There are gun shots and she leaps to the street and is caught
and danced by a New York tough until the boyfriend, now behind her,
stabs this dame to death. The stage becomes a sea of cardboard sky-
scrapers tilted back and forth by a sea of dancers. When the show ends,
the audience streams out of the theater on to the next New York minute.
They celebrate Sawyer. A star is born as the denigrate Marsh sits on the
back steps. He has directed his last show. He is exhausted. The exiting
theatergoers dismiss his triumph and credit the star. John Q. Public is con-
vinced Marsh is dispensable—the final insult from the town that made
him and now breaks him. We do not see Marsh die, but he is a dead man
spiritually if not physically—the city swallows him up.
42nd Street embraces the sudden passion of New York City, where am-
bition can lead to prosperity, celebrity, or disaster. Martin Scorsese, John
Cassavetes, Sidney Lumet, Spike Lee, Woody Allen, Abel Ferrara, Bob
Fosse, and a hundred B-movie directors have walked the Deuce, where
promise of romance, the fear of the unknown, and the wrong place at any
time have inspired the genres of drama, musicals, and comedy. Scorsese
shot Mean Streets primarily in Los Angeles, but that film, like 42nd Street,
never lost its edge. It is the attitude—tough, funny, abrasive, crude, and
elegant, it is the one place on the planet that is the litmus test to prove
whether you can make it there, and so then, anywhere.
Cinematic technique is applied to 42nd Street for expressive purposes.
The crane shots shake, the montage is spit out, and the art direction is
background for the human drama; the naked rehearsal stage and squalid
backstage is home. 42nd Street is a documentary fantasy, as if the dames
and con men, the gents, the regular Joes, the shop girls who read
Photoplay, the hustler hawking for a buck, and the street cops could all
sing and dance.
An American Musical • 147
42nd Street is a backstage musical, a story about show people: their de-
sires, fights for survival, the tedium of their lives, the parties, the endless
auditions and practice, and the ever-changing cast of lovers, moneymen,
stage managers, chorus boys and girls. Abner Dillion (Guy Kibbee) is a
kiddie-car magnate who backs the play to wine and dine Dorothy Brock
(Bebe Daniels), a star who in turn is really in love with Pat Denning
(George Brent), a performer with less luster. The fresh face kid Peggy
Sawyer, a babe in the woods surrounded by cynical pros who have seen
it all, becomes romantically involved with Billy Lawler (Dick Powell), one
of Broadway's better juveniles. Marsh's right-hand man, Andy Lee
(George E. Stone), is a yes man with a pencil mustache, who keeps things
moving and is a father figure, brother, best friend, lover boy, diplomat,
and taskmaster all rolled into one. Thomas Barry (Ned Sparks) and Mac
Elroy (Allen Jenkins), curmudgeons always cracking wise, are permanent
members of the Broadway grind. The songs by Harry Warren and Al
Dubin are the score to Pretty Lady, performed in the context of the show
as it is rehearsed and at the end, performed at its premiere. No one breaks
into song as part of the narrative development in 42nd Street. The film au-
dience watches as Marsh shapes what the temperamental director con-
siders a leaky musical into an entertainment machine that never quits. As
he directs the show, Marsh perpetually chain-smokes cigarettes, rubs the
back of his neck, scowls, gives speeches, throws out routines, and drives
the cast to the breaking point. When he gives them an hour break or sends
them home for a night's rest, he demands that they relax.
42nd Street perpetuates the myth of the director as dictator beating his
cast and crew into submission. Marsh gives several tear 'em down, build
'em up speeches that are among the finest of the backstage genre. He is
a no-nonsense man without agendas. He does not party, does not pick a
chorus girl to share his bed each night. All he cares about—more accu-
rately, obsesses over—is the work. Julian Marsh is not only the prototype
for Bob Fosse or Joe Gideon as a genius slave driver, he is Hollywood's
image of the director as a force of nature. As Marsh, always ready to ex-
plode, twists himself into his hardwood chair on the precipice of the
stage, his presence on the screen is a tribute to Otto Preminger, Cecil B.
DeMille, Joseph von Sternberg, and Eric von Stroheim. Warner Baxter in-
habits all these men. His Julian Marsh is the life-blood of show business.
The stars achieve celebrity, but it is the director, the man you love to hate,
the entertainment machine that lives on sawdust, about whom the leg-
ends are written.
42nd Street was directed by Lloyd Bacon (1890-1955; Knute Rockne All
American, Give My Regards to Broadway), who handled the dialogue scenes.
148 • Becoming Film Literate
The Julian Marsh behind Julian Marsh's extravagant, glitzy, and delight-
fully excessive vision was Hollywood's choreographic genius, the one
and only Busby Berkeley (1895-1976).
Berkeley was a stage baby—his father was a theater director and his
mother was an actress of the boards and the screen. When he was three,
Busby's family moved to New York; at five, the boy made his debut as a
stage performer. Schooling at a military academy and service in World
War I as a field artillery lieutenant instilled in Berkeley the discipline and
precision he would later bring to his innovative work in film. By the end
of the Roaring Twenties, Busby Berkeley was known on Forty-second
Street as one of Broadway's best dance directors—a reputation he shared
with the fictional Julian Marsh. Samuel Goldwyn brought Berkeley to
Hollywood in 1930 to choreograph musical sequences featuring the
mogul's star, Eddie Cantor. In 1933, he began to work at Warner Broth-
ers, where Berkeley was empowered with the technology and the tech-
nicians to realize his vision of that seminal American decade.
Two major forces pulled America out of the misery of the Great De-
pression: President Franklin Delano Roosevelt and the Hollywood dream
factory. For the suffering, public entertainment was a powerful healer. On
the giant screen they could see glamour and beauty and for a few hours
could escape from poverty, joblessness, soup kitchens, and a broken econ-
omy.
During the 1930s, Busby Berkeley seized the time and did more than
just distract his countrymen. His delirious, extravagant, sexy, frenetic, and
decadent concoctions raised the spirits and contributed to the delightfully
vulgar American pop culture. His metaphor was a celebration of the pop-
ulace. The production numbers in 42nd Street are filled with a procession
of humanity, configured in rows and circles moving in every direction of
the compass. Going beyond the individual, past the pair to the masses
was part of Berkeley's more-is-more philosophy.
The "Shuffle off to Buffalo" number in 42nd Street is set in a sexually
provocative context. The young marrieds are on a honeymoon train to
Niagara Falls. As they skip through the cars, the packed train of the ini-
tiated smirk and chirp at the innocents, knowing what will come next.
The number appears to be light and innocent, but there is erotic intensity
when from behind the curtains of their berth the bride extends her arm
to put her shoes out onto the train hall floor. With her arm up and fully
extended, holding her shoe, Berkeley intimates the sexual rapture behind
the curtain.
Berkeley is most associated with female dance configurations in ab-
stract geometric patterns. Here his concept is stark black and white and
An American Musical • 149
ican musical, applied the idea boldly in Taxi Driver. D. W. Griffith may re-
ceive most of the credit for the close-up and other aspects of movie gram-
mar, but the top shot, also known as God's point of view, or an overhead,
is pure cinema.
42nd Street speaks to our primal desires to make it big, to get that one
big chance. The movies are an expression of the individual and a gift to
the masses. Julian Marsh is the voice that tells us there is nothing nobler
than giving yourself to your art for the sake of others.
Read
Hollywood Musicals: The Film Reader by Steven Cohan
42nd Street (BFI Film Classics) by J. Hoberman
The American Musical Film Song Encyclopedia by Thomas S. Hischak
Our Musicals, Ourselves: A Social History of the American Theater by John Bush
Jones and Sheldon Harnick
Can't Help Singin': The American Musical on Stage and Screen by Gerald Mast
22
The modern era of moviemaking in the United States began after the
mighty classical Hollywood studio era came to a close during the 1960s.
As a movement, the American New Wave of the 1970s produced the next
generation of filmmakers, who applied an evolved aesthetic to content
derived from a rapidly changing social and political culture.
In 1969, the last year of the Aquarian decade, three American films, Easy
Rider, Midnight Cowboy, and The Wild Bunch (see chapter 49) implanted re-
productive seeds to generate what became filmmaking's second golden
age. This trio of films challenged the moral code of the traditional school
by altering motion picture vocabulary to bring once taboo screen subjects
to realization.
Many complex factors merge to form an artistic epoch. The most au-
dacious and controversial works receive the lion's share of attention and
reputation for their pioneering accomplishments, but it is the total appli-
cation of a nascent aesthetic to the standard mode of operation that pro-
duces a quantitative and lasting transformation. The French Connection
(1971) could have been another cop and gangster film if it followed tra-
ditional conventions in its approach to narrative, visualization, and struc-
ture. By applying a new language and style to what, on the surface,
seemed familiar, The French Connection became a model of the new cin-
ema; this cinema produced movies for general release, popular films that
honestly reflected the age in which they were created.
152 • Becoming Film Literate
The genesis of The French Connection was the true-life story of New York
narcotics detectives Eddie Egan and Sonny Grosso, who made the largest
heroin bust of their era. In 1968, author Robin Moore chronicled these
events in a nonfiction book. Through an unusual series of events that in-
cluded signatures on a cocktail napkin by an industrious third party, pro-
ducer Philip D'Antoni (Bullitt, The Seven-Ups) acquired the film rights for
The French Connection and was bankrolled by 20th-century Fox.
D'Antoni chose thirty-five-year-old William Friedkin as director. The
producer considered Friedkin's impressive documentary work an asset
for a film based on a real incident. In addition, the director had completed
two fictional television films and four theatrical features; Good Times, star-
ring Sonny and Cher; The Night They Raided Minsky's; and stage adapta-
tions of Harold Pinter's The Birthday Party and The Boys in the Band,
New York Filmmaking • 153
lighting. Locations were lit to appear as if the practical sources of the sun,
moon, and artificial fixtures provide the illumination. Friedkin rarely
called for more than two takes of a particular shot and the action was ei-
ther improvised or rehearsed in private. The camera operator followed
the actors as the drama unfolded in much the same way as news and non-
fiction footage is captured.
Hollywood traditionally postdubbed sound for scenes shot on location,
but production sound recordist Chris Newman (The Godfather, Amadeus,
The English Patient) brought back a production track that resonated with
the vibrancy of the city.1 It was later sweetened with sound effects that
completed a veritable city soundscape.
Film editor Jerry Greenberg (Kramer vs. Kramer, Scarface [1983], The Un-
touchables) paced The French Connection with a brisk rhythm that balanced
character, motion, and story. His contribution to the chase scene made it
a benchmark of action cutting that continues to influence practitioners of
the genre.
The performances by the entire cast are models of naturalistic acting.
Each character is multidimensional with specific personality traits. Rela-
tionships and emotional drives are defined as are the motivation and in-
tent of these vigorous, flawed, and very genuine screen people. Many of
the background characters are played by nonactors who lived the life of
the actual story, and residents of New York, instead of hired extras, filled
the streets. Conflict and contrast are the stuff of drama. Popeye is in-
stinctive and volatile. Cloudy is morose, loyal, and careful. Boca is ambi-
tious and defiant. Charnier is urbane and crafty. Many action films
contain one-dimensional characters and are powered by nonstop physi-
cal events. The French Connection balances the relationship between char-
acter development and the results of their actions by constantly
investigating how the characters are reacting to their environment and
circumstances.
Before The French Connection, musical scores had functioned primarily
to finesse an audience's emotional reactions and to indicate the mood of
a scene. Don Ellis, a jazz artist known for his experimental approach to
melody and time signatures, created an atmospheric and psychologically
penetrating score for The French Connection. The music is spare and ef-
fective. The score articulates Popeye Doyle's obsessive nature by musi-
cally addressing his thought process as he continually returns to his
mania to catch the bad guys. Ellis also underscores the tensions control-
ling Popeye with a deep-toned riff that is at the same time halting and
relentless.
New York Filmmaking • 155
The "music" of the chase involving a car and an elevated subway train
is the sound of a speeding car, the pounding on wooden tracks, tire
squeals, and a blaring auto horn. A dynamic use of parallel editing jux-
taposes the pursued and the pursuer, emphasizing the cat and mouse
chase, a narrative theme expressed throughout The French Connection, first
on foot, then through hard-charging vehicles. Greenberg cuts back and
forth as congested traffic and the train crew simultaneously complicate
the quests of Doyle and Charnier's henchman, Pierre Nicoli (Marcel Boz-
zuffi). The intercutting keeps both lines of action "alive" by arriving and
returning at just the right dramatic moments. 2 In editing circles this scene
is often compared with the Odessa Steps sequence in Eisenstein's The Bat-
tleship Potemkin (see chapter 5). One of the heart-stopping moments dur-
ing The French Connection chase also involves a mother, child, and a baby
carriage. The Russian montage masterwork belonged to an early era of
cinema, the American montage-style of The French Connection to modern
times, but they are linked by the fertile concept that a collision of shot
units is so much more than a sum of its parts.
In the case, Egan and Grosso made the big bust, but the Frenchman es-
caped to France and was never prosecuted because he had been a resist-
ance fighter with Charles de Gaulle. However, the film ends on an
ambiguous note. As they search for Charnier in the bowels of an aban-
doned ruin on Wards Island, Doyle tells Russo that he has seen the
Frenchman. Doyle charges off, gun in hand, and runs through a doorway
out of camera view. A gunshot rings out—cut to black—and the end cred-
its roll.
Did Doyle get his man? Did Charnier kill Doyle? Was this the begin-
ning of another episode that continues even though the film is over? With
few exceptions the happy ending had always been the backbone of the
American film. The original studio movie moguls had decided long ago
that the resolution of drama was congruous with the victory of democ-
racy over tyranny. That all changed by 1969. Easy Rider and The Wild
Bunch end in slaughter; Midnight Cowboy concludes in death and desola-
tion. The bullet without a discernible target in The French Connection im-
plies that life continues without explanation or justice. The American film
was finally liberated from a convention that prevented movies from being
a mirror of reality, a concept long understood by international cinema.
Before Los Angeles became the industry's capital, moviemaking in
America was located in New York. In Hollywood, New York had been
depicted on soundstages, and occasionally on a brief location visit, the
gritty streets would be transformed into Hollywood gloss. There had al-
156 • Becoming Film Literate
Notes
1. The production sound recordist is responsible for recording the production
track during the shooting of a film. Newman prefers this term to the more com-
monly used production sound mixer. The job is the same. The dialogue and other
sounds produced during the shooting process are recorded. Tracks are not mixed
together. On most productions, several microphones record actors in the scene ei-
ther on separate or multiple tracks at the same level. Mixing occurs near the end
of the postproduction process during the re-recording mix when all the tracks are
blended together to achieve a desired effect.
2. "Alive" is an editing term that refers to keeping all of the characters or ac-
tions active in the mind of the audience by returning to them periodically to show
their relationship to the story and to the other characters as the narrative pro-
gresses.
Read
William Friedkin: Films of Aberration, Obsession, and Reality by Thomas D. Clagett
To Free the Cinema: Jonas Mekas & the New York Underground, edited by David E.
James
Projections 11: New York Film-Makers on Film-Making, edited by Tod Lippy
Celluloid Skyline: New York and the Movies by James Sanders
Hurricane Billy: The Stormy Life and Films of William Friedkin by Nat Segaloff
23
Period Comedy
The General
Buster Keaton and two young friends squat alongside the star of The General,
a Civil War era steam engine train after which this meticulously rendered pe-
riod comedy is named. Courtesy Photofest.
The General. With little distraction, the majority of the film is a chase scene
involving the train in various lengths, configurations, and directions
North and South, with the controlling parties switching between the
Northern army and our lone hero, representing the South. These amaz-
ing sequences are performed live with a real period train that is actually
moving on working tracks. There are no special photographic effects or
plates. The background and foreground are not art directed. The
verisimilitude heightens the thrill of the action and allows the comic ele-
ments to soar just past reality.
Although the Civil War was still a delicate topic in 1927 when The Gen-
eral was released, the film is apolitical. Keaton and his cowriter and codi-
rector Clyde Bruckman, a longtime screenwriting collaborator, turned the
North and South into generic good guys and villains. With Johnnie on
their side, the Confederates are the underdogs with a genteel tradition.
The issue of slavery is never raised. Northerners are portrayed as bad
guys because they steal the Southern train through deception. The Yan-
kees are one-dimensional baddies who are there so Buster can conquer
them with a purity of intent that allows him to be respected and loved
by his hometown.
Although The General is not overtly political, it is certainly one of the
most accurate visual depictions of that historical time. The design of the
film has consistently been compared with Matthew Brady's photography,
the primary documentary record of the Civil War. The interior sets are
typical of the average silent film. There is not much attention to dimen-
sion or texture. The sets look more like theater flats and primarily serve
the purpose of indicating the scene locations. But interiors make up a
small part of The General, which takes place out in the open country, sur-
rounding the tracks on which the train travels. The terrain never smacks
of art direction; every tree, rock, and grain of dirt appears real. A sense
of distance and travel is accomplished by photographing from the mov-
ing train. One of the most remarkable shots in the film, and of the entire
silent era, shows Buster so busy chopping wood to feed the steam engine
that he is unaware there are troops from the North on one side and the
South on the other—on horseback, in wagons, and on foot—speeding to-
ward battle. This shot creates kinetic multidynamic movement and par-
allel action in the fore-, mid-, and background. Within each line of action
there is a multitude of detail specific to the objective of the activity. The
viewers—and only the viewers—are able to see the entire situation that
is really happening on the screen. The result is funny, thrilling, and oddly
real, as if Buster Keaton were in the middle of the actual Civil War. There
does not appear to be any trickery here. The shot plays as if it were vir-
Period Comedy • 161
sides in the war. Johnnie loves his girl and his train. He sets out to de-
fend the honor of both in the name of the Old South.
Many of the set pieces concerning Johnnie and the General are memo-
rable and part of his complex association with his job and his mechani-
cal ally. Two of the most celebrated are when Johnnie sits dejected on a
steel cross-piece connected to the wheels, which rises up and down when
the General is in motion. Lost in his woes, Johnnie is unaware he is trav-
eling and rising up and down until the train enters a tunnel. A perfectly
timed double-take is executed just as the light from the tunnel falls upon
Johnny capping the improbability of his situation. A cannon with a mind
of its own turns from its enemy target toward Johnnie, who, as usual, is
busy with other business when he is in the most danger. This sequence
has forever been associated with the deadpan humor of Buster Keaton.
The General begins whole, but throughout the struggle against the
North, the South's precious transportation equipment reconfigures its for-
mat and changes direction. At times the train may seem to have a mind
and a life of its own—the General is always in command even when its
persistent engineer Johnnie is distracted or presented with overwhelm-
ing challenges. It is hard to imagine that Sam Peckinpah didn't have The
General in mind while planning and executing the spectacular scene in
The Wild Bunch (see chapter 49) in which a bridge is blown up, sending
the pursuing posse, horses, and all into a river. The General's most breath-
taking moment concerns a wooden trestle bridge that is on fire. In one
dramatic extreme full shot, the train, now led by the North, tries to pass
through the burning structure, which can no longer stand. The train de-
rails and plunges a frightening distance down into the drink. There is
nothing funny about this action. The viewer is reminded that Keaton
breaks the comedy contract of always providing good clean fun where it
appears that no one gets really hurt. The General once again becomes a
Civil War film in which there is much at stake.
Keaton was a master visual storyteller. There are very few inter-titles
in The General. Only what is absolutely necessary is presented in brief text.
Many silent films presented dialogue sequences in which the actors
mimed lines translated by the cards. The General cannot completely avoid
this convention, but Keaton's command of cinematic language, portrayal
of action, story, and especially character directly communicate with au-
diences who enjoy spending time in a world that appeared to mirror their
own but was just beyond reality.
In addition to Keaton's surrealist tendencies, he also became a cine-
matic icon of the postmodern film movement in the 1980s and 1990s, in-
fluencing films such as True Stories (David Byrne), Desperately Seeking
Susan (Susan Seidelman), and Stranger Than Paradise (Jim Jarmusch).
Period Comedy • 163
The General and Keaton's body of work clearly fit into several defining
aspects of postmodernism. Keaton struck out against ideology. His film
did not embrace or promote any specific political tract. Keaton was skep-
tical about society's advocacy of high art over popular culture. Although
his films contain sophisticated aesthetic and stylistic concepts, they were
accessible to the populous and were created for a general audience.
Keaton's trademark flat pancake hat belongs to popular culture while
holding a place in the existentialist landscape of Samuel Beckett (Keaton
was featured in Film, the playwright's only foray into the cinema). Buster
Keaton's embrace of hyperreality traces his direct lineage to the post-
modernists. The perfect actualization of reality on film is a simulation of
experience—that is the principal mission of postmodernism. The visual-
ization technique applied by Keaton and Bruckman rejects the montage-
driven frenetic style fashionable at the time. Long shots rather than
close-ups are employed to frame the simulation of the period, the action,
and the comic take on a historical event. It is camera placement that
makes Keaton's visual ideas work, not editing, which here is a delicate
structural device that controls the flow of cinematic events.
The General is a feat of filmmaking and performance that goes beyond
stunt work and a "how did they do that?" attitude from the viewer. It is
a unique blend of realism and vision—an elegy to filmmaking magic
based on mechanical feats of wonder, not chemical or digital wizardry.
Keaton's cinematic vision made the movies dreams to watch while awake.
Read
Keaton by Rudi Blesh
Keaton: The Man Who Wouldn't Lie Down by Tom Dardis
My Wonderful World of Slapstick by Buster Keaton with Charles Samuels
Buster Keaton Remembered by Eleanor Keaton and Jeffrey Vance
Buster Keaton: Cut to the Chase by Marion Meade
24
Parallel Storytelling
Intolerance
The largest, most ornate movie set ever built in Hollywood for just one of
four stories told in parallel during D. W. Griffith's Intolerance. Courtesy
Photofest.
tred, prejudice, love, and compassion throughout the ages. Four stories
are tied together by the image of a young woman (Lillian Gish) rocking
a baby lying in a wooden cradle. The scene is tinted deep blue. A heav-
enly shaft of light halos them as three women cloaked in black sit
hunched over in the background. A preceding card quotes Walt Whitman,
"Out of the cradle endlessly rocking," from his epic poem "Leaves of
Grass." For Griffith, the recurring shot symbolized human pain, passion,
and sorrow. A bound book with the title "Intolerance" slowly opens to
two pages of text signifying that the film story is about to unfold.
The first story takes place in modern day, which at the time of
Intolerance's release was in the teens of the twentieth century. Three fe-
male social reformers interfere with the lives of a young couple as unjust
circumstances lead the man to a life of crime and to leave his wife and
baby destitute, ultimately threatening his very existence by the hang-
man's noose of an uncaring society.
The second story is set in old Jerusalem as Jesus Christ is betrayed and
then crucified. Griffith recalls the spiritual awakening of the Holy Bible's
passion play. The next tale reveals the events leading to the religious
slaughter known as the Saint Bartholomew Massacre in 1572 A.D. in Paris,
France.
The fourth story is the fall of Babylon in 539 B.C. This opulent grandeur
and decadence plays out on one of the most spectacular film sets ever
built. The scale and attention to breathtaking detail of this ancient world
that mirrors the flawed times about which Griffith was moralizing has
become a symbol of the cinema's potential for visual audacity.
Scenes are tinted sepia, blue, magenta, earthy green, and other tones to
delineate a time, mood, or psychological state. Inter-title cards offer ex-
planatory text and dialogue in the tradition of the silent film. Because of
the adventurous and somewhat confusing multilayered narrative, Grif-
fith gave the cards for Intolerance special attention as a means to inform
the audience of time, place, and plot during the time-tripping excursion.
Cards for the Jerusalem segments display a background of a stone tablet
with writings carved in Hebrew. The text for the Babylonian scenes is over
a stone wall topped with chiseled hieroglyphics. Fonts are changed ap-
propriately. Footnotes give data and attest to the supposed historical ac-
curacy of Griffith's research. The open-book pages of "Intolerance"
appear throughout the film as a constant reminder that these many trib-
utaries form one story.
What is behind the director's grand scheme? What motivates a shift in
time in Intolerance? Griffith's idea was to connect the stories much in the
way that they would be connected in the associative annals of the mind.
Parallel Storytelling • 167
Of Further Interest
Screen
The Great Train Robbery (1903)
Kids
Magnolia
Time Code
A Wedding
Read
Story and Discourse: Narrative Structure in Fiction and Film by Seymour Chatman
D. W. Griffith's Intolerance: Its Genesis and Its Vision by William M. Drew
Thinking in Pictures: Dramatic Structure in D. W. Griffith's Biograph Films by Joyce
E. Jesionowski
Story: Substance, Structure, Style, and the Principles of Screenwriting by Robert
McKee
D. W. Griffith: An American Life by Richard Schickel
m
French New Wave
In the 1950s, the influential French film magazine Cahiers du Cinema was
revolutionizing critical thought by expounding on the auteur theory,
which elevated Hollywood studio directors to the exalted status of artists
with aesthetic and thematic vision. The French New Wave began when a
number of these film critics started to make films. When Francois Truf-
faut, Jean-Luc Godard, Eric Rohmer, Claude Chabrol, Alain Resnais,
Jacques Rivette, and others made films that both embraced and rejected
the traditional cinemas of France and America, they reinvented cinematic
grammar and storytelling and inspired change in international motion
pictures. Francois Truffaut's (1932-1984) Jules and Jim (1961) encapsulates
the vitality, daring, and artistic courage typified by the French New Wave.
What created the French New Wave? French film was stagnating. Past
masters had died, gone into retirement, or were hopelessly repeating
themselves. There was a new generation of filmmakers that came from
different backgrounds than their predecessors. As a critic, Francois Truf-
faut understood how great directors like Alfred Hitchcock, Howard
Hawks, and John Ford interpreted themes with images. The innovative
critical work and filmmaking of his French colleagues stimulated a spirit
of adventure and created a climate to grow their work as individuals into
a movement.
A key contributor to any new wave is the cinematographer. New di-
rections require a new look, a different set of aesthetics and conventions.
The American New Wave of the 1970s (which grew out of admiration for
French New Wave • 171
The blocking of the menage et trois of Jules (Oskar Werner, left), Jim (Henri
Serre), and Catherine (Jean Moreau) in Francois Truffaut's Jules et Jim commu-
nicates that the woman represents attraction and independence to the two
smitten lovers. Courtesy Photofest.
three main characters. By reflecting their needs and desires toward each
other, Truffaut examined and explained the changing mores of the 1960s
by revealing a prehistory of a revolution in human relationships.
The principal narrative of Jules and Jim is a simple one from which
emerge complex characters and intricate consequences for all. Jules
(Oskar Werner) and Jim (Henri Serre) both fall in love with Catherine
(Jeanne Moreau), a woman with a mercurial personality filled with pas-
sionate motivations and a swirling disposition totally dedicated to her
needs and desires. Jules and Jim is not just a menage a trois; the relation-
ship among the three is an investigation into the nature of love, sex, re-
spect, individual freedom, the bond between two and three people, and
the strength and fragility of connections.
The key to Truffaut's visualization of the special relationships between
Jules, Jim, and Catherine is in the compositional placement and choreog-
raphy of the three characters within the frame. The actors give penetrat-
ing performances, and the screenplay by Truffaut and Jean Gruault (The
Nun, Le Sex Shop, The Green Room), based on the novel by Henri-Pierre
Roche, provides the motivation and behavior. The staging and blocking
interprets the manner in which Jules, Jim, and Catherine react to each
other, with the camera capturing the way they move, stand and walk as
pairs and as a trio. While bicycling, Jim catches up to Catherine and Jules,
who are ahead of him. Later, Jules asks Catherine to marry him. Next,
while the men ride their bikes together, Catherine is bicycling ahead of
them to signify that she is in control of the relationship of the trio. Two-
shots between Jules and Jim or between one of them and Catherine re-
veal the intimacy between two people, but throughout the film Truffaut
and Coutard make detailed use of the three-shot to track the delicate bal-
ance as Catherine expresses her needs for each friend with very different
limits and expectations. Often Catherine is physically in the lead if they
are photographed in profile. Shots taken directly in front or behind the
three often place Catherine in the center. The former represents her power
over the two men who consider Catherine to possess all that a man looks
for in a woman. The latter is Catherine's message to Jules and Jim that
for her they represent two halves of a whole. Catherine respects Jules's
loyalty and Jim's passionate nature. Jules commits himself totally to
Catherine, but Jim holds onto his relationship to Gilberte (Vanna Urbino).
Ultimately, the two men are symbolic of one man who would fully sat-
isfy the physical and emotional requirements of a complete woman. Jules
and Jim both agree that their attraction to Catherine goes beyond the sur-
face. To these men she is not the most beautiful or intelligent, but she is
French New Wave • 173
a woman. It is that elusive quality and also what a woman wants from a
man that Truffaut explores in Jules and Jim.
The French New Wave set out to create a new language culled from
American and French cinema heroes (Jean Renoir was a major influence)
that visually defined the characters, story, and textural themes. From
D. W. Griffith, Truffaut borrowed the technique of the iris shot, where
part of the image is on screen in a field of black and then the image widens
to fill the screen. The shape of an iris is varied. This technique, associated
with early silent cinema, ties Jules and Jim to earlier film traditions and is
aesthetically appropriate because Truffaut mixes the old and new in the
pre-World War I period film.
Jules and Jim is photographed in a widescreen format that references
black-and-white CinemaScope films of the 1950s. This aspect ratio is also
effective in presenting the three characters in a single locked-off (see
locked-off camera in glossary) or moving shot while anchoring them in
their environment. This especially applies to vital scenes in the country-
side, where they are free to explore their social experiment.
The fluidity and pace of Jules and Jim is linked more to American than
French cinema, but Truffaut departs from Hollywood by relying on a
handheld and moving camera and the rhythm of action and dialogue
rather than montage. The editing punctuates moods and emotional states
with jump cuts, or a series of angles cut together to express the inner life
of the characters. These moments do not interfere with the overall lan-
guid pace of Jules and Jim that establishes the movement of life in an ear-
lier time. Editing accentuates Catherine's independent spirit and the way
Jules and Jim react to her.
Before Steven Spielberg in Jaws and Martin Scorsese in GoodFellas, Truf-
faut and Coutard executed what has come to be known as the vertigo shot,
named after Hitchcock's technique of tracking (see tracking shot in glos-
sary) in and zooming (see zoom lens in glossary) out or vice versa to in-
ject and heighten a sense of uneasy movement in the viewer's mind and
stomach. Truffaut uses this technique as a sign of profound recognition
when Jules and Jim visit the Adriatic Islands and find a statue that re-
minds them of the face of a beautiful woman who later takes the human
form of Catherine.
The French New Wave was a bridge between the classical cinemas of
France and the United States—the evolution of the medium that pro-
gressed throughout the 1960s, resulting in a new generation of filmmak-
ers who flowered in the 1970s. With Jules and Jim, Francois Truffaut
challenged the morality portrayed in traditional cinema and liberated the
174 • Becoming Film Literate
camera from the restrictions of the tripod and studio lights. However, the
dissolve, the classical article of grammar where one image fades in while
another fades out to suggest the passage of time, is used throughout the
film.
In Jules and Jim, the freeze frame is applied in a playful and insightful
manner within the body of the film (a favorite cinematic gesture in a Guy
Ritchie film). Truffaut did not invent the freeze frame with the ending of
The 400 Blows. Frank Capra used this editorial technique in It's a Wonder-
ful Life to stop the action so the narration could comment on the story.
The freeze frame was later used by Scorsese in GoodFellas. Dziga Vertov
employed freeze frames to stop the kinetic action in Man with the Movie
Camera (see chapter 28). The renowned freeze frame of Antoine Doinel,
which ends The 400 Blows, influenced editorial grammar so thoroughly
that it became a popular aesthetic choice for a film's conclusion. By hold-
ing Antoine in our gaze, Truffaut stopped the motion but allowed the
viewer to continue to ponder the boy's future and fate. During a domino
game between Jules and Jim, pans passing by all three characters are
punctuated with freeze frames of Catherine's facial expressions as her al-
ternating moods are contrasted with the exuberance demonstrated by the
men.
Throughout Jules and Jim, a third-person narrator was woven in be-
tween scenes and when Truffaut found it necessary to switch to an in-
formed observer's point of view. The narration anoints Jules and Jim with
a literary voice to connect the film to its novelistic origin. The narrator is
able to supply information and insights that the characters and action
cannot. The voice of the narrator becomes linked with the musical score
as an interlude to bridge time and to understand the emotional roller-
coaster of feelings that shift constantly through the intricacy of the trio's
relationships. The narrator is another reference to the cinema of the past,
a favorite device of classical Hollywood movies, combined with the dar-
ing aesthetic technique that defined the French New Wave.
The performances by Oscar Werner, Henri Serre, and Jeanne Moreau
are fresh and real. The approach to acting represents a rejection of Hol-
lywood movie star gloss and the mannered plunging of emotions found
in the method style (see chapter 32). The performances emphasize the
range of emotions conveyed with the complicated love relationships
shared between the characters. All three actors are specific in their por-
trayals while demonstrating a sense of fun, romantic spontaneity, and the
sixties Zeitgeist that drove the New Wavers during this period. Werner
and Serre are absolutely convincing as two very different men who share
friendship and love. Moreau achieves exactly what Jules and Jim say
French New Wave • 175
Of Further Interest
Screen
Breathless (1959)
The 400 Blows
Last Year at Marienbad
My Night at Maud's
Zazie in the Underground
Read
Truffaut: A Biography by Antoine De Baecque and Serge Toubiana
Screening the Text: Intertextuality in New Wave French Cinema by T. Jefferson Kline
The French New Wave: An Artistic School by Michel Marie
The New Wave: Truffaut, Godard, Chabrol, Rohmer, Rivette by James Monoco
A History of the French New Wave Cinema by Richard Neupert
m
The Epic
Lawrence of Arabia
enemy, his troops made it into Damascus, a strategic stronghold, but even
at this moment of victory the fragile coalition crumbled into a bitter, frac-
tured alliance, and French and British concerns prevented Lawrence's
dream of a united Arab nation from materializing. T. E. Lawrence retired
from the military and declined all decorations.
The themes of Lawrence's life and those explored by Lean in the film
are epic: claiming a homeland, the search for ethnic and personal iden-
tity, the power of an empire, peace, war, the impact of violence on the in-
dividual, the nature of dissent, the impossibility of unity, the cult of
personality, and the sweep of history.
The 217-minute running time of narrative (227 minutes including the
overture, Entr'acte during the intermission, and exit music for its initial
roadshow release) gave David Lean and his scenarists Robert Bolt (Dr.
178 • Becoming Film Literate
Zhivago, A Man for All Seasons, The Mission) and Michael Wilson (The
Bridge on the River Kwai, Planet of the Apes, Che!) a large enough canvas to
explore a story that demanded breadth. The story structure embraces
Lawrence's single-minded mission, driving himself away from the proper
British tradition, and obsessively and methodically bringing fractious,
warring Arab tribes together in solidarity to overthrow the Turkish Em-
pire. The narrative is carefully constructed. The time compression is so
well planned that the combination of character, exposition, action, and
transition scenes modulate across the running time, which is almost twice
the length of an average feature of the time. What could have been an un-
wieldy, repetitive story instead is finely tuned entertainment with pur-
pose and bold showmanship.
Through careful collaboration and supervision of the fine screenplay,
David Lean emerged with a blueprint he would visualize in a grand man-
ner worthy of his grand subject. Staging and filming in desert locations
present so many technical and logistical problems that earlier filmmak-
ers had avoided going and settled for studio art-directed sand or location
terrain just outside of civilization. Lean knew that approach could never
capture or represent the vastness of a Middle Eastern total desert envi-
ronment and shot all the desert sequences on location.
Lean took on this enormous challenge with cinematographer Freddie
Young (Goodbye Mr. Chips, Treasure Island, Solomon and Sheba), whom Lean
had met when he was an editor. Their relationship continued through
every Lean film save A Passage to India when Freddie Young's advancing
age made the grueling process too difficult for him. David Lean directed
every shot of Lawrence of Arabia; there was no second unit. Lean was in
on the planning and execution of each shot. Young was the ideal cam-
eraman for Lean. He was one of England's most accomplished photog-
raphers and a confident man who relished an intense relationship with a
meticulous director.
David Lean wanted the desert to have the pink tinge that sand masses
reflect in intense sunlight. He envisioned the microscopic sharpness he
could see as billions of individual grains of sand-formed dunes, waves,
and a bed of glistening grains as far as the eye could see. Lean decided
Lawrence of Arabia would be photographed in 65mm. To achieve a greater
definition of the image, Lean and Young used the 70mm film stock de-
veloped for the Panavision cameras used on the production, which pro-
duced a much finer grain pattern than standard 35mm film. The
wide-screen format would give him the perfect compositional structure
for the epic form, and the horizontal width that stretched out across the
The Epic • 179
large screen was what he needed to create shots full of space, detail, and
the landscape of legend.
The experience of life in a desert with the hot, glaring sun beating down
created a mirage—the illusion of a shimmering, liquidy reflection that can
be seen by the human eye but doesn't really exist. As Freddie Young was
going through the Panavision equipment at their plant, he came upon a
500mm lens. The compression captured by the long lens would create the
mirage effect on film. In practice, the lens was photographing the long
distance between the camera position and the subject and shooting
through layers of air, dust, sand, and light reflections that cause a mirage
when the sun is at a particular intensity. In the desert Young observed
that mirages appeared at the hottest time of every day, so those sequences
were planned accordingly.
The first mirage sequence ever put on film is the spectacular entrance
of Sherif Ali ibn el Khrarish (Omar Sharif), who appears as if from infin-
ity on his camel and slowly and steadily rides up to defend the water
well of his tribe. Sharif was 1,000 feet from the camera and ten minutes
of a continuous take was shot, concluding with him at the well. Carefully
planned cutaway shots and the environmental sounds that include the
steady clip-clopping of the camel's hoofs all combined to give the viewer
a desert mirage experience that added a magical quality to Ali's charac-
ter and demonstrated the illusion of space and time in an environment
place without boundaries.
The desert sequences in Lawrence of Arabia are absolutely breathtaking.
The technical problems that confront a movie company filming in the
middle of a desert are enormous. The cameras were constantly in repair;
sand penetrated everything. Maintaining the natural surface of the sand
for each shot involved teams of workers rolling and smoothing out vast
areas. Logistics were critical in keeping the large cast and crews from soil-
ing zones that were supposed to look virginal. The sun was so hot dur-
ing the day that cameras constantly had to be cooled down, and nights
were so cold that warming blankets were utilized to keep the delicate
equipment from freezing.
It has been said that a David Lean film expresses love for the camera.
He was a visualist of the highest order, but the images were there to serve
the story. Lawrence was a passionate and iconoclastic man brought up in
proper British tradition who fell deeply in love with the desert and had
an obsession with the Arab cause. This led Lean to a mise-en-scene that
always connected Lawrence to his environment. The vast desert is an
awesome sight, especially to Western audiences. If a forest or an ocean
180 • Becoming Film Literate
these two images is far more complex editorially than it looks on the sur-
face. When do you exit the first shot and enter the next? Do you cut right
on the blow out or find the spot as Coates does to blow us to, not just cut
to, the next shot? When should the sun rise—right on the cut, or later? If
later, as it is in the film, how much so? Just long enough to give the viewer
the experience of watching the sun rise on Lawrence's first time in his
beloved desert. Coates gives Lawrence of Arabia pace, context, and the per-
fect rhythm for each scene. The editorial style, some of which originates
from the screenplay, is filled with time cuts. Coates takes us from one
place in this massive story to the next, never overstaying her welcome or
leaving too soon.
David Lean achieved an epic grandeur in Lawrence of Arabia by or-
chestrating all of the narrative, character, and craft elements, which were
painstakingly chosen, detailed, developed, and then choreographed
within the camera's frame. Shot by shot, Lawrence of Arabia is beautiful
and perfect.
The legacy of Lawrence of Arabia is deep. It is an Oscar champion, con-
sistently on critics' lists. The film inspired the American New Wave of the
1970s and is responsible for motivating the modern blockbuster, the Hol-
lywood holy grail founded by Steven Spielberg and George Lucas.
David Lean made his films with concrete cinematic elements that are
no longer practical or affordable. The romance and adventure of Lawrence
of Arabia is solid, not electronic smoke and mirrors. David Lean may be
the last film director who went out and made movies. He started in the
confines of an editing room, but the film frame led him to exotic places.
Lawrence of Arabia is a timeless film created in the classical manner. Its
well-made screenplay, forceful performances, and consummate craft rep-
resent a unique set of aesthetics. It is not a consumer product or digital
wizardry to amuse. Lawrence of Arabia will live on forever because it
makes us forget film as a business while we are in awe of its art.
Of Further Interest
Screen
Ben Hur (1959)
The Bridge on the River Kwai
The Fall of the Roman Empire
How the West Was Won
Spartacus
182 • Becoming Film Literate
Read
David Lean: A Biography by Kevin Brownlow
Lawrence of Arabia: A Film's Anthropology by Steven C. Canton
Sam Spiegel by Natasha Fraser-Cavassoni
The Hollywood Epic by Foster Hirsch
Lawrence of Arabia: The Official 30th Anniversary Pictorial History by Robert L.
Morris and Lawrence Raskin
m
The Political Thriller
In a pretitle sequence that takes place in Korea, 1952, a unit of U.S. sol-
diers are set up by a Communist spy and captured. Unconscious, the men
are airlifted out of the area. After the titles, a solemn narrator (see nar-
ration in glossary) explains that Raymond Shaw (Lawrence Harvey) is to
receive the Congressional Medal of Honor for saving the lives of his unit
while under enemy attack. When Bennett Marco (Frank Sinatra) is
plagued by sweaty nightmares that recall distorted pieces of his tampered
memory, he begins to understand that there is something very wrong
with Raymond Shaw. When Marco is asked how he feels about his ser-
geant, he goes into a trance and is compelled to say, "Raymond Shaw is
the kindest, warmest, bravest, most wonderful human being I've ever
known in my life," even though rationally he states that Shaw was in-
tensely disliked and unloved.
The Political Thriller • 185
The programming of the men, who were swept off the battlefield as
part of a fiendish Communist plot to manufacture an assassin, relies on
convincing others, especially in Washington, D.C., that Shaw was so
revered that he would be above suspicion. The incongruity of that senti-
ment sparks an investigation that uncovers Shaw as a perfect killing ma-
chine who will murder at the will of his operators.
Shaw appears to behave with free will, but he has been rewired to obey
commands as if he were an automaton when he hears the phrase "Ray-
mond, why don't you pass the time by playing a little solitaire." Shaw
then methodically plays the solitary game, a metaphor for a lone assas-
sin, a role that has been designated for him. When the red Queen of Di-
amonds appears, a mental switch is thrown and Shaw is left without free
will. He will do as he is told regardless of his personal morality. This trig-
ger is narrative, word-driven, and provocatively visual. The film is in
black and white, but the deadly significance of the red Queen's appear-
ance throughout the film plays as vivid red in the viewer's imagination.
The color red dominates The Manchurian Candidate. The red stripes of the
American flag represent the fanatical patriotism that threatens democracy
in the hands of the villains. It is also a symbol of Communism, an ideo-
logical force dedicated to crushing the American system. Red, of course,
also signifies the blood of the victims murdered at the hand of the brain-
washed Raymond. During a demonstration of the brainwashing shown
in flashback, Raymond coldly shoots to death the company "mascot," a
young soldier. The blood (most likely chocolate syrup, the substance of
choice at the time for blood in a black-and-white film) splatters all over
a poster of Joseph Stalin. The result of Raymond's horrible act is more
terrifying when shown as if it were a detail of a Jackson Pollock painting,
and like the recurring red Queen, it registers as red in the mind's eye be-
cause in human experience we know blood is red. 1 The Manchurian Can-
didate, like Psycho (see chapter 34), would have been unbearable in color.
The black-and-white images are able to directly translate to color through
the viewer's recollection of emotional life experiences.
Variations on the red Queen theme build the tension and intensify the
drama. Jocie Jordon (Leslie Parish), the love of Raymond's life, comes
back to him even though his mother's evil machinations had kept them
apart. Drawing this development into her heinous plans, the mother ma-
nipulates Jocie to wear a Queen of Diamonds outfit at a costume ball. The
visual image of Jocie standing with the huge card across her body height-
ens the sense of impending crisis. The operatives employ a magician's
deck of cards that to the eye looks like a standard pack of fifty-two, ex-
cept every other card is cut to a slightly smaller size and has the same
186 • Becoming Film Literate
face so that the magician can always identify the right card. This trick
deck can be purchased in a wide range of choices for the duplicate. Here
it is the Queen of Diamonds, a symbol for the domineering mother he de-
spises to ensure that Raymond will get to the prompt card and go into
his trance quickly. When Marco attempts to deprogram Raymond, his
most powerful tool is to fan out all the Queen of Diamond cards. The im-
pact of seeing the platoon of trigger cards could be the final short-
circuiting of the evil mechanism inside Raymond. The ending of the film
both confirms and points to a deeper psychological issue operating in
Raymond when his anger is finally turned toward the genuine source of
his pain.
The trigger line about solitaire is not always under the total control of
the operatives. In one scene Raymond goes to Jilly's (a New York bar
made famous by Sinatra and his Rat Pack cronies). Raymond hears the
bartender inadvertently say the line in conversation with other cus-
tomers. He asks the barkeep for a deck of cards. When Raymond sees the
red Queen he hears the bartender, who while telling patrons a story says
a phrase about jumping in a lake. Obeying the command, Raymond goes
off to Central Park and does so. Marco follows him. This advances the
plot in making contact between Marco and Shaw and establishing that
something is very wrong.
The villain of The Manchurian Candidate is Raymond's mother, played
to perfection by Angela Lansbury. She is Raymond's American operative.
Her plan unfolds like the concoction of a most elaborate assassination
buff. She has sacrificed her son, who hates her. This makes Raymond sus-
ceptible to brain laundering and makes the Queen the perfect
symbol-stimuli. His mother's second husband is Senator John Iselin (John
Gregory), an alcoholic nobody who allows his brilliant and commanding
wife to shape him as a political demigod. Iselin is a totally undisguised
representation of Senator Joseph McCarthy, the red-baiting senator whose
abuse of power and finger-pointing lit the match for the dreaded black-
listing era, one of America's darkest moments as a democracy. Iselin ac-
cuses the innocent of being Communist spies, always bellowing names,
numbers, and threats. His campaign is televised and black-and-white
monitors are filled with images right out of McCarthy's reign of terror.
And then there are those words, "Point of order, point of order," a mantra
for the senator known as tail-gunner Joe, which grabs the attention of a
duped American public. Iselin is positioned to receive the nomination for
vice president of the United States. Raymond's mission is to assassinate
the presidential nominee during the convention so Iselin can step in, rally
the party, and become president under control of the Chinese and Rus-
The Political Thriller • 187
sians. But Raymond's mother resents that she has been taken advantage
of. As a Communist disguised as a right-wing zealot, she was forced to
destroy her relationship with her son. When she realizes she has been
suckered, her plan becomes to get Iselin into the Oval Office so she can
hunt down and destroy her former comrades for revenge.
The principal performances are riveting. Sinatra is tough, vulnerable,
human, and heroic as Marco. Laurence Harvey is mesmerizing as the ill-
fated Raymond Shaw. His handsome, fine-lined face is haunted with fa-
milial pain and the zombielike trance over which he has no control. He
is an unloved man and is devastated that he has been denied happiness.
Viewers who only know Angela Lansbury from her hit television series
Murder She Wrote are in for a rude awakening. This first-class actress por-
trays pure evil. The complex character uses diplomacy, power, manipu-
lation, and deception for the means to her objective to control the United
States government and strike back at her enemies around the world.
James Gregory has done his homework in bringing a perfect portrait of
the McCarthyite senator, a drunk, led by the nose by other concerns, a
man of no conscience and only blind ambition.
John Frankenheimer had been a tireless voice against the blacklist. Al-
though not directly affected by the scourge himself, The Manchurian Can-
didate gave him a direct potshot at the absurdity and danger of what the
morally bankrupt senator had done to his country. For his film Seconds,
Frankenheimer hired many blacklisted actors and crew members well be-
fore other producers and directors were doing so.
Raymond's purpose is to assassinate a presidential nominee. The
Manchurian Candidate was released in 1962, a year before the assassina-
tion of President John F. Kennedy changed America forever. This context
makes The Manchurian Candidate even more fertile. It is more than just a
good thriller but approaches art in making a statement about the violent
nature of the country and the fragility of democracy, a theme Franken-
heimer would explore again in his next film, Seven Days in May, about an
attempted coup d'etat by the U.S. military.
The Manchurian Candidate is not always solemn, but peppered with gal-
lows humor. When Raymond shoots his boss, a powerful newspaper
magnate, the man is in his bedroom dressed in his wife's fuzzy night-
gown. This absurdity makes the killing tragic and nuanced. The man ex-
plains he is wearing it because the garment is warm but the cross-dressing
point is made as well as the ridiculous image of a powerful media giant
wearing feathers. Raymond shoots Jocie's father, Senator Thomas Jordan
(John McGiver), a political enemy of Iselin, through a milk carton the man
is holding in front of his chest. In such a highly charged movie about the
188 • Becoming Film Literate
American way, milk is the perfect symbol for the purity of the country. It
also replaces a bloody moment with an ironic one. Then Frankenheimer
turns the film back into high drama as Jocie enters and is also shot to
death by Raymond. A two-shot of father and daughter lying dead on the
floor is sobering and a sign that Raymond may be beyond the point of
no return. Jocie was the love of his life and her father was a role model
of a caring parent, a fact of life denied to Raymond.
The final sequence resonates with the dark side of American history.
Raymond is given his command to assassinate the presidential nominee.
He is in a perch high up in New York's Madison Square Garden, where
the convention is being held. Raymond is dressed as a priest so that he
will not be noticed. There is the irony of a man of the cloth wielding a
rifle. He is shown from many perspectives—inside looking down and
from the floor looking up. A point of view angle through the rifle scope
is the most disturbing, and it is through this shot that the shocking cli-
max occurs. After 1963 it was impossible to watch The Manchurian Can-
didate without striking an emotional connection with the list of leaders
who were taken down by the assassin's bullet.
The Manchurian Candidate is a film to be studied for the physical ex-
citement generated by director and production designer. There are stat-
ues and images of Lincoln strategically aligned with Iselin to disguise his
fascist nature. Senator Jordan has a large spread-eagle plaque over his
fireplace. At one point when he stands, it appears that the wings are com-
ing out of the sides of his body. His character embodies liberty. The am-
phitheater where the brainwashing exhibition took place and the
solarium for the hotel garden party were two sets on real railroad tracks,
which allowed for a 360-degree pan to go from one set to another with-
out cutting the camera. The detailing in the interiors is rich and reflects
the political power of the characters. There are several variations of wood-
paneled walls, arches, elegant decor, and old American style.
The Manchurian Candidate is the model for the contemporary political
thriller. It is intelligent, pregnant with meaning, and sheds insight on the
fragility of a democratic society. John Frankenheimer was a director with
a strong social conscience. He was politically astute and a natural-born
filmmaker. He entertained and sent a message. It did not come from West-
ern Union, as the old saw goes. When John Frankenheimer wanted to
send a message, he made a movie that was entertaining and that made
you think. He believed that the cinema should reflect society and em-
braced the notion that movies should move—in every sense of that word.
The Political Thriller • 189
Notes
1. Jackson Pollock (1912-1956) was an action painter who splattered, dripped,
and poured paint as he stood above the painting surface on the floor.
Of Further Interest
Screen
Fail Safe
Patriot Games
Saboteur
Seven Days in May
State of Siege
Read
John Frankenheimer: A Conversation with Charles Champlin by Charles Champlin
The Thriller; the Suspense Film from 1946 by Brian Davis
The Suspense Thriller: Films in the Shadow of Alfred Hitchcock by Charles Derry
The Cinema of John Frankenheimer by Gerald Pratley
The Films of Frankenheimer: Forty Years in Film by Gerald Pratley and John
Frankenheimer
28
Self-Referential Cinema
The cinema has always been fascinated with itself. There are countless
films about the making of a movie—The Bad and the Beautiful, Contempt,
Day for Night, Day of the Locust, Boogie Nights, The Last Movie, and Alex in
Wonderland—or those concerned with the film business—The Big Knife,
The Last Tycoon, and Barton Fink.
Audiences are lured to these films because they appear to show the
backstage glamour and drama associated with moviemaking as well as
insights into the process. Some of these films are truthful and perceptive,
others are not, but all use the narrative and aesthetic techniques consis-
tent with the traditional mode of filmmaking.
Since the 1970s, filmmakers have referenced or quoted other films by
recreating a shot, repeating dialogue, or replicating visual characteristics.
This practice has been a dominant stylistic element in the films of Peter
Bogdanovich, Martin Scorsese, Brian DePalma, and Quentin Tarantino.
An entirely different movement is the self-referential film, a cinematic
work that refers to itself. A self-referential film is not about the making
of another film—it is concerned with the one that is currently being
watched by the viewer. One such film is The Projectionist, which incorpo-
rates the concept of a daydream film within a film to capture the fantasy
life of the main character. Morgan Fisher's Standard Gauge examines the
very physical properties of motion pictures.
Man with a Movie Camera (1929) is an early and daring experiment in
self-referential cinema. Dziga Vertov (1896-1954) brings two concepts to-
Self-Reterential Cinema • 191
gether—his celebration of the cinema and the workers of his country, the
U.S.S.R. This nonnarrative, nonfiction, avant-garde film follows an in-
trepid motion picture cameraman as he carries his camera and tripod to
film city life in Moscow, Kiev, and Odessa.
Man with a Movie Camera also fits into the critical classification of a city
symphony—films that present the characteristics of life in a specific me-
tropolis within the structure of a day from morning to night. This move-
ment began during the 1920s. Along with Man with a Movie Camera,
Nothing but the Hours, directed by Alberto Cavalcanti, and Walter
Ruttmann's Berlin: Symphony of a Big City are considered classics of the
form.
Vertov celebrates filmmaking by making the man with the movie cam-
era a heroic figure. Undaunted, he takes his camera high and low to cap-
ture the vitality in front of his lens. Socialism is the subject matter here:
192 • Becoming Film Literate
happy productive workers at the job, at play, keeping physically fit, and
moving effortlessly by means of the state's active transportation system.
Is Man with a Movie Camera a propaganda film or the reflections of an
enthusiastic citizen? Both apply. For Vertov, the film was a manifesto for
a cinema empowered with the responsibility of capturing life through the
nature of the medium. Man with a Movie Camera is not a documentary.
The images are poetic and captured with cinematic innovation. Man with
a Movie Camera opens as a day-in-the-life-of-a-city film is about to be
shown in a movie theater. Wooden chairs magically open by themselves
through a form of stop-motion photography, an audience files in, and we
see the projectionist ready himself for the show. The sparking of an arc
allows the projector to present images through light on the screen, which
is the movie being made by the cameraman. At the conclusion of Man
with a Movie Camera, Vertov again returns to the movie theater to show
the film ending on the screen. The last image is an eye reflected in the
camera lens that signifies that the camera is all-seeing.
During Man with a Movie Camera, as the man is shown filming the city,
an editor begins to go through what is supposedly the footage being shot.
She catalogs, cuts, and splices the film. The concept that the film we are
watching is being edited by this on-screen editor ratchets up the self-
referential intentions.
As seductive and exhilarating as this notion becomes, there is another re-
ality taking place here. Another man with a movie camera, the one who is
not visible to the audience is photographing the man with the movie cam-
era as he appears to shoot the film we are watching. With the exception of
point of view shots that are editorially linked to the on-screen cameraman's
actions, this is an illusion. The editor could not possibly be editing what
we see on the screen in real time. It is the result of detailed intercutting
that creates the relationship between the shots of the on-screen editor ed-
iting and the edited footage presented in Man with a Movie Camera.
The day is organized in sequences that depict the movement of the city
as it goes through a daily cycle. At first the city is at rest. The man with
the movie camera is visualized on screen, but in reality Vertov and his
chief cameraman and brother, Mikhael Kaufman (Kinoglaz, Moscow, Odin-
nadtsatyj), show empty streets, a trolley depot, machinery at rest, and
empty shops. A surreal quality is achieved by several images of dolls or
mannequins on display. They represent the culture and the omnipresence
of the Soviet worker.
Intercutting and montage techniques create editing patterns to connect
several categories or movements of action at the same time. A young
woman is asleep, then wakes and readies herself for the day while the
Self-Referential Cinema • 193
city slumbers, then begins to come alive for the day as shops begin to
open. This editorial relationship personalized the film by allowing the au-
dience to relate to the woman's morning ritual of washing and dressing
while linking her to the city and the masses, made up of other individu-
als who gather, work, and play in the city.
It is the choice of what to shoot and the order and rhythm in which the
shots are edited that creates the cinematic experience of the man with the
movie camera being omnipresent as the day progresses. A factory se-
quence stresses the harmony between the mechanical and the human.
Machine parts spin, pump, and revolve. Workers start up and maintain
the machines. A rapid montage of a woman forming cigarette packages
by a series of manipulations depicts her dexterity, efficiency, contribution
to society, and her pride as a Soviet worker. Vertov uses associations to
connect ideas. The on-screen film editor has similar qualities. She per-
forms her job with great speed and purpose. The former serves the So-
viet people and industry. The latter supports art and history by becoming
part of the documentation process in this vital social and political order.
This sequence communicates other aspects. Gender equality is stressed
throughout the film. This woman captured on film by Vertov and edited
by Yelizavita Svilova (Kinoglaz, The Fall of Berlin, Parade of Youth) is shown
to possess the ability to slow down and freeze images by her manipula-
tion of the editing process. The slow motion and freeze frames for the
film were accomplished by the cinematographer and the laboratory, but
intercutting of the editor working on strips of film with full shots of those
very frames moving, slowing down, and freezing gives the impression
that the editing produces this result. The speed in which the editor se-
lects and splices shots creates the illusion that to produce a film with
quick, dynamic editing like Man with a Movie Camera, the editor must
move at the speed of the real-time unfolding of the film.
An effective editorial strategy is establishing an intercutting pattern be-
tween individuals and an action, such as the sequence in which onlook-
ers are shown in close-ups reacting favorably to intercuts of athletes
performing a variety of Olympic decathlon sports. Just when the viewer
feels comfortable that they understand the context, the relationship
changes so the onlookers are now observing and reacting to something
entirely different. This principle is known as the Kuleshov effect after the
Russian filmmaker Lev Kuleshov (Three Day's Life, Taras's Dream, The Great
Consoler), who discovered that intercutting could produce a specific emo-
tional response based on the intended purpose of the filmmaker. The
viewer's own response to the stimuli influences the reaction to a charac-
ter or subject's feelings.
194 • Becoming Film Literate
posite of a Russian city, just another illusion and principle of what the act
of filming and editing motion pictures can create.
Man with a Movie Camera can be seen as a propaganda film, a cinematic
demonstration film, documentary, art film, sociology, anthropology, his-
tory, and a nonnarrative narrative. It is all these and more. Dziga Vertov
was not just ahead of his time; he clearly understood the artistic proper-
ties of the cinema in presenting the point of view of its creator by exam-
ining the aesthetic issues the medium embraced. It may be the first and
only motion picture to attempt to take viewers on an expedition through
the filmmaking process while at the same time they are watching a film.
The mind boggles at the possibilities contained in Man with a Movie Cam-
era. One can only hope that the grand experiment begun by Dziga Ver-
tov will never cease.
Of Further Interest
Screen
Coming Apart
David Holzman's Diary
The Last Movie
The Lickerish Quartet
Standard Gauge
Read
Coming Apart by Milton Moses Ginsberg
The Language of New Media by Lev Manovich
Kino-Eye: The Writings of Dziga Vertov, edited and with an introduction by
Annette Michelson
The Man with a Movie Camera (The Film Companion) by Graham Roberts
Allegories of Telling: Self-Referential Narrative in Contemporary British Fiction by
Lynn Wells
29
Metropolis
Historians have designated The Cabinet of Dr. Caligari (see chapter 10) as
the first German expressionist film and Metropolis (1927) as the last.
Robert Wiene conceived The Cabinet of Dr. Caligari in reaction to the so-
cial and political morass in the Germany of his day and at the beginning
of the German expressionist art movement. As German expressionism
was in gestation, Fritz Lang (1890-1976) was refining his architectural vi-
sion of the cinema. His Wagner films developed lofty themes and pre-
sented the visual power of the masses. In these films, Lang's abilities to
use structural and graphic images emerged and were employed to ad-
vance the narrative and to envisage content on the screen. Metropolis is a
warning about the future—a warning that the brains that create machines
must have a heart for a society to survive. Lang foresaw a Germany
driven by mechanization and was inspired by the accomplishments of
Wiene, F. W. Murnau, and the German expressionist painters to reinvent
science fiction when the cinema was still in its youth. 1 Lang had the nas-
cent technology available—miniatures, superimpositions, glass shots,
and other cinema technology that already existed or was just coming into
use—but it had never been combined for a single purpose. Metropolis is
not just a science fiction film but a film with a message, point of view,
and the visualization to support it and create a cinematic experience that
eight decades later can still astonish.
Lang employs architecture as a means to present and articulate themes
concerning political dominance, caste struggles, the decadence of the
Architecture in Production Design • 197
powerful, the suffering of the underclass, the dangers of science, and the
healing of spiritual power. Metropolis is set in the future, where Art Deco
buildings rise up to the heavens and lofty roadways soar past ultrasky-
scrapers. The city is lorded by Joh Fredersen (Alfred Abel), who oversees
every detail from his massive office, where he give orders to control the
power source that runs electricity, water, transportation, and everything
necessary to provide a productive life for those who live in this metrop-
olis. Fredersen's son Freder (Gustav Frohlich) resides in the Club of the
Sons, located high above the city, where the privileged few exercise in a
stadium worthy of an ancient Greek Olympics and have their pick of fem-
inine delights from a Garden of Eden.
Freder falls in love with Maria (Brigitte Helm), an angelic young
woman who cares for children and secretly gives solace and hope to their
parents, the workers who keep the metropolis vital. Conflict between fa-
198 • Becoming Film Literate
ther and son begins when Freder learns that workers labor in an under-
ground power station and live in dwellings comparable to contemporary
housing projects. Freder goes far below the city, where the workers toil
sweat and blood under brutal, inhumane conditions so that the well-to-
do can live extraordinary, progressive lives. Freder joins the workers in
the cause, and his father turns to the evil Rotwang (Rudolf Klein-Rogge)
to create a clone of Maria (also played by Helm), who turns her spiritual
power and message of hope into a fury of maniacal decadence, so that
Freder sen can retain his dominance over the classes. In a spectacular cli-
max, the workers' city is flooded, but the people are saved when good,
in the form of the true Maria and Freder, triumphs over evil.
The screenplay by Lang and Thea von Harbou (Spione, M, Journey to the
Lost City) provides the thematic context that connects German expres-
sionism in Metropolis to a country speeding towards oblivion. This me-
tropolis is a fascist state in which one man and his perfect race live off
the suffering and sacrifice of others who are offered no choice but to be
loyal slaves to the state. A constant metaphor in Metropolis is that the brain
and the hand must have a mediator—the heart. Maria preaches this to
the oppressed. Joh Fredersen is the brain, actually the authoritarian fig-
ure beholden to the mad genius Rotwang, who performs evil deeds and
provides the leader with the technology to keep the metropolis safe from
a growing resurgent anger. This anger threatens to disrupt the paradise
above the hell of the workers who provide life to the city. When Maria
gives her sermon to the workers and talks about a mediator who will
come and end their misery, she appears to be referring to the coming of
God. Freder becomes an earthly flesh and blood mediator between his fa-
ther and the workers after much destruction leaves the two sides even
further apart. At the conclusion of Metropolis, it is Freder who takes re-
sponsibility for this enormous task and brings his father together with
Grot the Foreman (Henrich George) to fulfill Maria's prophecy. Good and
evil are clearly defined. The ultimate evil is Rotwang's corruption of
Maria's purity by defying God's will and creating a life form dedicated
to destroying the moral will of the people.
Seen today, the visualization of Metropolis is remarkable, a unified vi-
sion of a futuristic world composed of heaven and hell. Like Blade Run-
ner (see chapter 7), Brazil, or Dark City, Metropolis creates a convincing
future city with scope and detail. The workers are dressed in black with
matching caps. They pass through tunnels of low arches and are packed
into massive elevators. Symmetry imprisons the men who work below
the earth. The masses are choreographed to walk slowly, heads down, in
lockstep that causes them to sway right to left, left to right, in the tradi-
Architecture in Production Design • 199
turistic society and a metaphor for biblical prophecy; Lang actually visu-
alized the parable. The prophets of the Tower of Babel are a direct allu-
sion to Fredersen, and the slaves who build the tower refer to the
subterranean workers in the story. This film within the film is as visually
detailed as is all of Metropolis, and it sets the downward spiral of the fu-
ture city in a doomed context. Maria is portrayed as both good and evil.
Her pure beauty glows in one and her sexual depravity reigns in the
other. Fredersen is a character burdened with the weight of his responsi-
bility. As played by Alfred Abel, he is not purely driven by ambition and
lofty ideals. From his very first appearance, he is absorbed by guilt over
the loss of his wife and his inability to love his son unconditionally. This
can be seen in his strong but sad eyes and his furrowed brow. This moral
shading turns the plot in the climax when Freder as the mediator brings
together the head—his father—and the hands—Grot the foreman.
Freder's heart is touched by Maria's devotion to peace and humanity and
the message that only the mediator of the heart could save Metropolis from
the disaster represented by the Tower of Babel.
Lang's understanding of cinema language is masterful. To show the ini-
tial attraction between Maria and Freder, he intercuts (see intercutting in
glossary) full screen point-of-view shots of their faces. Handheld shots
are used to show the chaos of working with the monster machine, and
another point-of-view shot of Freder is dramatically rendered by includ-
ing his outreached arm in the shot so that the viewer experiences life as
this character for the length of the image. Lang moves from big shots of
the city to the smallest human detail with ease, all at his disposal in the
mise-en-scene, which creates the science fiction world of Metropolis and
is a comment on the rise and fall of great societies.
With Metropolis Fritz Lang brought a maddening, expansive vision to
the screen, attempting to tackle philosophic issues of human existence.
He reached out beyond entertainment and traditional drama and em-
ployed the alchemy of the cinema to take us into a future he hoped we
could avoid.
Notes
1. F. W. Murnau (1888-1931) was a German film director who worked in the
German expressionist style in such classics as Nosferatu (1922), The Last Laugh
(1924), and his first American film, Sunrise (1927), considered by many to be not
only one of the finest achievements in silent film history, but possibly the great-
est film of all time. The German expressionist film movement evolved from Ger-
man expressionist painting, which is noted by its favor toward distortion and
exaggeration of color and shape to express the artist's emotional response to his
202 • Becoming Film Literate
Of Further Interest
Screen
Dodsworth
Eclipse
The Fountainhead
The Hudsucker Proxy
Things to Come
Read
Designing Dreams: Modern Architecture in the Movies by Donald Albrecht
Fritz Lang by Lotte Eisner
Fritz Lang: The Nature of the Beast—A Biography by Patrick McGilligan
Film Architecture: Set Designs from Metropolis to Blade Runner, edited by Dietrich
Neumann
Cinema & Architecture: Melies, Mallet-Stevens Multimedia, edited by Francois
Penz, Maureen Thomas
30
Robert Flaherty (1884-1951) was not the first documentarian, but his in-
augural effort in nonfiction filmmaking, Nanook of the North (1922), is con-
sidered to be a starting point for creativity and substance in the genre.
The documentary is a film form governed by many philosophies. From
the beginning theorists and practitioners were divided as to whether doc-
umentary films needed to have a social-political purpose or be the result
of an objective journalistic effort. A search for the truth motivates those
working in nonfiction film. Filming real circumstances is a component of
a nonfiction work, but how real are documentaries? What impact does
the presence of the camera and filmmaker have on the way reality is cap-
tured? How can editing preserve or replicate the truth?
Robert Flaherty was not a trained or experienced filmmaker, but he got
many aspects of the documentary right. The subject of Nanook of the North
evolved out of four major expeditions Flaherty had taken over a period
of years to prospect the region east of the Hudson Bay. This effort began
in 1910, when Sir William Mackenzie contracted Flaherty to explore this
vast area for its potential for railway development and for its natural re-
sources. During these excursions, Flaherty became fascinated with the
survival skills and spiritual strength of the Inuit people, popularly known
as Eskimos.
Flaherty was not an anthropologist or ethnographer. His original intent
was to produce a film for commercial exhibition. In terms of structure and
style, Flaherty felt strongly that his audience would be accustomed to the
204 • Becoming Film Literate
Nanook, an Inuit who fights for survival in a frozen wilderness, is seen here
comforting his son. Robert Flaherty's landmark documentary film proved ma-
nipulation and cheating of reality were necessary to create the illusion of
truth in documentary filmmaking. Courtesy Photofest.
in a narrative departure from what had been seen during the early de-
velopment of the cinema.
Even in the media-savvy world of the twenty-first century, the general
public tends to believe what it sees in nonfiction, including documentary
shorts and features, as well as television news. "Seeing is believing" con-
tinues to be a powerful concept. In understanding Nanook of the North or
any nonfiction work, it is essential to comprehend several critical truths
about filmmaking. No film can literally capture real life. Issues such as
composition and creative manipulation of images during the editing
process make the absolute truth in motion pictures unattainable. The best
documentaries are either objective or subjective in an honest attempt to
bring what the filmmaker has found to the screen. Filmmakers must ma-
nipulate material to get it on film and structure it. Here the word "ma-
nipulate" does not necessarily imply deceit or a predetermined agenda—
it defines the process. It is through this process of orchestration of cine-
matic devices that the filmmaker, working with integrity and without a
preconceived interpretation, can create a nonfiction work that captures
some eternal truths.
Do not believe everything you see. The family shown in Nanook of the
North was not Nanook's actual family—they were brought together by
Flaherty for narrative purposes. The clothing worn by the Inuit people in
the film was not their actual clothing, but a wardrobe provided by Fla-
herty. When Nanook struggles to capture a seal, the scene is a simulated
recreation. The seal, in fact, was already dead before the camera rolled
and what appears to be a fight between man and mammal was actually
men off camera pulling Nanook's hunting line.
The walrus battle that is the climax of Nanook of the North was a real
and harrowing experience for Nanook and the men. The exciting and
dangerous action allows the viewer to feel that the battle could possibly
be lost by the Inuits. In truth, Flaherty filmed the event with a rifle at his
side. The conflict continued for so long, the men pleaded with Flaherty
to stop shooting film and to utilize his rifle to end the fight. The film-
maker ignored their cries and kept the camera running. The result is one
of the great documentary sequences in film history, but the cost could
have been deadly. This more than any issue concerns the morality of some
documentary filmmaking methodology. The truth of the total situation
occurring when filming commences, not just what is projected in the dark,
is a reality that documentarians must face: Does the end justify the
means?
Flaherty engaged Nanook's complete trust and cooperation in partici-
pating in the film. During the shooting, Flaherty screened the raw footage
206 • Becoming Film Literate
Of Further Interest
Screen
Berlin: Symphony of a City
The City
Man of Aran
Night Mail
The Plow That Broke the Plains
Read
Documentary: A History of the Non-Fiction Film by Erik Barnouw
Nonfiction Film: A Critical History, edited by Richard Barsam
The World of Robert Flaherty by Richard Griffith
Documentary Film: The Use of the Film Medium to Interpret Creatively and in Social
Terms the Life of the People as It Exists in Reality by Paul Rotha, Sinclair Road,
and Richard Griffith
Robert J. Flaherty: A Biography by Paul Rotha, edited by Jay Ruby
For Documentary: Twelve Essays by Dai Vaughn
EH
Multiplot, Multicharacter Narrative
Nashville
The twenty-four actors of Nashville in search not of an author but of the truth
about America at its bicentennial birthday. The connections between charac-
ters create a multi-plot narrative that is both exhilarating and exhausting in
its ability to mirror the breadth of the nation through examination of the
home of country music. Courtesy Photofest.
begin. When the concert turns into a violent tragedy, his motorcade sud-
denly drives off.
John Triplette (Michael Murphy) is Walker's advance man who is in
Nashville to get the country music industry on board for his candidate.
Hollywood once had great influence on the political scene, but their lib-
eral message was no longer considered to be mainstream. The courting
of country superstars to support Walker symbolizes Music City's con-
nection to the American political machine. In organizing the concert,
Triplette receives help from Delbert Reese (Ned Beatty), whose purpose
is to establish a relationship between Nashville's elite and the new polit-
ical force. The politicians are not interested in music; the performers are
not interested in politics. They are connected because the music reflects
their political views and is the key to real power over the hearts and
minds of the American people.
Nashville is a musical, with Richard Baskin (Welcome to L.A.; Buffalo Bill
and the Indians, or Sitting Bull's History Lesson) serving as the music su-
pervisor. Altman required that each of the actors portraying singers write
their own songs. The music is the best kind of parody. The ersatz coun-
try songs so capture the style and intent of the elder statesmen of coun-
try music that it is difficult to separate the performances from the real
thing.
Altman began experimenting with sound early on in his career. The
aesthetics of Hollywood studio sound demanded that spoken voices be
separated in dialogue scenes. Overlapping dialogue was rare. Characters
did not speak while others talked, although in life there are cross con-
versations, interruptions, and discussions while crowds and other ambi-
ent sounds are heard. By the time Altman made Nashville, the maverick
director had found the ideal production sound mixer in Jim Webb (All the
President's Men, One from the Heart, Down and Out in Beverly Hills). Webb
came to the project with expertise and experience in multitrack record-
ing. Applying music recording technology to film sound allowed for each
of the twenty-four-plus voices to be recorded on separate tracks. During
the editing and mixing processes, the choreography of dialogue could be
controlled to perfection. The rerecording mixer, Richard Portman (The
Godfather, Funny Lady, The Deer Hunter), was able to place each voice in
its correct zone on the screen and in the proper aural perspective.
Altman's keen sense of casting is connected to his philosophy toward
acting. Robert Altman adores actors. He allows them the freedom to im-
provise within the structure created by the director and screenwriter.
Throughout his career Altman has created a stock company that grows
with every project. For Nashville Altman chose many actors from televi-
212 • Becoming Film Literate
sion, some known for their character parts in feature films, some of his
own discoveries, and established players, who, for Altman, dispensed
with actorly mannerisms, personas, and conventions that the director felt
constrained the craft. Altman gave the cast of Nashville his unconditional
trust to develop their multifaceted roles, which gained nuance with every
interaction and unfolding situation.
Haven Hamilton (Henry Gibson) is royalty in Nashville. In public he
is an ambassador and diplomat; in private he is a tyrant with ambitions
beyond music. Lady Pearl (Barbara Baxley) puts the political context of
Nashville into perspective. She pines for the days of Camelot when John
F. Kennedy was president. His assassination had changed America for-
ever and moved the country into a darker, more cynical cycle. Barbara
Jean (Ronee Blakely) is based on Loretta Lynn, the country music queen
whose life was chronicled in Coal Miner's Daughter. Lynn had suffered
from psychological stress that made it difficult to perform for a period in
her career. Altman uses Barbara Jean as a cult of celebrity figure who in-
tersects with the majority of the characters. The country music world re-
volves around her. Her fragility and unstable behavior is a crack in the
American Dream. Barbara Jean is held together by her husband-manager,
Barnett (Allen Garfield), who is at odds with everyone trying to exploit
his wife.
Another central character is connected to a number of Nashville's
women. Altman comments on the sexual politics of the music scene
through Tom Frank (Keith Carradine). This lothario is a member-in-
standing of the "Me Decade," only interested in his own pleasure. Tom
juggles affairs with Mary (Christina Raines), who is married to Bill (Allan
Nicholls), all of whom are part of a contemporary trio act; Linnea Reese
(Lily Tomlin), Delbert's wife and mother of their two deaf children; Opal
(Geraldine Chaplin), a BBC reporter who is reporting on the Nashville
scene (through whom we see Altman's European perspective on Ameri-
can life); and L.A. Joan (Shelley Duvall), a groupie in town to visit her
dying aunt.
The political wing of Nashville uses sex to buy support for Hal Phillip
Walker. Sueleen Gay (Gwen Welles) is a sweet and naive but talentless
waitress who aspires to sing at the Grand Ole Opry. An insensitive bar-
tender delivers her to Triplette and Reese, who book her for a gathering
of men, known as smoker, where she is deluded into performing a
striptease for potential campaign contributors. The scene quickly loses the
humor of the terribly off-key chanteuse singing badly to a roomful of
button-downed men. When they yell for her to "take it off," Sueleen is
humiliated but she strips, losing all self-respect, and is cheered by the
Multiplot, Multicharacter Narrative • 213
crude male chorus. Altman delivers the final blow to Sueleen's abuse
when, after driving her home, the normally affable Delbert Reese becomes
an out-of-control predator.
Barbara Jean is another female victim, but of a more extreme sort.
Nashville must be seen twice to observe the subtle clues and motivation
of her assassin. During a first viewing, it is shocking in its recall of the
memory of JFK on that tragic day in Dallas. The assassination of John
Lennon in 1980 in front of his home marked another descent into mad-
ness. In Nashville the murder of Barbara Jean reflects the dark side of the
decade, which followed a hopeful period of belief that a new generation
would remake the world in its own image. Altman concludes his film
masterfully with a straight dose of reality but is able to make another turn
during the tragedy. Throughout the film, Albuquerque (Barbara Harris),
an unknown country singer, struggles to get her big break in the Nashville
music scene. The tragedy becomes her moment and the film concludes
with Albuquerque's galvanizing vocal performance to the stunned crowd
and a film audience who now realizes Nashville is more than a satiric
romp—it is a microcosm of a young country experiencing growing pains.
The superstructure of Nashville is a series of set pieces. The airport ar-
rival of Barbara Jean is a story convention to create the superstar's mys-
tique and to reveal the motives of the swirl of people around her. The
spectacular multicar pile-up that stops traffic allows for character devel-
opment and reveals aspects of the twenty-four as they interact when they
are thrown together by happenstance. The recording session that opens
Nashville establishes the power of Hamilton Haven and the studio as a
symbolic seat of government. Club scenes present the characters at play
as they continually strive for ambition and look for love after hours. The
concert at the Parthenon is the location of the assassination and a scene
toward which the film builds throughout its development. Triplette and
Reese are constantly organizing for it. The performers are courting for the
event, Barnett is trying to protect his wife from appearing, and the fans
ready themselves for a country music Woodstock disguised as a political
rally. The Parthenon is a copy of Greek architecture that represents a great
society in ruins.
The cinematography by Paul Lohmann (Time after Time, California Split,
Mommie Dearest) is crisp and employs Altman's trademark use of the
zoom lens to bring an immediate sense of near and far as well as a docu-
mentary patina to the film. On the surface, the tableaus of Nashville do
not have intricate interscene editing. Much of the intercutting that en-
joins characters and story-lines is the result of the editing by Sidney Levin
(Sounder, Mean Streets, Norma Rae) and Dennis Hill (Quintet, Major League,
214 • Becoming Film Literate
Of Further Interest
Screen
Baby Fever
Gosford Park
Short Cuts
Slacker
Welcome to L.A.
Read
Reading for the Plot: Design and Intention in Narrative by Peter Brooks
Robert Altman: Jumping off the Cliff—A Biography of the Great American Director by
Patrick McGilligan
Robert Altman's Subliminal Reality by Robert T. Self
Robert Altman Interviews, edited by David Sterritt
The Nashville Chronicles: The Making of Robert Altman's Masterpiece by Jan Stuart
32
Method Acting
On the Waterfront
Film acting has evolved over the course of cinema history. Theater acting
styles were first applied to the new medium, and the silent film required
its own acting technique to communicate story, action, emotion, and char-
acter. During the sound era, the Hollywood studio system employed ac-
tors under contract and had its own program of training performers to
act on screen. The star system made a tremendous impact on the craft.
Projects were created for particular actors as vehicles, and supporting
players who often specialized in particular roles were part of the ensem-
ble.
Early notions of screen acting were based on elocution, poise, and the-
atrical blocking. Many actors captured the imagination of audiences with
their personas, iconic qualities, and association with particular genre
characters and attitudes: Greta Garbo, Cary Grant, Bette Davis, James
Cagney, Joan Crawford, and Humphrey Bogart. There was a distinction
between personality actors such as Gary Cooper, John Wayne, and Rita
Hayworth, who played roles close to themselves, and transformational
actors such as Paul Muni, who became his characters.
The nature of screen acting changed when method acting moved from
its experiments and practice on the stage to the medium of film. The
method, as it was called, was an Americanization of the teachings of Kon-
stantin Stanislavsky. The tenets of method acting, taught and practiced
by the Group Theater, Harold Clurman, Cheryl Crawford, and Lee Stras-
berg, were based on the concept of being the character and not just play-
216 • Becoming Film Literate
Karl Maiden (left), Marlon Brando, and Eva Marie Saint don't act but "be" the
characters of Father Barry, Terry Malloy, and Edie Doyle in On the Waterfront.
This attainment of realism launched a new era in motion picture screen acting
that influenced most American films to follow. Courtesy Photofest.
As they talk, they each have on one glove. The gesture is a feminization
of Terry that eventually gets him to open to his feminine side to gain the
inner strength to fight a fierce enemy.
Brando takes advantage of the strong dramatic blocking by Kazan.
While waiting in a crowd of longshoremen to see who will work on a par-
ticular day (a dehumanizing procedure called a shape-up), two investi-
gators approach Terry; one, played by Leif Erickson, is to his right and
the other, portrayed by Martin Balsam, is behind him in the center. Terry
refuses to cooperate with them. He directly answers questions from Er-
ickson's character, but when Balsam's character makes a comment Brando
turns all the way around to screen-left to rudely dismiss him. The dy-
namics of the gesture indicate Terry's rebellion and defiance of law en-
forcement, which will later evolve into motivation for Terry's cooperation
with the authorities.
It is the emotional honesty in Brando's performance that empowers
Terry Malloy. A product of mean streets and failed dreams, Terry is used
as muscle for the mob, but his conscience and support from Edie and a
maverick priest (Karl Maiden) turn him toward a more just and noble life.
Edie had been at a Catholic school preparing for the sisterhood. Her
hardworking father, "Pop" Doyle (John Hamilton), wants his daughter to
be far away from the ugly and brutal life of the neighborhood. Edie be-
comes a crusader for the truth about her brother's murder. Eva Marie
Saint, in her first film role, was the perfect physical type for Edie, with
her thin, under-nourished looking, and delicate features as well as long
blond hair, but it is the inner life of Edie that is the stuff of conflict and
drama. She is defiant against those who turn their back on justice. Edie
stands up to the priest, holding him to his word and reminding him that
hypocrisy is just as wrong as noncommitment. Edie's relationship with
Terry is complex. As a young girl, Edie took in stray cats to her family
home to nurture. She sees Malloy as someone who with care and en-
couragement could do good but has had the wrong influences in his life.
She expresses revulsion upon learning that Terry was involved in Joey's
death but ultimately believes he was duped and supports his courageous
one-man army against Friendly's regime. Saint gives a performance that
is sincere and human, without actorly pretenses.
With his portrayal of the priest, Karl Maiden breaks decades of screen
stereotypes. Actors often portrayed men of the cloth as devoid of a social
consciousness, as witty moralists, or as pious figures without conviction
in the real world of their parish. Maiden embodies the bravery of the fa-
ther as he puts himself on the firing line in his battle against the mob,
which is destroying his parishioners. Maiden is emotionally specific,
Method Acting • 219
for the truth of each scene gave On the Waterfront an inherent power to
capture the trust of the audience.
On the Waterfront is a significant film in many ways. It was a seminal
East Coast production, one that used social issues for its content, pre-
sented without artifice. The film was a highly influential work for Mar-
tin Scorsese and for a new American cinema that emerged during the
1960s and 1970s. Terry's pained words, "You was my brother Charlie, you
should have looked out for me a little bit," gives On the Waterfront time-
less significance. They signify hope that the human spirit can conquer op-
pression. The fact that On the Waterfront was directed by a less than moral
filmmaker is significant to the terrible legacy of the blacklist. Whatever
the artist's intentions, On the Waterfront is about a standard of American
ethical courage the country strives for but does not always achieve.
Notes
1. Budd Schulberg is the son of B. P. Schulberg, who was a screenwriter and
publicity director for Rex Films. The elder Schulberg joined Adolph Zukor's Fa-
mous Players at their outset, discovered Clara Bow as an independent producer,
worked as a producer at Paramount, and in 1928 became the studio's general
manager of West Coast Productions.
Read
On Method Acting by Edward Dwight Easty
A Method to Their Madness: A History of the Actors' Studio by Foster Hirsch
Ella Kazan: A Life by Elia Kazan
On the Waterfront: The Final Shooting Script by Budd Schulberg
An Actor Prepares by Constantine Stanislavsky
33
The Close-Up
Renee Falconetti as Joan of Arc in Carl Dreyer's silent masterpiece The Passion
of Joan of Arc. The use of the close-up transcends the traditional use of this
shot unit, which usually features a character by bringing them intimately
close to the viewer, by attaining a state of faith, grace, commitment, and ac-
ceptance of Joan's faith that has been judged by the oppression of an organ-
ized religious authority. Courtesy Photofest.
The Passion of Joan of Arc is a study in the art, power, diversity, and in-
tensity of the close-up. Dreyer's directorial concept was to engage Joan
and her inquisitors in constant confrontation. Every word and feeling ex-
pressed during this assault against religious freedom and for the power
of conviction can be felt through the inescapable juxtaposition of the men
who question and badger as Joan's indomitable beliefs endure and ulti-
mately conquer the hypocrisy against her. Through a wrongful and
painful death, she transcends her earthly role and takes her rightful place
beside God at the end of her spiritual journey.
Many were critical of Dreyer's bold choice in designing the film
through the expansive use of this specific shot. They argued that the
close-up should be used sparingly to make a dramatic point during a
scene that was covered in myriad shot sizes, in combinations of long and
medium shots. This statement ignores the breadth, power, and diversity
of what may appear to some as a singular entity. What does blue mean
to a painter, the word white to an Eskimo, and sweet, salt, hot, or sour
to a master chef? The Passion of Joan of Arc is a masterpiece of the close-
up. The open-minded, open-hearted viewer will observe that each shot
is composed for the moment and suddenly reveals blue as a range of col-
ors and hot as spicy, tangy, or smoky, as a burst, an aftertaste, a constant
presence, or a recurring series of taste-bud experiences that retreat and
endure.
Dreyer blocks and composes the faces right, left, up, and down. The re-
lationships of the characters to arches, to white space, and to each other
are constantly changing. Some shots are framed with faces in the extreme
lower quadrant of the image. Dreyer rewrites the rules of eye-line match
cutting, the guiding principle of cinematic technique, for his directorial
purpose. The rule states that when two characters are speaking to each
other, looking or reacting to another person in a close-up, the direction in
which they are looking, the eye-line, must match the gaze of the other
person when the reverse angle or associative shot comes on screen. Joan
is in a heightened state of emotion, agitation, and holiness throughout the
course of the interrogation, sentence, and her martyrdom. Because she an-
swers only to God, her eye-line is often turned heavenward, above the
heads of the priests. In shots in which the eye-lines match in the correct
direction, they do not always match in focus of attention. Joan looks at
the others, but her mind is concentrated above the hostile proceedings;
the eye-lines trace and connect, but Joan's mind and soul are elsewhere,
underscoring Da Vinci's pronouncement that the eyes are the windows to
the soul.
At times the priests look directly at Joan or at each other, or they are in
226 • Becoming Film Literate
a deep inner monologue as they deviously plan how to trick this mortal
woman they are convinced has crossed over to the devil's way. The in-
tensity of the faces reaches the highest threshold of the viewer's ability
to receive emotionality. The intimacy of the range of feelings is directly
absorbed because every facial feature and the terrain of the human mask
reveal the deep convictions of all the participants. The priests represent
a range of personalities, but they are uniform in their insistence that Joan
must confess at any cost. The expressions are honest and reveal truths of
each character. During a shot, reactions to events and the feverish process
of proving the church's honor speed from anger to false sorrow, real com-
passion, and devious manipulation from the men—some that is learned,
and some that is petty, deceitful, and calculating. Joan cries, suffers
deeply, experiences moments of spiritual bliss and many emotions rep-
resentative of human frailty.
The Passion of Joan of Arc is made up of 1,333 shots and 174 inter-titles,
a total of 1,517 separate edits. The average Hollywood silent film of this
period contained 500 to 1,000 cuts, with a maximum of 1,300, which was
rare. Silent films relied on visual storytelling to eliminate the need for di-
alogue. When necessary—and it was kept to a minimum—the characters
spoke silently on screen and the text followed on a title card. In The Pas-
sion of Joan of Arc, the characters are constantly and fervently speaking. It
was Dreyer's intention to project the film silent without any musical
score. These decisions increase the intensity of the viewing experience.
The audience is not asked to understand each word but rather to read
each face, wherein the truth lies.
The original prints of the film did not identify any of the crafts people.
The editing by Dreyer and Marguerite Beauge (Napoleon, Pepe le Moko,
Abel Gance's Beethoven) was influenced by the work of Abel Gance and
Sergei Eisenstein's The Battleship Potemkin (see chapter 5). The rapid pas-
sages of montage stress Joan's agitated state and the aggressive behavior
of the priests. The editing accentuates how at times Joan turns her head
jarringly to see that there are priests all around her. The camera move-
ment is employed to express emotional reactions. There are many swish
pans, some in which the priests are looking in one direction and others
in which the camera quickly moves down their faces. Extreme low angle
shots, which were the essence of German cinema at the time, are used to
emphasize the power and might of the priests and how they try to over-
power Joan with their very presence.
For a film with a minimalist approach, the production design is curi-
ous and effective. Although only fragments and elements of gothic struc-
tures are in the film, Dreyer and his designers, Hermann Warm (The
The Close-Up • 227
Cabinet of Dr. Caligari, Train without Eyes, Vampyr) and Jean Hugo, devised
and built a complete gothic environment for The Passion of Joan of Arc. The
look was highly influenced by German expressionism (see chapter 10)
and surrealism (see chapter 12). Arches dominate the architecture as a
symbol of the church. Circular structures physically imprison Joan, who
is able to spiritually escape the dominant architecture of the organized re-
ligion that represses her. Crosses and crosslike images in the details of the
set and props bear the presence of the priest's notion of a wrathful God
upon Joan. Warm and Hugo employed distortion of structure and per-
spectives to create a psychological atmosphere of unreality. Windows are
off scale and angled. The many angled compositions balance and coun-
terbalance the distorted environment of the set, which heightens the over-
bearing human and architectural power that dominates Joan. When light
comes through the simply constructed windows with black bars, the
shadow image of a cross appears on the floor to Joan as a sign that God
hears her. Later, when one of the most deceptive priests walks past the
crosslike shadow, it disappears, signaling to Joan and the viewer that God
is no longer present.
The conclusion of The Passion of Joan of Arc is a powerful representation
of religious strife. As Joan burns at the stake, the horrifying yet poetic im-
ages are intercut with the English soldiers launching an attack on the
townspeople who witness the murder of their future saint. Dreyer was
inspired by the work of Eisenstein (see chapter 5), and he employs a pow-
erful example of how montage can generate unrelenting action, as de-
struction of life is everywhere. Eisenstein's philosophy as a Russian was
to utilize montage as a celebration of the people and the unity of the
masses for good and harm. Dreyer was interested in the individual; as
the montage records countless deaths from one mass of people toward
another, it is the central image of Joan's earthly form burning to ashes
that prevails. The last shot is of the stake. Joan's body is gone—her soul
is at the side of God.
The Passion of Joan of Arc is a challenging film for the viewer. Dreyer
was relentless in the application of his austere aesthetic. The musical score
provided with most presentations of the film eases the viewer's discom-
fort, but Dreyer was truly a silent film master. He communicated with
silent images that created their own dialogue, sounds, and music. It is the
images that provide the power of The Passion of Joan of Arc—those unfor-
gettable close-ups of Falconetti, her hair shorn to the scalp, desperately
trying to transcend the oppression of life on earth. Through the cinematic
artistry of Carl Dreyer and his artisans, the viewer witnesses a spiritual
event—the soul leaving the body and achieving heavenly bliss. This is
228 • Becoming Film Literate
Notes
1. Antonin Artaud's theories, applied to what he called the Theater of Cruelty,
were intended to liberate his audience from the negative effects of society and to
free intuitive instincts. He proposed to create theatrical spectacles that presented
human suffering, pulsating lights, and oversized puppets to shock the audience.
His writings and ideas influenced many avant-garde movements including the
Living Theater and the Theater of the Absurd.
Of Further Interest
Screen
Faces
Husbands
Pickpocket
Tokyo Story
The Trial of Joan of Arc
Read
The Films of Carl Theodor Dreyer by David Bordwell
Speaking the Language of Desire: The Films of Carl Dreyer by Raymond Carney
My Only Great Passion: The Life and Films of Carl Th. Dreyer by Jean Drum and
Dale D. Drum
Transcendental Style in Film: Ozu, Bresson, Dreyer by Paul Schrader
Dreyer in Double Reflection: Translation of Carl Th. Dreyer's Writings about the Film,
edited by Donald Skoller
ED
Dark Side of American Cinema
Psycho
During the 1960s, American film mirrored the society it represented and
metamorphosed to challenge traditional values and conservative com-
portment. The Hollywood studio era was rapidly coming to a close, and
a new generation was looking to the movies to reflect its needs and de-
sires. Ironically, three lions of the old system opened the decade with films
that led the way to the development of a new American cinema that
evolved over the following twenty years. The Apartment, directed by Billy
Wilder, presented a frank portrayal of sexual morality. John Huston's The
Misfits examined the dissolution of the American Dream and the human
desolation left in its wake. The third stalwart director harnessed the pow-
ers of pure film to reinvent the conventions that were the lifeblood con-
nections between a movie and audience expectations. Alfred Hitchcock's
Psycho crossed a line that represented what movies should be, and there
was no turning back. It also scared the heck out of everyone who saw it.
Psycho (1960) was adapted from the novel by Robert Bloch, who used
the real life of brutal murderer Ed Gein as an impetus for the story of
Norman Bates, a psychopath who killed out of a murderous rage har-
bored in his split personality. Joseph Stefano (producer and writer on the
landmark speculative fiction television series The Outer Limits) crafted a
screenplay that Alfred Hitchcock (1899-1980) considered a blueprint for
an experiment in cinematic storytelling. The camera would tell the story.
Hitchcock was celebrated for his enormous contributions in shaping the
contemporary suspense thriller. The Man Who Knew Too Much, The Wrong
230 • Becoming Film Literate
One shot from the infamous shower murder sequence from Alfred Hitch-
cock's Psycho. The screen space to the left of Janet Leigh, as the ill-fated Mar-
ion Crane, is designed to create tension in the viewer's consciousness as well
as a position for the knife wielding Mrs. Bates. Courtesy Photofest.
Man, Vertigo, and North by Northwest brought him to the dawning of the
1960s. He always respected his audiences and made their participation a
part of his creative process. With an instinctive awareness of what con-
temporary audiences craved and the audacity to go beyond the accept-
able in content, form, and implementation, Hitchcock stepped out into a
brave new world.
Psycho defied two narrative conventions and forced the viewer to aban-
don preconceived expectations nutured by traditional filmic formulas.
One-third into the film the main character, Marion Crane (Janet Leigh), is
murdered. Audiences had been trained by Hollywood to believe that a
movie star was invincible until the conclusion of a movie. The role of pro-
tagonist then switches to her sister, Lila (Vera Miles), and Marion's
boyfriend, Sam Loomis (John Gavin). Psycho begins as a caper film. Mar-
ion steals forty thousand dollars cash from her employer's client in a des-
perate attempt to bring happiness to her clandestine relationship with her
financially burdened lover. When Marion is suddenly and savagely
Dark Side ot American Cinema • 231
shocked, and then saddened by the events before coming to the unset-
tling conclusion that the prior logic of the story has been swept out from
under them. The slaughters of Marion and Arbogast set the precedent for
things to come.
Whereas Hitchcock used staging and montage, technology would soon
allow for direct representation of acts of horror. Hitchock chose to pho-
tograph Psycho in black and white because he was well aware of the
shocking impact the violence would make on audiences. For the director,
the shower scene would have been unbearable in color. But the master of
suspense began the 1960s by opening a pandora's box of explicit screen
violence, allowing filmmakers to explore subjects with graphic, violent
content. After Psycho, America would witness political assassinations,
riots, unrest, and serial murders captured by a new American cinema that
would mirror history—and the blood would then flow red.
During the 1970s and 1980s, a new genre evolved out of the traditional
horror film and from the prehistory of Alfred Hitchcock's Psycho. Slasher
and splatter films like The Texas Chainsaw Massacre (also inspired by the
misdeeds of Ed Gein) and Friday the 13 th were filled with gore and a cel-
ebration of amoral violent acts. Halloween, directed by John Carpenter—
a landmark of the style—actually starred Janet Leigh's daughter, Jamie
Lee Curtis, who became known as the teen scream queen, picking up the
modern tradition her mother championed.
Eventually the unthinkable fell upon the film world. Three sequels
were made to cash in on the Psycho legend and the fine filmmaker Gus
Van Sant had a monumental lapse of judgment when he directed what
he described as a shot-by-shot recreation of the original. For the curious
only, view this freak of cinematic nature after the one and only. For the
purists, concerning Psycho (1998), repeat to yourself over and over, "It's
only a movie, it's only a movie, it's only a movie. . . . "
Of Further Interest
Screen
The Apartment
The Birds
In Cold Blood
Midnight Cowboy
The Misfits
Dark Side of American Cinema • 235
Read
Hitchcock's Notebook's: An Authorized and Illustrated Look Inside the Creative Mind
of Alfred Hitchcock by Dan Auiler
A Long Hard Look at Psycho by Raymond Durgnat
Psycho: Behind the Scenes of the Classic Thriller by Janet Leigh with Christopher
Nickens
Alfred Hitchcock: A Life in Darkness and Light by Patrick McGilligan
The Dark Side of Genius: The Life of Alfred Hitchcock by Donald Spoto
35
Raging Bull
making rather than the conventions of the sport or how it had been cap-
tured on television and the movies. Long before digital technology made
it easy and commonplace to ramp (see ramping in glossary) the frame
rate up or down, Scorsese goes into slow motion or advanced speed
within a shot. Angles are employed to fully express the defined space of
the ring. The camera moves almost constantly and shifts in its point of
view according to what Scorsese is trying to investigate inside La Motta's
mind and the way he sees, hears, and feels while he is boxing.
The sound design of Raging Bull puts the viewer inside Jake La Motta's
head, a mind tortured by demons, unrelenting rage, severe paranoia, and
a crippling anger. Scorsese first worked with Frank Warner (Little Big
Man, Close Encounters of the Third Kind, Being There) on Taxi Driver. A gen-
teel man who began his career in radio and television sound, Frank
Warner credited Stanley Kubrick, whom he worked with on Spartacus, for
mentoring him in the important contribution sound brings to the cine-
matic experience. Throughout Raging Bull, Frank Warner created aural
backgrounds that set the mood for each scene and contributed to the pal-
pable sense of time and place. For the interior scenes, Warner evoked the
volatility of streets outside with voices, music, and traffic that waft in
through the open windows.
Frank Warner called the sounds he created to identify La Motta's emo-
tional and psychological states "the Raging Bull effects." The ingredi-
ents—animal noises, transportation sounds, and the crushing of fruits
and vegetables—are less important than how the sounds express the in-
ternal turmoil of Jack La Motta. Inside the ring Jake focuses his attention
on his opponent. His perspective changes from hearing the diegetic
sounds of the crowd, the fight bell, the referee voice, and his cornermen,
to a distorted cacophony as he is overwhelmed by his extreme mental
condition. Jake does not hear voices in a clinical sense, but the low and
pounding rumbles, screeches, and thumping, and the flashbulbs that
sound like explosions; the slowed-down aural stretches demonstrate the
depths of his mental deterioration. Elements of these Raging Bull sounds
follow Jake throughout his life until he reaches what for him could be
called a stage of inner peace.
Catholic imagery defines Jake's persona. This obsessive theme in Scor-
sese's oeuvre is depicted here with crucifixes hanging over the beds of
the principal characters and framed religious images hung on the walls.
During one of Jake's most brutal fights, a sponge filled with blood bathes
his torso, associating the fighter with the figure of a crucified Christ. Even
the pummeling he receives from Sugar Ray Robinson will not allow Jake
240 • Becoming Film Literate
to give up his dignity. Losing the fight, Jake proclaims "You never got me
down, Ray," a subtextual message about how his soul cannot be taken
from him.
After his boxing career is over, La Motta continues to slide into Dante's
hell. He opens a nightclub where he serves underage girls liquor and
leads them to a life of depravity. When he is arrested and dragged into
isolation in a Florida prison, La Motta pays his penance by banging his
head repeatedly into a concrete wall, pounding it with fury as he emo-
tionally collapses into tears chanting, "I am not an animal." This is the
bottom. Jake begins the long road to redemption. To repent for one's sins
is a centerpiece of Catholic theology. Redemption can be attained by
prayer and devotion, but for Scorsese the sins of life must be exorcised,
not just spiritually but physically. Jake's punishment in the ring was
linked to a cycle of anger that destroyed everything that was good in his
life—his reputation, wife, brother, and the pride of his individuality. Jake
fights as a man at war with himself. His insane jealousy and suicidal at-
titude bring more sins and more pain, and leave him spiritually bank-
rupt. After serving jail time, La Motta plays dive bars where he tells
self-deprecating jokes, insults hecklers, and emcees for strippers. By
chance Jake sees Joey walking to his car. The brothers had not spoken for
many years. Jake tries but fails to reconcile; Joey barely responds as Jake
begs for a hug and to be let back into his brother's good graces.
Raging Bull ends where it began, in 1964 in a New York City hotel dress-
ing room as La Motta prepares for an evening in which he will perform
monologues from Tennessee Williams, Rod Serling, Shakespeare, and
Budd Schulberg. In a final act of redemption, Jake rehearses the "You was
my brother" monologue from On the Waterfront (see chapter 32) directed
by Scorsese's hero Elia Kazan and written by Schulberg. De Niro plays
the scene as if Jake is just running the lines, leaving La Motta's actual per-
formance of the monologue off screen after Raging Bull concludes. The
words of the speech relate directly to La Motta. Terry Malloy was a down-
and-out fighter whose brother sold him out to the mob but loved him
enough to sacrifice his life to protect Terry. Jake's brother Joey sacrificed
everything to devote himself to Jake. Both men learned their brothers
loved them unconditionally when it was too late. When Jake says Terry's
words, "You should have looked out for me," he is lamenting that Joey
should have saved him from his worst enemy—himself. Jake then phys-
ically works himself up to go on stage by rapidly throwing punches and
saying "the boss" repeatedly as his mantra. "That's entertainment" is Jake
expressing that he must move on. He accepts the realization that by tak-
ing life so seriously and letting his dark side rule, he missed the fact that
Subtext in Personal Expression • 241
everything does not revolve around him. Now Jake La Motta can go on
without the demons.
Raging Bull is a uniquely Italian American story. Scorsese layered the
film with autobiographical touches and an insider's understanding of La
Motta's cultural identity. La Motta's pride, stubborn nature, and volatile
temper were all common traits for his generation of Italian Americans
who considered themselves to be outsiders to the culture of the United
States. During the 1940s and 1950s La Motta was a force to be reckoned
with in boxing. At the time it was difficult to get into the championship
arena without compliance with organized crime, which controlled the
sport. La Motta was fiercely independent to a fault. His macho dominance
over family and business affairs was traditional in the male role in Ital-
ian American households. Scorsese has revealed at length in interviews
that the pressure and influence of Italian American cultural traits appear
in his body of work. The dominant one is irrational anger. During the pe-
riod in which Raging Bull was conceived and produced, Scorsese experi-
enced severe bouts with anger. A generation raised on global social
change clashed with the tradition of Old World upbringing. This phe-
nomenon transformed Scorsese with an awareness of identification and
compassion with La Motta, a man who demonstrated outwardly what the
gentleman director felt inside. Scorsese would use not his fists but the cin-
ema to express his inner rage through Jake La Motta's story. Raging Bull
is a movie about redemption by a film director who had to prove after
the failure of New York, New York that he could still make the kind of per-
sonal movies to which he was dedicated.
The vision and concept of Raging Bull is a personal interpretation from
Martin Scorsese as a director and creator of the film. Scorsese's longtime
editor Thelma Schoonmaker (GoodFellas, Casino, Gangs of New York), who
won the Oscar for her work on the film, heightened the manic energy
Scorsese imagined, felt, designed on paper, and executed on film through
Michael Chapman's probing, hard-charging camera. Every craft decision,
image, edit, and sound, is inspired by the sinful soul in Robert De Niro's
brilliant portrayal of La Motta. The actor became skilled as a mid-
dleweight contender under the tutelage of La Motta himself. Much has
been said about the weight De Niro gained to play the older La Motta in
search of redemption, his anger and sins transferred from the physical to
the spiritual, destroying and distorting his physique by eating himself
into oblivion. For De Niro, gaining the weight was more than just an
actor's stunt; it physically matched the emotional transformation the
actor created to serve the subject and the personal intentions of the di-
rector.
242 • Becoming Film Literate
When a film director is in perfect harmony with his or her subject, the
results transcend drama and become an experience that exposes truths
about the subject and the creator. Raging Bull is the model for that para-
digm.
Of Further Interest
Screen
The Hustler
The King of Comedy
The Pawnbroker
The Swimmer
Ulee's Gold
Read
Martin Scorsese: Interviews, edited by Peter Brunette
Untouchable: A Biography of Robert DeNiro by Andy Dougan
Martin Scorsese: A Journey by Mary Pat Kelly
Raging Bull: My Story by Jake LaMotta with Joseph Carter and Peter Savage
Scorsese on Scorsese, edited by David Thompson and Ian Christie
36
Rashomon
themselves is repeatedly pelted and stained with wrath from the heav-
ens.
As the men speak above the sound of the bombarding rainstorm, the
story begins. There has been a rape and murder. The priest (Minoru Chi-
aki), the younger of the two, fears he has lost his faith. What has occurred
is so horrible that it overshadows war and plague. Man's sins are crush-
ing his soul. A third man, a commoner (Kichijiro Ueda), comes out of the
rain, and after some provocation the woodcutter (Takashi Shimura) be-
gins his story.
Multiple Point-of-View Narrative • 245
dit's character. This allows the bandit, who is tied with rope much like
the victim, to report a story about which only he knows the most salient
aspects, because the voice of the victims cannot be represented in present
time.
Each time Kurosawa returns to present time the rain continues. The fe-
rocity of the storm is so intense both visually and aurally that it appears
as if it will never end as long as this murder and rape go unsolved and
remain wrapped in a tissue of truth, half-truths, and lies. Kurosawa re-
turns to present time at key narrative moments to conclude a character's
story and to introduce the next speaker and their point-of-view. But the
contrast between the story taking place at the ruins and the one taking
place in a sun-dappled forest creates a stark metaphor. The society is in
decay because it has embraced evil and is being punished by the gods.
The sanctity of the woods and the tradition represented by the samurai
and his elegant wife signify the end of civility when the primitive urge
for dominance and the emotions of lust, jealousy, greed, and wrath, rep-
resentative of the seven deadly sins, erupt into a physical and psycho-
logical violence that brings on the end of a dynasty.
Kurosawa was a master of camera and editing. The cinematography by
Kazuo Miyagawa (Sansho the Bailiff, Floating Weeds, Zatoichi the Outlaw)
captures the contrasting moods with an acute attention to light. For the
present, the intensity of the rain is created by an effective angle of the
light source. The texture of the wooden ruins, stone steps, and grounds
are detailed but layered in gloom and dark sheets of light. The forest is
speckled with strong sunlight. The beauty of the woman is enhanced by
the light revealing her face underneath a hat and through a white veil.
The trial is photographed in an even light that does not make an atmo-
spheric judgment about the characters, their testimony, or the sincerity of
the facts they present. The compositional style subtly shifts to illustrate
the mood of the major segments. The present-time scenes are shown in
full shots that incorporate the ruined gate, the men, and the turbulent en-
vironment. These shots have an epic sense featuring jutting elements of
architecture and a large canvas of rain so that the characters are both
dwarfed and confined by the images as defined by the framing and as
identified by the narrative context. The forest sequences are poetic, con-
trasting the beauty of the woods, and the tradition and elegance of the
couple with the archetypal villainy of the bandit. There are shots of the
sky and sun intercut with the drama unfolding on the ground. There is a
larger degree of coverage during these scenes to build interrelationships
between the characters and to accelerate the rhythm, tension, and action
during all versions of the story. The trial is photographed in a wide shot
Multiple Point-of-View Narrative • 247
Of Further Interest
Screen
Amores Perros
Hero (2002)
The Outrage
Seven Samurai
Velvet Goldmine
Read
The Emperor and the Wolf: The Lives and Films of Akira Kurosawa and Toshiro Mi-
fune by Stuart Galbraith
Akira Kurosawa and Intertextural Cinema by James Goodwin
Rashomon (Rutgers Films in Print, Vol. 6) by Akira Kurosawa, edited by Donald
Ritchie
Something Like an Autobiography by Akira Kurosawa
The Films of Akira Kurosawa by Donald Ritchie
m
Widescreen Filmmaking
After the invention of the widescreen motion picture image, it was Nicholas
Ray's Rebel Without a Cause that finally utilized the dimensions of the screen
as a vital aspect of presenting the narrative and its troubled characters. Cour-
tesy Photofest.
form a nuclear family with Jim as dad, Judy as mom, and Plato, a boy
emotionally abandoned by his parents, as their surrogate son. They take
residence in an abandoned house they call a castle. When the gang ar-
rives, the trio escapes to the planetarium where the tragedy began. In
reaching out to Plato, Jim comes of age and gets Plato to surrender after
he wounds one of the gang and fires a gun at a police officer. When the
police see the gun (that has been stripped of bullets by Jim), they shoot
and kill Plato. The film concludes as Jim proudly introduces Judy to his
parents and father and son finally reunite in their proper roles. Now the
father is the father and the son is the son.
Nicholas Ray brought the theme of disaffection to Rebel Without a Cause
with every major directorial decision he made. The most significant was
photographing the film in CinemaScope. The widescreen format was cre-
ated to compete with the growing popularity of television, but filmmak-
ers were perplexed with how to compose and block for the aspect ratio
that was much wider than its height. Directors working in the epic genre
were able to fill the frame with landscapes, troops, and other large masses.
Interiors, dialogue scenes, and close-ups were especially problematic.
Ray applied great artistry to the CinemaScope format for his drama.
For the director, the widescreen frame was ideal to depict the tempo-
ral alienation of the characters. In the opening scene in the police sta-
Widescreen Filmmaking • 251
tion, Jim, Judy, and Plato are physically separated: Jim and Judy are
distanced from each other by a glass partition, and separate sides of
the room set Jim and Plato apart from each other. Every shot of Rebel
Without a Cause places the characters solidly in their environment while
stressing their alienation from their surroundings. The knife fight is in-
herently dramatic, but Ray and director of photography Ernest Haller
(The Roaring Twenties, Mildred Pierce, Lilies of the Field) use the curved
cement path and the California landscape high in the background to
create tension between the natural and man-made world of the story.
Ray, who had worked with architect Frank Lloyd Wright as a young
man, applied dynamic expressions of space throughout the film. The
widescreen frame is also used to present the full figure of Jim with Judy
at his side. Then, a reverse angle reveals her torso, completing the com-
position. Ray was well aware of how close-ups left large areas of space
to fill in the frame. The most common solution in these early days of
widescreen photography was to counterbalance a shot with a piece of
furniture or a zone of space. These and many other techniques wasted
the power of the format and filled in the rest of the frame with much
window dressing. Ray utilized space in a dynamic force that addressed
the content of a scene and the overall narrative artistic intent of the
filmmaker.
Space in Rebel Without a Cause is either in control of the adults who run
society or in the domain of the alienated teens. The police station is old-
world, wooden, and bare—a place to process crime. When Jim, along with
his family, is taken in to talk to Juvenile Officer Ray Fremick (Edward
Platt), Jim and Fremick are seated in the foreground on opposite ends of
the frame. They are separated by his family standing in between them in
the fore and background as the officer works at his desk, physically and
emotionally isolating himself from the troubled boy. Later they talk tough
in a separate room from where Jim's parents are waiting. At first Fremick
is forced to physically handle Jim when the boy lashes out and attacks
the officer. After some communication, Fremick allows Jim to take out his
aggression on a desk and watches as the boy attacks the furniture—rep-
resenting authority—with the full force of his entire body.
The familial homes of Jim, Judy, and Plato do not meet their emotional
needs. They serve as a way station as the youths search the night for re-
lief from their unrelenting loneliness. The abandoned house Plato has
found is a respite for comfort and freedom. The disrepair represents the
destruction of the order, confinement, and repression of their parent's
world. The empty pool is a surrealistic hole in the ground where family
252 • Becoming Film Literate
fun once took place. Now it is a playground for wayward youths, a set-
ting where the three can act out against their parents through parody in-
formed by a hunger to be accepted. It also becomes a trap for Plato, who
fights off the marauding gang members.
Rebel Without a Cause is about stress within the family unit. Jim wants
his father to stand up to his domineering mother. Judy wants her father's
love as it was before she entered her teens. Plato is abandoned by his nat-
ural parents and cared for by an African American woman. Before the
three role-play as a family unit, Plato demonstrates homoerotic feelings
for Jim, who seems compelled but confused by the troubled boy.
Ray designed and applied color in a bold manner that also heightened
the psychodynamics of the narrative and characters. Red has an expres-
sive purpose throughout the film. The main and end titles, Jim's jacket,
and Judy's coat, hair, and lipstick are red, signifying rebellion, anger, sex-
uality, violence, and self-expression. Jim wears a white tee shirt and blue
jeans—the uniform of American youth. Plato wears a dark blue sweater,
white shirt, and black tie, signifying his morose nature.
The colors of the adult world are cool and drab. A room in the Stark
residence is a dull, grayed green. The contrast expresses the dissatisfac-
tion the teens have toward straight society, and the colors represent the
positions of the fractured family structure and a generation gap between
the youths and their parents. The color palette represents a collision be-
tween outward rebellion and the status quo.
The camera angle and movement of the lens work in concert with the
design, format, color, and staging to comment on the dynamics between
the teen and adult worlds. In the police station sequence, there is an up-
angle on Jim in a chair as his parents and grandmother are reunited. The
impression of Jim rising above his parents, who are incapable of under-
standing the boy, further distances the family emotionally. Later in the
scene, Ray juxtaposes an up-angle of Jim and his family with an eye-level
shot to contrast the two divergent points of view of rebellion and re-
pression. While Jim is lying on the family couch with his head near the
floor, feet up on the wall, Ray cuts to Jim's point of view of his mother
coming down the stairs. As she comes closer, the camera turns in a cir-
cular movement until she is upright. Then a cut to Jim shows he has got-
ten up a bit. Jim's position does not match the upright position of his
mother in the point-of-view shot, but the message concerning a reversal
of power occurring is abundantly clear. Dutch or canted angles had been
part of the cinematic vocabulary, but Ray on several occasions tilts the
camera from a stable position to create a psychological tension between
the characters. The dynamics of power are experienced by the audience
Widescreen Filmmaking • 253
who view through this interscene tilting Jim's struggle against his par-
ents and a world that does not accept him for who he is.
The musical score by Leonard Rosenman (East of Eden, Barry Lyndon,
Star Trek IV: The Voyage Home) gives an aural interpretation to the context
of Rebel Without a Cause. For the most part, Hollywood composers stayed
within the conventions of interpretive music that restated the drama of
the story on screen. Music that addressed the psychology of a character
was rare, that of Bernard Hermann (Citizen Kane [see chapter 13], Vertigo,
Psycho [1960; see chapter 34]) being a notable exception. The main theme
repeated throughout the film does not indicate but evokes the terrible
loneliness of the three main characters. The majority of the music engages
the inner torment of neurosis. Music scores for contemporary films of this
era found it necessary to establish time and place, but Rosenman allowed
the visuals to create those on their own. The music operates on a psy-
chological level that speaks to the emotional disturbance, anxiety, and
frayed nerves of the characters.
James Dean's performance as Jim remains iconic in its depiction of a
1950s troubled youth. Dean is best remembered and associated with this
role. To millions of admirers Dean was Jim Stark. Dean's otherworldly
gifts for portraying emotional pain as well as a confident sense of cool
are on display in the three films he left behind upon his early death in
1955 at age twenty-four. 1 But Jim Stark was a character that a generation
alienated by postwar culture understood, and they empowered Dean to
represent them. The James Dean cult of personality tends to dominate
Rebel Without a Cause, but the entire cast gives honest, memorable, and
nuanced performances. Casting Jim Backus as Jim's father was a shrewd
decision on the part of Nicholas Ray. The man then known as Mr. Magoo
and now as Thurston Howell III from television's Gilligan's Island brought
empathy and recognition as a man unable to reach out to his son or to
stand up to his overbearing wife. Edward Platt, associated with the tele-
vision culture classic Get Smart, embodies the burden of a law enforce-
ment officer who understands the generational divide. Natalie Wood and
Sal Mineo are as compelling as Dean. Wood embodies the conflict of not
being accepted at home and of the highly charged sexuality of a teenage
girl. Mineo may have the most complex role of the three. Rejected by his
parents, Plato acts out through violence, a confused sexuality, and dis-
torted self-image. There is no hope in this tragic figure unable to resolve
the situation he finds himself in.
The nuclear age is a subtext that permeates Rebel Without a Cause. Dur-
ing the class trip to the planetarium, the main characters see a demon-
stration of how the world may end through natural science, and it strikes
254 • Becoming Film Literate
terror into young lives already stressed with cold war worries. The end-
of-the-world theme takes on both political and religious meaning
throughout the film for Jim, Judy, and Plato, who are strongly affected by
an unstable world that holds a dim future for them.
The legacy of Rebel Without a Cause flows through decades of American
films that followed. It was the prototype for the youth culture film of the
1960s and the American New Wave of the 1970s, and responsible for the
acceptance of the widescreen format that has been a presentation choice
of filmmakers for the last thirty years. Rebel Without a Cause should no
longer be classified or viewed as a cult film. It is a motion picture con-
taining the DNA for the American cinema of the latter half of the twen-
tieth century.
Note
1. Dean's other two screen appearances are in East of Eden and Giant.
Of Further Interest
Screen
Bigger Than Life
The Blackboard Jungle
East of Eden
River of No Return
The Robe
Read
Widescreen Cinema by John Belton
Teenagers and Teen Pics: The Juvenilization of American Movies in the 1950s by
Thomas Doherty
Nicholas Ray: An American Journey by Bernard Eisenschitz
The J.D. Film; Juvenile Delinquency in the Movies by Mark Thomas McGee and
R. J. Robertson
I Was Interrupted: Nicholas Ray on Making Movies by Nicholas Ray, edited by
Susan Ray
38
La Ronde
foresees the future and tells the woman that fate will be kind to her in
two months. In the next scene that part of her story unfolds. A bell rings
at significant moments, often before a new event in the story.
La Ronde is both theatrical and cinematic in nature. The Raconteur/par-
ticipant who is the host, ringmaster, narrator, and guide is theatrical in
style and delivery. There is a stage on the main street and a clothing pole
on which to hang his various disguises and a dress tuxedo with top hat.
The sets by Jean d'Eaubonne (The Blood of a Poet, Lola Montes, Charade) are
elaborately designed and decorated, but their architectural structure is
predicated on narrative connections and provides easy access for the fluid
camera. The movement of the camera often reveals and heightens the the-
atricality of La Ronde through cinematic application of cinematography,
music, and art direction. The potent symbol of a spiral staircase—like the
merry-go-round, a circular image—contributes to perception of the ro-
mantic environment. The film was richly photographed in black and
white, but when a character compliments the blue of a woman's blouse,
we begin to sense the color of the scenes as perceived by the characters.
Ophiils and his director of photography, Christian Matras (Le Plaisir,
Paris Blues, The Milky Way), use two guiding principles to motivate the
dolly shots in La Ronde. As Gordon Willis (Klute, The Godfather, Annie Hall
[see chapter 2]) once explained, "actors move cameras." Ophiils's staging
involves characters and couples strolling, so a dolly shot that follows their
journey is logical and experiential. The viewer travels along as characters
move through the atmospheric environment and the rhythms of the de-
veloping relationship. The extensive use of the long take or plan sequence
also necessitates a moving camera. There are many reasons for a long
take. A plan sequence brings a dancelike and theatrical feeling towards
the material. In a long take, time is not compressed or structured by edits.
The relationship between the characters and their spatial environment is
explored, so the viewer can be acutely aware of its physicality. Camera
movement in a long take can direct the eye right, left, up, down, forward,
and back within the frame. Edits can achieve all the same results, but the
method of a cut presents images by ending one and beginning another.
The relationship between shots produces spatial changes. Camera move-
ment within a long take carries the eye through scenes, so many revela-
tions concerning a composition in constant transition can be observed. A
scene fades to black and the next fades up from black. Ophiils and his
editor, Leonide Azar (Bitter Victory, The Lovers, The Battle of Austerlitz), also
employ intercutting, wipes, and direct cuts to structure the episodes into
a form.
In La Ronde Ophiils and Matras move the camera so that the thrust of
258 • Becoming Film Literate
tionships with shapes, light, and shadow to create the essential mood for
each scene.
Other locked-off camera shots do not employ angles but feature pre-
cise framing to comment on a scene. To convey that a couple has a mar-
riage of convenience, the camera shoots from the foot of their separate
beds, framing a perfectly symmetrical composition (which Kubrick
would later use in another homage to Ophiils) that demonstrates their
physical and emotional distance. Shooting through the decorative
wooden design in the bed's structure and at times with an ornate clock
in the foreground, the visuals show what the characters reveal emotion-
ally and what the text indicates in action.
The Raconteur is not a traditional film narrator (see narration in glos-
sary). He appears on camera and addresses the audience directly, which
signals an active relationship between the viewer and the character in the
film. His observations about love and life take on weight because of his
authoritative presence. He tells us up front that he will be wearing dis-
guises throughout the film. These are costumes that identify him to the
other characters as a member of their environment. During the sketches
his involvement in the story and with the characters has a direct impact
on their actions and reactions, so the Raconteur takes on magical roman-
tic powers. At times he takes on the role of film director standing behind
a slate that identifies the next sequence. This is the most overt technique
used by Ophiils to tell us we are watching a movie. On another occasion
he directs a light onto the set that can represent theater, cinema, or both.
La Ronde is structured around sketches that are indicated by titles an-
nounced by the Raconteur. They are named plainly and clearly identify
the situation, such as "The Young Man and the Married Woman" and
"The Poet and the Actress." However, La Ronde is a unified cinematic
work, not an anthology or compilation. This is achieved by Ophiils's un-
derstanding of Schnitzler's theme—the search for love as a continuum
and not as a means to an end—and his observation that the human libido
and the human heart search for different dreams.
Every aesthetic decision concerning staging, decor, and camera chore-
ography realizes Ophiils's directorial objectives. La Ronde is an elegant
waltz through the minefield of sexual politics. The act of love is always
off camera; it is the joust and the gamesmanship that interests the play-
wright and director.
For Max Ophiils his sensitive, gliding camera was more than a stylis-
tic device; it was a cinematic philosophy that grew out of the director's
worldview. The beauty of La Ronde underscores the reality that love is
complicated by status, gender, economics, and the endless search for an
260 • Becoming Film Literate
everlasting satisfaction, a love that just eludes our grasp while life con-
tinues to offer temptation and opportunity on a merry-go-round existence
that is forever circling.
Of Further Interest
Screen
1900
Paths of Glory
The Round-Up
The Shining
Weekend
Read
Max Ophiils in the Hollywood Studios by Lutz Bacher
The Mobile Mise-en-Scene: A Critical Analysis of the Theory and Practice of Long-Take
Camera Movement in the Narrative Cinema by Lutz Bacher
Mise-en-Scene: Film Style and Interpretation by John Gibbs
Making Pictures: A Century of European Cinematography by Imago, the Federation
of European Cinematographers
Max Ophuls and the Cinema of Desire: Style and Spectacle in Four Films, 1948-1955
by Alan Larson Williams
39
Mise-en-Scene
Andre Jurieux (Roland Toutain, left), a heroic aviator, and the wealthy Robert
de la Cheyniest (Marcel Dalio) in the center of a room in Cheyniest's elegant
home, in Jean Renoir's Rules of the Game. The decor, staging, composition,
camera movement, and lighting are all part of the film's elaborate mise-en-
scene. Courtesy Photofest.
many characters, intertwined plots and twists until the last shot of the
film. It is also an actor's film. The performances are delicately graded and
in depth. The performers appear to be free to inhabit their characters and
their environment. The cinematographic style features luxurious sets that
create a perfect stage for the story to unfold. The adroit utilization of the
camera, staging, and blocking communicate the ostensibly careful exis-
tence of the characters. Their lives are riddled with anxiety, by lust and
secrets, they maintain a patina of civility as passions run wild. It is a film
with a grand theme. On the surface, Rules of the Game is about moral cor-
ruption of the ruling class. A line spoken by Octave, a pivotal character
portrayed by the director, Jean Renoir, goes straight to the meaning of all
human interactions when he explains that the sad truth of life is that
everyone has his or her reasons; today we use the terms motivation and
agenda. This philosophic observation, spoken by the director and
cowriter of Rules of the Game through one of his characters, may be the
most important theme concerning human behavior in the film. The drives
of the characters and their lower-class staff are the same. The context
changes with freedom from financial worry, but that only amplifies
Renoir's point. Life is messy. It is the heart that rules and the mind tries
to maintain order. Rules of the Game is a director-driven film—a master-
work of style and content and a timeless reflection on the search for sta-
tus, love, and true friendship.
The narrative of Rules of the Game begins on the eve of World War II,
placing it in a global political context. Andre Jurieux (Roland Toutain) is
a dashing, heroic aviator who has taken a historic flight for his love of
Christine de la Cheyniest (Nora Gregor), who is married to the wealthy
Robert de la Cheyniest (Marcel Dalio), referred to as the Marquis. Andre
has just landed when a radio interviewer and a slew of reporters and ad-
mirers mob him. The aviator is so distraught that Christine was not at the
airfield to meet him that he goes into an emotional down-spiral. Andre
and his friend Octave, a charmer who also adores Christine romantically
and is embraced by Andre's rich company, arrive at the home of Robert
and Christine. The complications between the married couple and the cast
of romantic suitors play out their many tributaries. The main action of
the film takes place at a country estate where Robert and Christine have
invited their friends to a hunt, party, and theatrical extravaganza during
which the games become serious and costly in human terms.
Rules of the Game is an ensemble piece in which characters interact and
move freely, motivated by their desires and intricate cover-ups of secret
liaisons. Renoir and his cinematographers, Jean-Paul Alphen (L'Atlante,
La Vie est a nous, La Marseillaise), Jean Bachelet (The Crime of Monsieur
Lange, Poison, I Did It Three Times), Jacques Lemare (Maid in Paris, Dish-
264 • Becoming Film Literate
onorable Discharge, Echec au Porteur), and Alain Renoir (They Met on Skis,
L'Enfer des Anges), often compose shots so that many characters are shown
full frame in deep-focus photography. This anchors the characters in an
environment acquired through birthright. The fullness of the space allows
the viewer to observe how they react to each other, their body language,
and the freedom in which they frolic and play games of love and decep-
tion.
Renoir's staging is masterful. The camera moves with or to characters
and composes and recomposes groupings to capture the zest of the char-
acters. Close-ups are used sparingly, assigning a real emotional weight
when they occur. Two-shots are especially significant in Rules of the Game
because they do more than satisfy the convention of relating to both char-
acters in the frame as they talk; the framing defines spatial and emotional
relationships—it captures the excitement of a clandestine meeting.
Renoir clearly depicts both the segregation of classes and the depend-
ence of the upper echelon on the underclass. Aside from the duties the
servants and house staff perform to make life free of chores and drudg-
ery for the rich, there are emotional ties that put the servants on equal
footing or even tip the balance with their employers. Christine and the
lady's servant Lissette sa Cameriste (Paulette Dubost), bond as women
and support each other like girlfriends. Christine relies on Lissette for ro-
mantic advice, and when Lissette gets into a catastrophic situation Chris-
tine is there for her servant, saving her job and protecting her from a toxic
marriage. Robert understands the rules of the game. He gives an oppor-
tunity to Marceau (Julien Careete), a poacher elevated to servant by the
Marquis and a womanizer who is enchanted with Lissette, and defends
Schumacher le Garde-Chasse (Gaston Modot), Lissette's husband who
handles hunting and security issues for Robert, from a potentially seri-
ous criminal charge.
The story is further complicated by the fact that Christine is also inter-
ested in St. Aubin (Pierre Nay), who for a time seems to be in position
for a tryst. Of course the Marquis also has a mistress, Genevieve de Mar-
ras (Mila Parely), a friend of the couple, and Christine's young niece
Jackie (Anne Mayen) pines for Andre; but these acts are Christine and
Robert's obligation if they want to continue the game. Octave, a friend to
all, learns he can never be equal to his rich friends, so as the game pro-
ceeds he leaves for Paris; friendship costs more than he can afford.
Rules of the Game is a charming yet caustic look at a self-serving so-
ciety. Its morality is defined by the necessity to live by rules granted
by status, and a license to legislate a proper exterior behavior even
though the heart does not always comply. The shocking and surpris-
Mise-en-Scene • 265
Notes
1. The French film magazine Cahiers du Cinema appeared in 1951 and was
coedited by Andre Bazin, who developed the auteur theory, which was its guid-
ing critical principle. Many of the young film critics writing for the magazine be-
came filmmakers in their own right, including Francois Truffaut, Jean-Luc
Godard, Claude Chabrol, Jacques Rivette, and Eric Rohmer. In their writings con-
266 • Becoming Film Literate
cerning the film director as the author of a film, they adapted the theater term
mise-en-scene to establish how a director presents his or her personal vision of a
film through the use of staging action for the camera. The contemporary defini-
tion and application of the mise-en-scene concept now includes the use of edit-
ing in examining how a director utilizes camera and staging to cinematically
capture a scene.
Of Further Interest
Screen
Imitation of Life
Laura
Letter from an Unknown Woman
Lola Montes
Touch of Evil
Read
Jean Renoir by Andre Bazin
Mise-en-Scene: Film Style and Interpretation by John Gibbs
My Life and My Films by Jean Renoir
Renoir, My Father by Jean Renoir
Renoir on Renoir: Interviews, Essays and Remarks by Jean Renoir
40
Direct Cinema
Salesman
A brief history of the nonfiction film before the late 1960s is necessary to
fully appreciate the achievements of Albert Maysles, David Maysles
(1932-1987), and Charlotte Zwerin (1931-2004) in creating this document-
ary about traveling Bible salesmen. Early nonfiction films were without
synchronous sound and were presented with a musical score. The advent
of sound brought narration, sound effects, music, and limited sync-sound
dialogue. The sound was limited because the cameras were bulky and un-
wieldy, and the sound recording consoles were not mobile enough for
field use. The development of the Nagra, a portable sync-sound recorder,
and lightweight cameras that could easily be handheld, led to the cinema
verite movement in France; notably Jean Rouch's Chronique d'un Ete
(Chronicle of a Summer), which did not employ narration or talking head
interviews. During the 1960s, several American filmmakers developed
their own style of cinema verite commonly known as direct cinema. The
Maysles brothers were at the forefront of this movement.
Salesman (1969) observes the lives of four Bible salesmen on the road
through several U.S. territories as they go from snow to sun. The tech-
nique and method of filmmaking was to follow the men into the homes
of potential customers, into sales meetings, countless motel rooms, their
cars, and to the doorsteps of leads. There is a minimal acknowledgment
of the camera almost too subtle for the average viewer to perceive; the re-
sults look as if we are watching real life unfolding.
268 • Becoming Film Literate
Reality as filmed by Albert and David Maysles. Bible salesman Paul "the
badger" Brennan uses his charm, patter, and take-no-prisoners approach to
sell a woman a Holy Bible in her home as the filmmakers watched and
recorded the action. Courtesy Photofest.
nique that Martin Scorsese later applied to the opening of Mean Streets.
Paul immediately emerges as the focal point of the narrative. We meet
Paul at a critical moment in his life. Everyone speaks of Paul's great rep-
utation as a top salesman, but times are hard for him now. No matter
what pitch, be it hard or soft, he can not close a sale. When he does, the
orders for the day and week are way below the goals of the company and
of his own prideful standard. The men are supportive, but Paul is incon-
solable. The scenes of him at work are fascinating. Paul says all the right
lines and has all the correct comebacks, but the look in his eyes reveals
depression, fear, and the sad fact that drive is seeping out of this sales-
man's soul. Paul's rapidly diminishing success has a devastating impact
on his attitude. With each bad day, Paul becomes increasingly negative.
Every night back at the motel room, Paul holds court, bad-mouthing the
territory and the leads. He ridicules the people he has met on his travels.
Paul is a Boston Irish Catholic, and he saves his most vicious barbs for
his own, speaking in an exaggerated brogue as he rips into what he calls
Mickies. In discussing an Italian American area, he makes disparaging re-
marks about their cuisine and refers to them as Guineas. If Paul was once
a gentleman, his disillusionment has embittered him and he is spiritually
lost. One devastating scene at the end of the film takes place in a home
where the Gipper is trying to close a sale as Paul, detached, watches on.
Then a spark hits and Paul goes into a closing pitch. They fail and the
Gipper explains to the family that Paul has been a bit negative and down
on his luck. Is the Gipper being honest about his despondent friend or is
he trying to use sympathy to try again to close the sale? The Gipper tells
the family that Paul just needs a spark. Paul says, more to himself than
to the others, that sometimes it is not a spark you need but an explosion.
Paul goes back to the motel and packs up. He is at the end of the line. As
Paul looks outside in the last shot of Salesman, he could be a character in
a Eugene O'Neill play.
The Maysles understood that it was essential to capture intimate, re-
vealing, and honest material as it unfolded while they followed their sub-
jects across the country. The Maysles also realized that the editing process
would organize the material, define character relationships, and create the
pressure, success, failure, boredom, and camaraderie of the salesmen's
exploits on the road. Documentary film editors had long believed that
nonfiction films were constructed in the editing room. It is the time when
critical decisions are made concerning what to show, and when and who
should communicate the story and point of view consistent with what the
filmmakers experienced during the time they spent filming.
Direct Cinema • 271
Of Further Interest
Screen
Chiefs
Don't Look Back
Gimme Shelter
Primary
The War Room
Read
Documentary Explorations; 15 Interviews with Film-Makers by G. Roy Levin
Robert Drew and the Development of Cinema Verite in America by P. J. O'Connell
The Documentary Conscience: A Casebook in Film Making by Alan Rosenthal
New Challenges for Documentaries, edited by Alan Rosenthal
Documentary Filmmakers Speak by Liz Stubbs
a
The Freudian Western
The Searchers
The screen story and thematic intentions of John Ford's (1895-1973) The
Searchers have over time certified this 1956 American Western as one of
the most influential movies of the modern era. Since the 1970s, The
Searchers has been considered by critics internationally to be among the
finest of the Western genre. The Searchers resonates because it tackles uni-
versal issues: the search for home, racial differences, the obsessions of
love, hate, and vengeance, and the complex nature of the id. The Searchers
is also a well-told tale with multifaceted characters that brims with con-
flict, plenty of action, dramatic meditation, warmth, and humor. Although
based on a historical incident and adapted by screenwriter Frank S. Nu-
gent (Fort Apache, She Wore a Yellow Ribbon, The Quiet Man) from the novel
by Alan LeMay, The Searchers is the singular voice of John Ford in his ma-
ture years. With this film, the man largely responsible for writing the po-
etic mythology of the West-on-celluloid turned to the unchartered
territory of the dark side of that American story. With Homer, Shake-
speare, and Freud spiritually beside him, John Ford constructed the foun-
dation for the next chapter in American film history.
The setting is Texas, 1868. The Searchers begins and ends with a view of
Monument Valley from inside a homestead. The landscape is vivid: blue
sky, deep coral mountains, the light sienna of the earth, and the green of
the brush. The camera pulls back out of the black-framed doorway like a
baby coming out of a precious womb. Ethan Edwards (John Wayne), once
a member of the Confederate army, then soldier of fortune and wander-
274 • Becoming Film Literate
ing outlaw, has come home. From the porch, his family watches him
slowly ride in. Ethan receives a welcome from his brother Aaron (Walter
Coy) and sister-in-law Martha (Dorothy Jordan). The sexual tension be-
tween Ethan and his brother's wife is clearly felt through the emotions
they project. As they share dinner with Aaron and Martha's children, Ben
(Robert Lyden), Lucy (Pippa Scott), and little Debbie (Lana Wood), Mar-
tin Pawley (Jeffrey Hunter), a young man who was rescued by Ethan after
Indians massacred his family, is a late arrival. Ethan openly shows his
racial hatred for Indians and the mixed blood he immediately recognizes
The Freudian Western • 275
in Martin. Although Martin has assimilated into his family, Ethan does
not hide his disgust and deep-seated prejudice.
Ethan and Martin are deputized by the captain, the Reverend Samuel
Johnson Clayton (Ward Bond), for a posse investigating cattle thieves. Out
in the valley they discover that Comanches are responsible. Ethan has
greater knowledge of his enemies than of his kin and tells the men they
were lured out so that the Comanches could go on a murder raid.
During the orange light of dusk, the nervous flutter of birds indicates
to Aaron that the Indians are not far off. When her mother blows out an
oil lamp that Lucy is carrying, the young woman is overcome with hys-
teria. Extinguishing the light represents to Lucy that an Indian attack is
imminent. As the camera swiftly moves in, Lucy, facing the camera, lets
out a blood-curdling scream. It is an action that deromanticizes the West-
ern legend. Lucy's chilling scream assaults the audience as it directly ex-
periences the terror of the moment. The slaughter that then occurs is not
shown on screen, only indicated by Chief Scar (Henry Brandon) blowing
a war horn after he finds Debbie hiding in the family cemetery. What we
do not see is far more unsettling than the genre's usual convention of
showing violent action to build sympathy for the victims and hatred for
the villains.
When Ethan returns home, tragedy flashes across his face before Ford
shows us what Ethan sees—the house burning to the ground. His pas-
sion is no longer contained; he cries out repeatedly for Martha in the way
a lover would. When Ethan discovers her dead body, we only see the loss
on Ethan's face as the camera again shoots from within the black frame
inside the house. When he finds Lucy's dress and Debbie's doll, Ethan
knows that the Comanches have abducted them. The repellent thought
that they might lose their ethnic purity sends Ethan into an obsessive fury.
During a posse search for the girls, a dead, buried Comanche is dis-
covered. Ethan shoots out the Indian's eyes because he understands the
Indian belief that without sight the native cannot enter the spirit world.
With two thunderous blasts from his gun, Ethan pronounces an eternity
of wandering between the winds on the soul of his foe.
After a battle with a Comanche unit, the posse breaks up. Ethan, Mar-
tin, and Brad Jorgensen (Harry Carey, Jr.), Lucy's sweetheart, continue on.
While tracking on his own, Ethan finds Lucy's desecrated body. This in-
formation is revealed when Brad insists he's seen her alive traveling with
the Indians. When the young man expresses doubt, Ethan, with bile,
spews, "What do I have to do—spell it out for you!" The burden of proof
is the terrible responsibility Ethan takes upon himself. This burden hard-
276 • Becoming Film Literate
ens his heart and continues to eat away at Ethan's humanity. Brad runs
off in a fit of blind revenge. His murder is presented in the off-screen
sound of gunshots while Ethan and Martin are left to persevere on their
mission.
When snowfall prevents them from continuing, Ethan vows never to
give up and that he will eventually be victorious. Martin only wants to
rescue Debbie, but Ethan has now turned away emotionally from the girl
because he is convinced she has lost her lineage. As they travel back to
the Jorgensen homestead, the interior view is repeated, but this residence
is brighter inside without the Freudian connections of the Edwards home.
Lars (John Qualen), his wife (Olive Carey), and their daughter Laurie
(Vera Miles) warmly greet Ethan and Martin.
More time passes and Ethan and Martin go off when they receive a new
lead for Chief Scar's trail. More time passes again and Charlie McCorry
(Ken Curtis) brings a letter from Martin to Laurie as he comes to court
her. As she reads the letter aloud, Ford presents what has been occurring
with Ethan and Martin. In a series of flashbacks, we learn that Martin
was tricked into marrying an Indian woman during barter for goods he
was selling. A lighthearted scene turns ugly when Martin kicks the
woman away from his sleeping ground and Ethan harasses her for in-
formation concerning the whereabouts of Scar. By returning to Laurie
reading the letter; Ford is able to continue the flashbacks and set them up
through narration spoken by Martin. During another winter, Ethan
wildly drives away a buffalo herd to deny the Comanches the white
man's food. They come upon Scar's village, which has been terrorized by
a calvary platoon, and take off to find the platoon in case its men appre-
hended the chief. Ethan is obsessed with killing Scar. They reach the cal-
vary outpost and are brought to a room where white women kidnapped
by the Comanches reside. As Ethan looks at the women who have been
defiled and driven mad by his archenemy, Ford rapidly tracks the cam-
era (see tracking shot in glossary) into a tight close-up of Ethan. The dis-
gust and extreme hatred that burns in his eyes have made him half crazy
over his anger toward what he truly believes is an Indian scourge against
the supremacy of the white race. Laurie concludes the letter, bringing the
story back to date.
Later Emilio Gabriel Fernandez y Figueroa (Antonio Moreno) sets up
a meeting with Scar, for a price. Ethan and the chief finally stand eye to
eye. Inside his teepee they see Debbie (Natalie Wood), now grown into a
beautiful young woman. Scar tells them she is one of his wives. An older,
paunchier Ethan is as determined as ever. Controlling his emotions, he
tells Scar he will return to offer a trade.
The Freudian Western • 277
Debbie runs down an embankment and Martin charges after her. She
tells him it is too late—the Comanches are her people. Ethan unabashedly
reveals his true intentions and draws his gun to kill his own kin because
her bloodline is now contaminated. Martin protects her with his body as
Ethan is shot by an arrow fired by an advancing Indian party led by Scar.
Martin and Ethan manage to fend them off, riding to a cave where they
hold their own in battle. The inside of the womblike cave is sanctified by
a pure white light.
Back at the Jorgensen house, Laurie and Charlie are about to be mar-
ried. Ethan and Martin return as unwanted guests. Charlie and Martin
enter into a raucous fight over her that ends the chances of a union. Lieu-
tenant Greenhill (Patrick Wayne) enters to tell the Reverend Captain that
the army has located Scar.
Ethan, Martin, and the unit sneak up on the Comanche and his tribe in
the night air of the valley. At daybreak Martin goes into Debbie's teepee
unnoticed. She awakens and screams but then immediately embraces
him. The regiment attacks when they hear the sound of Martin shooting
an Indian who comes to stop him. Ethan rides directly into Scar's tent.
The chief is dead and Ethan completes his self-determined mission by
taking his knife to the Comanche. When Ethan leaves the tent, he spots
Debbie and charges after her. Martin is unable to stop him. It is the mo-
ment of reckoning for Ethan. Debbie makes it to the mouth of the cave,
again a symbol for the womb, the sanctity of the home and the unbreak-
able bond of family. Ethan sweeps her up in his arms and says, "Let's go
home, Debbie," in a gentle voice that lets her know he accepts her as fam-
ily. It is time to return home.
The Jorgensen family waits on their porch to receive them. Martin and
Laurie are reunited. Debbie becomes part of their family. Ford returns to
the safe black frame of the doorway, a representation of home as a place
of inner peace. Ethan, now alone and fully whole, says goodbye, turns,
and walks off to roam. The door closes—The Searchers has concluded.
John Ford was a master cinematic storyteller. This strong narrative,
abounding with insight into the human condition, is cinematically ren-
dered with elegiac and potent moving images. Director of photography
Winton C. Hoch (Joan of Arc, She Wore a Yellow Ribbon, The Lost World) shot
The Searchers in Technicolor and Vista Vision. The color is deeply saturated
and especially rich in capturing the red, blue, green, and earth tones that
define the Western genre. Vista Vision was a widescreen process in which
35mm film ran through the camera horizontally rather than by the stan-
dard vertical flow to create an image with an approximate aspect ratio of
1:85:1, the standard widescreen format for American films. Vista Vision ex-
278 • Becoming Film Literate
celled in sharp definition. The extreme clarity of the process assisted Ford
and Hoch in achieving a hyperrealism that expressed the extreme range
of emotions attained by the characters in the story.
John Ford considered himself not a filmmaker but a film director. The
difference may be semantics, but Ford was not a hands-on filmmaker such
as Alfred Hitchcock, King Vidor, or Orson Welles. John Ford was a clas-
sicist, a Hollywood professional, and a cinematic poet. He directed with
personal vision and by leadership. The insightful thematic treatment and
engaging story sensibilities of The Searchers are translated and structured
by images that serve their purpose with unpretentious virtue. Each shot
is composed and staged to convey a sense of place, emotional truth, and
dramatic fulfillment. Ford rarely moves the camera. When he tracks
alongside the gallop of horseback riders or pushes in for a close-up, it is
for a reason that has nothing to do with personal visual style and every-
thing to do with applying the right technique for that moment in the story.
There is a minimum of interscene editing. Ford cuts only when it is ab-
solutely necessary to move to another view or angle. His choices are only
dictated by the story he is telling, not artistic ego or personal expression.
The Searchers may be John Ford's most personal film in which he probed
the American psyche, but it is also a well-made movie, a paradigm for
the classical style of the American film.
The Searchers made a lasting impression on the third generation of
American film directors. The motifs of the nature of family, the racial pol-
itics of hate, and the journey for internal realization appeared in the work
of many American New Wave filmmakers, emerging in many forms dis-
tilled by the perceptions of a diverse group who share respect for and a
yearning to participate in Ford's search for the American character. Mar-
tin Scorsese's Taxi Driver, Steven Spielberg's Close Encounters of the Third
Kind, George Lucas's Star Wars, and Michael Cimino's The Deer Hunter
continued John Ford's tradition of making American films that go beyond
genre conventions and speak to who we are as Americans.
Of Further Interest
Screen
Forty Guns
Johnny Guitar
The Left-Handed Gun
Taxi Driver (1976)
Unforgiven
The Freudian Western • 279
Read
About John Ford by Lindsay Anderson
The Searchers by Edward Buscombe
Print the Legend: The Life and Times of John Ford by Scott Eyman
John Ford: The Man and His Films by Tag Gallagher
Searching for John Ford: A Life by Joseph McBride
42
Defining Theme, Metaphor, and
Character through Color, Texture,
and Environmental Design
Se7en
The narrative of Se7en (1995) concerns a serial killer who plans and exe-
cutes elaborate, grisly murders that interpret the seven deadly sins: glut-
tony, greed, sloth, wrath, pride, lust, and envy. The film is directed by
David Fincher in high visual style. Se7en is a neonoir set in an urban city
that is never identified. It is constantly raining. The interiors are dark;
long beams of flashlights held by law enforcement cut through thick, dirty
air. Everything is aged, decrepit, and disintegrating like the immorality
that produced a pathologically brilliant murderer hunted down by de-
tectives William Somerset (Morgan Freeman) and David Mills (Brad Pitt).
Fincher, who learned his craft as a music video director, was highly in-
fluenced by Ridley Scott, especially Scott's Blade Runner (see chapter 7), a
neonoir set in the future. Fincher, director of photography Darius Khondji
(The City of Lost Children, Stealing Beauty, The Ninth Gate), and production
designer Arthur Max (Gladiator, Black Hawk Down, Panic Room) applied
Scott's aesthetic to Se7en, but interpreted it by their own enormous talents;
they created the very detailed environments for the story of Se7en.
What makes Se7en unique is the elaborate library of journals produced
by the serial killer chronicling the crime plans: text, photos, graphics, and
the physicality of the crime scenes themselves with their ornate Grand
Guignol architecture identified with each of the sins. The materials used
by the killer include blood, feces, urine, flesh, bone, and gruesome props.
Each crime was well planned, designed, and carried out over a period
of time by one man. The artistic premise of these sequences that are the
Defining Theme, Metaphor, and Character • 281
Brad Pitt as detective David Mills in Se7en, directed by David Fincher. A serial
killer commits a series of murders based on the seven deadly sins. By leaving
elaborate and gory crime scenes the killer is narratively responsible for the
environmental design he deliberately creates. Courtesy Photofest.
centerpieces of the film presented a challenge for Arthur Max, who de-
signed these sequences as if they were created by the killer known as
John Doe.
This unique perspective added narrative depth to the character and
presented a formidable task for Arthur Max. How are the design ideas
presented in these horrific crimes manifested from the character's state of
mind? It is not until the last half hour or so of the film that we meet John
Doe, played by Kevin Spacey. For the majority of Se7en we only see the
results of his hellish deeds and learn about him indirectly. The detectives
are constantly talking about him, witnessing his heinous handiwork, re-
searching the clues he has left for them, and investigating the origin and
nature of the deadly sins.
The detectives have conflicting philosophies concerning the killer's mo-
tive; their theories are directly linked to their diverse personalities. Som-
erset is highly intelligent, methodical, and well aware they are hunting a
282 • Becoming Film Literate
brilliant psychopath. His approach is to read Dante, Milton, and other lit-
erary sources to understand the mind he is tracking. Mills is a young, in-
experienced, volatile hotshot with good instincts. Mills yearns for respect
and works hard at straight police work to solve the case that defies con-
ventionality. To Mills the John Doe killer is a dirt bag, a nut job, a psy-
cho. He tries to give the impression that he is unwilling to afford the killer
intellectual satisfaction, and at first dismisses the complex scholarly ap-
proach necessary to understand the fiendish plan linked to classical and
religious imagery and beliefs. Mills is rough around the edges and tries
to hide it. Eventually the two approaches come together and the killer is
captured with calamitous results for both detectives.
The killer is highly intelligent—image- and word-oriented. The visual
presentations of his crimes are an important motivation for him. His note-
books, numbering over 200, are works of depraved art, a library of anger,
hate, and the destruction of humanity. The title sequence reveals the
killer's skilled hands in creating the miniature hand printing, cutting and
pasting of photos, and other Hadean graphic elements. When the detec-
tives find his apartment from which he has escaped, they locate the raw
materials utilized for his death art.
Arthur Max created the ideal metaphorical environment in which to
breed these crimes. Buildings are old, retrofitted, and blighted with urban
decay. New businesses reflect moral depravity; a leather shop featuring
custom-made S&M gear becomes a plot point, as does a sex club that sig-
nifies the bowels of hell.
Max's design for John Doe's apartment and the murder sites are within
the parameters of the overall look of the film. The personal touches that
link these design elements to the killer's interpretation of each sin are the
logistics and specifics of each action, victim, and the environment altered
by the criminal's punishment for the designated sin.
Fincher carefully constructed clues and support for the sin of envy. The
characters involved in this segment are meticulously created. The most
audacious touch is the use of the color green, which is a selective thread
from the opening shot of the film. Green is the color of jealousy and envy.
Green becomes part of the color palette, first received as a color that de-
picts revulsion and disease. It may take more than one screening for a
viewer to comprehend the careful symbolic use of the color green. The
color is employed both as part of the emotional and psychological at-
mosphere of Se7en and as a deadly clue as to how envy and wrath will
personalize the series of nightmarish atrocities even after John Doe is cap-
tured.
John Doe's composition books of planning information were created by
Defining Theme, Metaphor, and Character • 283
a highly erudite criminal mind. They are a record of a serial crime so per-
fect, so contained and internal, it could never be solved without reading
the books. The books are shelved in no discernible order and are found
at a point when there is no time to disseminate information, only to find
and capture the killer.
A separate team in the art department worked on this detailed graphic
project. The massive micro-sized text was written by hand. It was not nec-
essary to the technical or narrative requirements of the film that the words
make sense or that they reflect the character of John Doe, but they were
designed using the logic of the character as written in the script. The
opening title sequence showing Doe's hands working on one of the vol-
umes puts him right in front of the viewer, who can see the step-by-step
process. As the movie is beginning, we can see inside his diabolical mind.
The character comes vividly alive long before we meet him.
Se7en is about urban life. The weather conditions of constant wind and
rain have led some to feel the film takes place in Seattle. New York and
Chicago also come to mind, but Fincher and his design team went be-
yond, creating a generic city. The metropolis in Se7en is a conglomeration
of many American cities because this disintegration of the American
urban city is a salient theme. The collapse of civility and the rise of de-
viance, anarchy, perversity, and violence are consuming the cities. Fincher
did not want to personalize Se7en by placing it in a specific geographic
location; rather, he generalized what was happening to the country.
Somerset, a streetwise but civil man, is retiring to withdraw from the
societal cancer surrounding him. David Mills and his wife, Tracy
(Gwyneth Paltrow), have lived in rural areas of the country. For David,
the city is the place where he can gain respect as a detective. Mills has a
jaded point of view toward urban crime and knows little about the so-
phisticated procedures necessary to deal with it. Tracy is frightened by the
city but is a dedicated marital partner, so she supports David and acts as
a diplomat to bring the two diverse detectives together. The dinner scene
is critical in better understanding Somerset and Mills as individuals—they
are brought together by Tracy. Somerset and Tracy bond immediately be-
cause they share sensitivity and a sense of humor toward life. Later when
Tracy learns she is pregnant, she confides in the detective and asks for his
counsel. Tracy is not sure she wants to bring a child into this decaying so-
ciety. Somerset advises Tracy not to tell David until she resolves this issue,
knowing that his partner is a man who wants a family as well as to be jus-
tified in his role as a detective before he can be whole.
The screenplay by Andrew Kevin Walker (8mm, Sleepy Hollow, Panic
Room) is tightly structured and has a seven-day timeframe dedicated to
284 • Becoming Film Literate
the seven sins. Each day is identified on screen with a text graphic. The
week begins with gluttony, greed, and sloth from Monday to Wednesday,
with one crime per day. Thursday and Friday are time units used to de-
velop the story and characters. On Saturday lust is carried out in a sex
club. On Sunday, a holy day, the man who has brought the seven deadly
sins to contemporary life completes the cycle with the sins pride, envy,
and wrath. The results forever impact the detectives, Tracy, and John Doe,
as well as the future of human history. The Somerset voice-over that con-
cludes Se7en is a chilling summary of mankind at the end of the twenti-
eth century. Quoting Hemingway, Somerset says, "The world is a fine
place and worth fighting for." Somerset ends with his own point of view:
"I agree with the second part." Somerset has seen too much destruction
during his career as a detective to remain an optimist.
The end credits do not crawl up from the bottom of the frame, the tra-
ditional direction for all films; they descend down from the top of the
frame. Se7en is a journey through heaven and hell. The descent can be
viewed as a symbolic visualization of John Doe going to hell. It can also
represent hell on earth, a world where the dark side is gaining strength
as we head for judgment day.
The musical score by Howard Shore (Dead Ringers, The Silence of the
Lambs, The Lord of the Rings) and sound design by Ren Klyce (The Game,
Fight Club, Being John Malkovich), Yin Cantor (Rushmore, Waking the Dead,
The Iron Giant), and Patrick Dodd (Red Rock West; The Crow: Salvation; Jakob
the Liar) combine to create a metallic, buzzing atmospheric soundtrack
that aurally inhabits the evil within the city, within Doe's head, and in
the caverns of hell.
In Se7en David Fincher and Darius Khondji brought the concept of
dark- or low-light photography to a new level. Low-light photography
developed during the 1970s after the demise of the Hollywood studio sys-
tem. The Hollywood studio system demanded films brightly lit, an aes-
thetic that supported their generally escapist attitude toward the
medium. Dramas would employ contrast and film noir took that concept
further. With his daring work in photographing The Godfather, Gordon
Willis (The Parallax View, Interiors, Pennies from Heaven) utilized very low
levels of illumination for the scenes in Don Corleone's office, which con-
trasted with the bright sunny scenes of his daughter's wedding. By cre-
ating entire scenes that were physically photographed as dark, Fincher
and Khondji visually interpret the dark context of the story. This low-light
style was the ideal application for an American cinema that delved into
the underside of human behavior.
Through a then-experimental laboratory technique, the prints of Se7en
Defining Theme, Metaphor, and Character • 285
Of Further Interest
Screen
Clockers
Fight Club
Red Desert
Scarface (1983)
U Turn
Read
Interaction of Color by Josef Albers
Bright Earth: Art and the Invention of Color by Philip Ball
Se7en by Richard Dyer
The Elements of Color by Johannes Itten
Dark Eye: The Films of David Fincher by James Swallow
m
Symbolism in the Cinema
During the golden age of international cinema in the 1950s and 1960s,
Swedish film director Ingmar Bergman dominated the interests of Amer-
ican audiences looking for a meaningful experience at the movies. To
those raised on Hollywood entertainment, the films of Ingmar Bergman
represented a gateway into art cinema. A prolific body of work including
Wild Strawberries, Through a Glass Darkly, Persona, The Virgin Spring, and
Hour of the Wolf were a revelation that motion pictures could present se-
rious themes about God, death, and existence. Bergman did not make
films to entertain but to ponder human and spiritual issues. These brood-
ing and liberating works did not fit the paradigm of the Hollywood
drama. Bergman's vision of the world was expressed in poetic imagery
rich with symbols, signs, and layers of meaning that required an intel-
lectual and emotional commitment from the audience. In return, the films
did more than satiate the need to pass time; Bergman's cinema was a cen-
tral part of a canon that contributed to a new cultural era. Film, the
medium of the twentieth century, took its rightful place alongside opera,
classical music, and the literate and visual arts. Bergman helped to ele-
vate the movies to an art in which images, text, and sound could deliver
an experience that made a lasting and significant impact on the viewer.
The Seventh Seal (1957) is a landmark of international cinema. The the-
matic structure of the film and the poetic cadence and imagery in which
Bergman presents and interprets the allegorical narrative would, over the
decades, have an indelible influence on American film. A knight, Anto-
Symbolism in the Cinema • 287
Antonious Block (Max von Sydow), a Knight who has returned from the bat-
tles of the Crusades, is confronted by Death (Nils Nittel). The man with the
stone white face dressed in black and a game of chess to decide the fate of
the Knight are some of the striking symbols in Ingmar Bergman's The Seventh
Seal. Courtesy Photofest.
nious Block (Max von Sydow), and his squire (Gunnar Bjornstrand) have
returned from the Crusades, a centuries-long religious war. The land is
ravaged by plague, the survivors fear doomsday, and zealots are about
to burn a young woman (Maud Hansson) at the stake for consorting with
the devil. The knight is weary from the long battle and seeks answers to
eternal questions about the existence of God and the meaning of life. An-
tonious encounters a white-faced man (Nils Nittel) cloaked in black—the
traditional Swedish image for death. Antonious challenges Death to a sin-
gle game of chess to win a respite from destiny so he can continue his
spiritual odyssey in search for answers that would justify his long suf-
fering on the battlefield and the gloomy future he sees ahead. The spec-
tacle of Nittel standing on the shore of the ocean announcing "I am
Death" is one of the seminal moments of poetic cinema.
Bergman's art is imbued with symbols and metaphors. You can not just
watch The Seventh Seal; you must also read it. The chess game between
288 • Becoming Film Literate
the knight and Death begins on a rock with the sea and a dramatic, tur-
bulent sky behind them. Chess is a war game in which the opponents
move pieces in the form of a knight, bishop, queen, king, castle, and
pawns related to the traditional ranks of battle. Antonious is a knight; his
wife, who appears in the last act of the film, can be seen as his queen. The
religious symbol of a bishop is reflected in the religious fervor to rid the
plague by destroying the devil in human form. All of the characters are
pawns for the devil, God, or both. Antonious is heading for his castle,
and a baby named Mikeal is a representation of Jesus, the Prince of Peace,
son of the almighty, who could be recognized as the figure of a king.
Chess is a game concerning territory, acquiring the enemy's materiel.
When a player resigns or is checkmated, making it impossible for the king
to escape enemy forces, the game is over. In chess one can win, lose, or
draw if the players are equal in strength. The knight has no chance of de-
feating Death because it is an inevitability of human existence. The knight
is looking to extend his time on earth to learn why human suffering per-
sists. What is man's purpose? Chess is an intellectual game as well. The
players use strategy and psychology of human nature. Intelligence and
will are critical skills as is the ability to presage events. The players vie
for which color to play, black or white, two colors with ages of iconogra-
phy attached to them. White is an advantage because that player moves
first, affording him an offensive lead, forcing black to defend, circumvent,
or defeat the attacker. The knight wins the right to play white, and Death
is comfortable with the color he says suits him. Death cannot lose but he
allows the knight to play on and live long enough to discover that after
the darkness of life there is light—another good and evil metaphor. A
young silent woman (Gunnel Lindblom) repeats the last recorded words
of Jesus, "It is finished." The phrase reveals insight into the knight's ques-
tion about God's existence. Death and chess represent finality. But for the
knight playing the game elevates him to a plane of spirituality that trans-
forms the hard reality of death with the magical possibility of an after-
life. This is visualized by a signature shot of Death leading the knight, his
squire, the girl, and others in a long shot in silhouette that pictures a hand-
in-hand dance that liberates the characters. The final vision of Jof (Nils
Poppe), who survives a storm threatening the lives of his family, is that
this is not their time to leave the earth. Jof is a member of a troupe of ac-
tors touring the countryside. He represents another of The Seventh Seal's
potent symbols. Jof, his wife Mia (Bibi Andersson), and their baby son
Mikeal are, in the screenplay written by Bergman, an actualization of
Joseph, Mary, and the baby Jesus.
Symbolism in the Cinema • 289
The acting troupe tries to spread joy during a time of great worry and
strife. All through the film there is talk and there are signs that the end
of civilization is near. To audiences who lived with the threat of nuclear
annihilation during the cold war and a global society turning toward the
dark side, the metaphor of the end of the world and a search for salva-
tion was a powerful connection between the fourteenth and twentieth
centuries. Throughout his career Ingmar Bergman assembled one of the
great acting repertory companies of the cinema. In addition to von Sydow,
Bibi Andersson, and Bjornstrand, there were Ingrid Thulin, Harriet An-
dersson, Liv Ullmann, and Erland Josephson. To Bergman, his actors and
crew were part of his family (he also had intimate relationships with sev-
eral of his actresses). In The Seventh Seal there was a significant link among
the director's acting company, the troupe portrayed in the film, and the
wandering performers who represented the family of Jesus. The actors in
the traveling troupe participate in a play within the film, which can also
be seen as a film within the film. The troupe is a positive force that tries
to uplift a society driven by fear and religious fanaticism. The actors have
their own lives and interactions. Jof, Mia, and Mikeal are both symbols
of the holy family and flesh-and-blood people struggling with the evil of
the plague and the same cardinal questions of purpose as the knight.
The plague in The Seventh Seal is a physical illness that is ravaging the
land, but Bergman uses it as a metaphorical device to represent a spiri-
tual crisis. The disease is interpreted as a message from God as punish-
ment for the sins of man. This use of the deadly, contagious disease as a
religious sign of moral degradation and collapse that brings the world to-
ward a day of judgment resonates throughout history. In the contempo-
rary age, the rhetorical descendants of those fanatical in their religiosity
have placed AIDS in this context.
The storm that is unleashed at the climax of the film when the knight
reaches his castle is a dramatic element employed in many Hollywood
movies to intensify or heighten a narrative situation. But in The Seventh
Seal the storm does more than just add atmosphere; it is a representation
of God's wrath and a sign that the end of the world has arrived. Although
destruction of the modern world is predicted to be by fire, the Old Tes-
tament image of an impending flood is a symbol of washing away the
ravages of disease and drowning the earth leveled to rubble by war. Dur-
ing this sequence, Jof and his family are out in the forest. The image of
their vulnerability is intercut (see intercutting in glossary) with the young
silent woman speaking the words of the Son of God. This demonstrates
that the storm or the message from God is far-reaching and has engulfed
290 • Becoming Film Literate
all of the characters and, by inference, the world. The clearing of the sky
at the end of The Seventh Seal is an indication that God has spoken and
given mercy because belief was recognized.
Bergman is obsessed with the notion of death and the meaning of life.
The Seventh Seal, like the bulk of his oeuvre, is solemn, morose, brooding,
and deadly serious in examining man's nature. What is often overlooked
however is a contrasting energy that enriches The Seventh Seal and many
of Bergman's films with humanity and a zest for life. There is humor
sourced from the squire and members of the acting troupe. Mikeal is a
celebration of life as well as a symbol for the baby Jesus. The child brings
hope, love, and happiness to his parents and to the world. The knight,
even in his despair, shows great compassion for the young woman ac-
cused of being a witch. The Seventh Seal ends with the family moving for-
ward as the world survives. The threat of the apocalypse is held in
abeyance.
Bergman's cinematic vision evolved out of his response to the content
he created. Over the course of a long career, Ingmar Bergman continued
to explore psychological pain, the burden of organized religion, the fa-
milial past, and fundamental issues of life. His two principal cinematog-
raphers were Gunnar Fischer (Monika, The Devil's Eye, The Magician), who
photographed The Seventh Seal, and Sven Nykvist (The Silence, Shame, Per-
sona), who collaborated with Bergman from the 1960s through the 1980s.
The lighting of the black-and-white cinematography in The Seventh Seal
accentuates stark blacks and shimmering whites. The tonal range high-
lights the textures of the natural environment: the beach, ocean, rock for-
mations, and dense forest. There is little interscene editing in The Seventh
Seal. Bergman uses long takes in which composition and staging bring
power and visual dynamics to every frame. In a two-shot the characters
often do not look at each other. By allowing the lens to observe both char-
acters as they face in different directions, Bergman examines the strain of
intimacy, the physical and psychological relationships they have with
each other and with their environment. This approach also gives The Sev-
enth Seal a measured pace that alters the viewer's sense of time. Most of
Bergman's black-and-white films are in the ninety-minute range. But the
intensity of the experience can make time seem interminable to the viewer
watching a Bergman film. Sound is very specific. All the voices are post-
synched and projected in an up-front perspective into the viewer's con-
sciousness. Sound effects are limited but distinctive and used to identify
place or mood or to evoke an emotion. There is music, but the over-
whelming sound is silence. Viewers are put in touch with their own heart-
beat, breathing, and inner thoughts.
Symbolism in the Cinema • 291
The Seventh Seal is an essential film. Woody Allen's career was perma-
nently altered by it, not only in his dramas Interiors, Another Woman, and
September, but in the comedies Love and Death, A Midsummer Night's Sex
Comedy, and dramedies such as Hannah and Her Sisters. American New
Wave directors Francis Ford Coppola and Paul Schrader, who came of age
in the 1960s and 1970s, were disciples who made the pilgrimage to each
and every new Ingmar Bergman film. It is a film that fascinates adoles-
cents who question their own existence. There is a stage when cineastes
feel they have outgrown The Seventh Seal with its pronouncements con-
cerning death and God. But that passes and we eventually arrive in a
place that Ingmar Bergman has never left. It is a place where he plum-
mets into his subconscious, conscious, and personal life for an answer he
may only get after the light finally goes out.
Of Further Interest
Screen
El Topo
Fireworks
Interiors
Meshes of the Afternoon
Persona
Read
Images: My Life in Film by Ingmar Bergman
The Magic Lantern: An Autobiography by Ingmar Bergman
Bergman on Bergman: Interviews with Ingmar Bergman by Stig Bjorkman, Torsten
Manns, and Jonas Sima
The Passion of Ingmar Bergman by Frank Gado
1000 Symbols: What Shapes Mean in Art and Myth by Rowena Shepard
44
Shock Corridor
The American B movie is a subversive art form. During the studio sys-
tem, B units produced lower-budget products to go out as support for the
main production vehicle. Going to the movies, audiences were treated to
a double bill of feature films packaged with short subjects, a newsreel,
and cartoons. The Bs were genre movies with a second-, third-, or lower-
tier cast. They were produced quickly without the intense scrutiny fa-
vored on an A-list release. As a result an American art thrived; the films
were bold and an explosive cocktail of exploitation, expressive style, raw
content and not-so-hidden messages. B-movie directors did not attain the
prestige of John Ford, Alfred Hitchcock, Howard Hawks, or William
Wyler, but they were able to make personal films in a factory system that
engineered their product to entertain and weave concocted dreams. To
the Hollywood moguls, the B movie was a classification. After the demise
of the studio system, it became an alternative cinema, then a genre. B
movies have always been a cinematic way of life for the maverick.
Samuel Fuller (1911-1997) is the quintessential B moviemaker. He was
a New York street journalist, a tabloid newspaperman. Fuller was in the
frontlines of World War II, and he wrote screenplays and novels. He called
his stories yarns. A highly intelligent yet blunt man, his yardstick for turn-
ing a yarn into a book or movie was based on whether it gave him a
"hard-on." Fuller hated phonies and was a truth seeker who always
aimed between the eyes and socked one in the gut. He never had to make
a speech or pen a position paper about radicalizing the well-made Holly-
Art of the B Movie • 293
soldier who during the Korean conflict defected to the Communists and
now believes he is a Civil War Confederate colonel. Trent (Hari Rhodes)
is an African American who went mad from the pressures of integrating
an all-white Southern college and now lives out the role of an Imperial
Wizard of the Ku Klux Klan. Boden (Gene Evans) is a brilliant scientist
who regressed to childhood when government pressures concerning nu-
clear armament shattered his sanity. Johnny solves the case and wins his
cherished Pulitzer, but the price is a permanent state of catatonia. He has
lost his most precious commodity—his voice.
Fuller realizes this powerful intention with a razor-sharp screenplay,
forceful direction, a visual style that interprets the narrative, and a story
structure that intensifies the emotional experience of the tragic protago-
nist.
The story is taut and economical. Not only is there no filler or fat, but
most scenes end unpredictably at the height of action and emotion, like
the erratic rhythm of a disturbed mind. Others go well beyond traditional
dramatic endurance and bring the viewer into direct experience with the
tedium and impulsive chaos that perpetually confronts the lives of the
confined mentally ill. The dialogue and situations are surprising and can-
did. Fuller allows his audience to witness hate, shame, violence, humili-
ation, racism, betrayal, sexual obsession, and the mental and physical
destruction of the human spirit without pity or any semblance of creative
restraint. This yarn is outrageous, honest, over the top, and a warning to
those who tamper with the mind. Fuller pulls out all the stops from be-
ginning to end to make his prophetic point, one that may be the most sig-
nificant metaphor that challenges human existence. Shock Corridor is
relentless until the lights come up. It begins and ends with the words of
Euripides in 425 B.C.: "Whom God wishes to destroy he first makes mad."
Shock Corridor brims with powerful and brutally effective perform-
ances. Most of the cast members were better known at the time for their
work in television and other B movies. The acting is forceful, often played
full out beyond melodrama and operatic intensity. The emotions are so
outwardly projected, they pound away at the viewer's credulity in rec-
ognizing naturalism. With no contrast or rest from the relentless passion
of the sane or the manic urges and irrationality of the insane, the audi-
ence enters a world where all is at stake in every nerve-stretched moment.
The Street is a lone, narrow hallway, the corridor to oblivion. The
mouth of this limbo is centered in front of the camera eye. The perspec-
tive is infinity. This row of desolation does not end. The internationally
renowned production designer Eugene Lourie (Grand Illusion, Rules of the
Game, Limelight) created an exacting visual metaphor for total confine-
Art of the B Movie • 295
ment, a prison of the mind with no escape in sight. To achieve what Fuller
identified as "infinity in a finite space" and "invasive claustrophobia,"
Lourie employed forced perspective. At the far end of the set, he painted
the endless horizon. Dwarfs dressed as patients paced before it to com-
plete the illusion.
Shock Corridor is photographed in ultra-stark black and white by mas-
ter Hollywood director of photography Stanley Cortez (The Magnificent
Ambersons, Night of the Hunter, The Naked Kiss). Cortez lit the film with
hard northern light. The visible source emanates from long ceiling fix-
tures that illuminate the Street—an upside down two-lane blacktop. The
cinematographer redirected the harsh white light so that it was aimed
straight and low across the frame. This created long black shadows and
a cruel reality for this doomed community. Their faces and figures are not
modeled in tonality but blasted with a cold bright intensity that leaves
them partly in the scrutiny of light and partly lost in the dark. When the
lens is far, the subjects appear to be trapped in the glare of an eternal sun-
rise. In close-up, the rays rake across the face so skin looks like a barren
desert.
Fuller's direction is tough, blatant, and immediate. Johnny Barrett's
inner voice is established at the get-go. The filtered sound of his thoughts
serves as a delivery method of narrative exposition and a system to track
Johnny's descent into madness. The psychodrama of this cautionary tale
posing as a mystery is kept on edge by Fuller's command over the mise-
en-scene. Some scenes are choreographed in long takes to emphasize the
hopelessness of the men and the enormity of the reporter's quest. The
camera can pan back and forth along the hallway, sit in one of the bleak
rooms, or stop on the Street to stare as the men act out their frayed emo-
tions. Without motivated provocation, the action can burst into spastic
motion with abrupt changes in camera position, movement, or jump cuts
that inflict illogic to the former tedium. Fuller's directorial method in-
cluded firing a gun instead of shouting "Action!" and announcing "For-
get it!" instead of "Cut." His sense of immediacy on the set was an
extension of years chasing sordid but human stories on the streets of New
York and dodging bullets in the theaters of battle during World War II.
This corridor shocks the senses. When the witnesses have their tem-
porary mental breakthroughs to rational clarity, Fuller cuts to 16mm color
footage that he photographed with his own camera during his many trav-
els over the globe. The 16mm images are stretched out and distorted
when presented in the wide-screen format, a strategy that effectively rep-
resents repressed memories of reality bursting forth through the madness
of the characters. When Johnny's mind submits to the breaking point,
296 • Becoming Film Literate
evil; sanity is love. When the men snap they become their polar oppo-
sites. Johnny is a man of words; he is destroyed by losing his voice. Hate
is action—love is compassion. If we cannot speak out against hate, we are
doomed not to love. In Samuel Fuller's words, "If I've learned anything
at all from writing all those stories, from fighting a world war, from mak-
ing all those films, from being way up and way down, I've learned that
everything—everything!—can be expressed in just four God-blessed
words: Love is the answer."
Of Further Interest
Screen
Gun Crazy (1949)
The Hitch-Hiker (1953)
The Naked Kiss
The Phenix City Story
The Wild Angels
Read
A Third Face: My Tale of Writing, Fighting, and Filmmaking by Sam Fuller
Sam Fuller by Phil Hardy
Kings of the Bs: Working within the Hollywood System: An Anthology of Film History
and Criticism, edited by Todd McCarthy and Charles Flynn
B Movies by Don Miller
Sam Fuller: Film is a Battleground: A Critical Study with Interviews, a Filmography,
and a Bibliography by Lee Server
45
Digital Filmmaking
During the 1990s, the cinema as we knew it changed forever. Until digi-
tal technology began yet another revolution in the development of mo-
tion pictures, the moviemaking process from the earliest days involved
shooting with a film camera on sprocketed celluloid film stock as the
medium that recorded the images. The evolution of the editing process
began with scissors and holding the film strips up to a light, and pro-
gressed to a viewer, then to the Moviola, a mechanical upright editing
machine used to edit at least ninety-five percent of the movies produced
during the twentieth century. The flatbed editing table was a refinement
but still relied on transporting film through a light source via sprockets.
After many false starts by myriad companies (including George Lucas's
Editroid), Avid Technology developed a software by which film could be
edited digitally on computer. During the mechanical age, the film labo-
ratory and the optical printer were the lifeline to visual effects and the
final look of a film; digital technology changed all of that.
Every motion picture begins with an idea, a story that forms in the
human imagination. Once the basic tools of the medium were invented and
in practice, it was the thought processes, dreams, fantasies, and the ability
to see images and an unfolding narrative in the mind's eye that led to the
technical innovations necessary to realize them on film. The imagination
and realities of "how to do it" are inextricably linked. Throughout history
what could be done and how well or convincingly it was rendered rested
on the tools and techniques that transposed the ideas onto the screen.
Digital Filmmaking • 299
The all-digital Jedi Master Yoda in Star Wars: Episode II—Attack of the Clones.
Courtesy Photofest.
When George Lucas originally conceived the Star Wars saga, he envi-
sioned a multipart film that would tell the epic story he dreamt of in his
thoughts. As he was writing the story before any of the films were made,
he was aware that the technology needed to produce particular images
and scenes was not yet available. The first film, Star Wars, released in
1977, was not limited in Lucas's abilities as a sci-fi dreamer and story-
teller, but Lucas was limited in the application of the mechanical film
technology that existed and the results it produced.
In the period from the release of Star Wars: Episode VI—Return of the Jedi
in 1983 to the arrival of Star Wars: Episode I—The Phantom Menace in 1999,
George Lucas and his companies Industrial Light and Magic (ILM) and
Skywalker Sound had been at the forefront of digital sound and visual
effects and electronic cinema. ILM had delivered cutting-edge masterful
visual effects for a long line of successful films, and the Skywalker Ranch
had become the state-of-the-art venue for digital sound design.
Star Wars: Episode I—The Phantom Menace gave Lucas and his team the
first opportunity to apply the technology they had cultivated working on
other projects onto a Star Wars film. Episode I became an experiment that
allowed refinements in Episode II. It had taken twenty-five years for the
tools to serve the creator's vision.
Lucas took a quantum leap by deciding to shoot Episode II—Attack of
300 • Becoming Film Literate
the Clones (2002) on digital video. The previous four films had to be pho-
tographed on film with motion picture cameras. Up until the creation of
a digital video camera that could shoot the same frame rate as a film cam-
era and improve in factors including definition and tonal range, video as
a recording device for a commercial feature motion picture was unable to
compete with the image quality of film. With the camera available, Lucas
was able to place his entire production in the digital domain. This possi-
bility allowed Lucas to create the intergalactic visions he imagined; it also
ratcheted up the definition of control on a motion picture. Film directors
had been struggling for total artistic control since the dawn of the
medium. Electronic cinema demonstrated that it had the capability to
allow changes to sound and image elements throughout the process with
nearly unlimited possibilities.
As long as someone else is paying the bills, no filmmaker has total artis-
tic control, so Lucas financed the entire production himself. Computer
graphics can create and render digital backgrounds and virtual charac-
ters and can design compositions and camera movement with a virtual
camera that can apply lighting and color effects as well. This liberated
Lucas from creature makeup, mechanical monsters, conventional matte
paintings on glass and extensive model and set construction—the com-
puter could now generate them.
Although George Lucas put all his trust into a creative team of super-
visors and their staffs comprised of small armies of artists and technolo-
gists, every detail and details within details of Attack of the Clones were
personally approved by him; Lucas even had an actual stamp pad made
up to put an imprint on drawings designating his graces to move ahead.
The process of electronic cinema is in many ways similar to traditional
filmmaking, but it allows the director to manipulate everything in the
frame at any time. This permits the director to make decisions and
changes all throughout the major aspects of production: screenwriting,
preproduction, production, and postproduction. Lucas had the vision of
the story in his mind's eye, and on Episode I for the first time he could
work more like a painter or a chef in adding a microelement at a time,
selecting from a wide range of possibilities and having total control over
the collaborative aspects of moviemaking. The visual effects supervisors
would take their instruction directly from Lucas and relay it to the com-
puter animators and graphic designers, who would do the work that
would be presented by the supervisor to the director, maintaining the
chain of command. Lucas would then sign off or give notes to continue
the process until he was satisfied.
The original screenplay for Episode II had its genesis decades ago when
Digital Filmmaking • 301
Lucas conceived and wrote out the full saga containing all of the episodes
in his epic story. Production on Episode II began with a working revised
screenplay but with the knowledge that new scenes or modifications to
scenes could be added during production and postproduction. Tradi-
tional filmmakers like Woody Allen regularly conducted reshoots that
were a total and complete process unto themselves. With digital cinema,
elements could be reconfigured and new material more easily created and
then composited (see composite shot in glossary) into the film. Lucas was
in control and did not have to explain and trust his collaborators as in the
traditional one-step process in which the film is shot and becomes the ma-
terial the editor works with. Lucas was able to have the prerogative of
dealing with or revealing what he wanted a bit at a time, and he set him-
self up as the ultimate, sole arbiter of the final work.
After the script was prepared, preproduction involved more than scout-
ing locations, hiring actors and extras, and assembling a crew and cre-
ative team. It was at this stage that Lucas previsualized the entire
production. To accomplish this, a storyboard was drawn for every shot
in the film. Then Ben Burtt (The Dark Crystal, E.T. The Extra-Terrestrial, The
Empire Strikes Back), a longtime Lucas collaborator and the film's editor
and sound designer, directed and photographed basic shots depicting the
characters (here played by ILM and Skywalker employees, family, and
friends) on a simple makeshift set. They even used one of Lucas's old cars
to represent a space craft. Digital background plates from earlier Star
Wars movies were used to composite the images. Actors wearing an ele-
ment of a creature or character on their head or body would walk through
as reference.
This material was edited by Ben Burtt and his crew into a temporary
version of the entire film. Next, Lucas worked with Burtt to go over each
shot and get the timing, sequence, and structure refined. During the pro-
duction process, this temporary version was referred to a scene at a time
and a shot at a time to guide the crew and give Lucas the precise logis-
tics of what he needed to shoot.
When Lucas made Star Wars in 1977, he had to put most everything he
wanted into the shot before the film camera. On Episode II there was quite
a bit of location shooting with the director of photography David Tatter-
sall (Con Air, The Green Mile, Die Another Day) and his crew and a pro-
duction sound team. There were physical sets or partial sets built on
location and on stages in several countries selected for the properties to
evoke the terrain of planets from another galaxy.
Much of the production work was photographed on a blue-screen (see
blue-screen shot in glossary) stage. The environment consisted of large
302 • Becoming Film Literate
shapes that were colored blue, representing architectural and other ele-
ments. The actual visual design would be digitally created and compos-
ited later in postproduction. So the actors performed in a blue void when
they were in a scene with a character or set elements that would be
computer-generated at a later date. The actors did rehearse with a voice
actor and shot at least one reference take with that actor or a stand-in.
Then the actor, knowing the eye-line matches and choreography of the
scene to be added later, would be the sole actor—or with other actors—
on the take surrounded by a sea of blue, a color that allowed computer
graphics to be composited into the scene later.1
The process of directing the actor here is similar to silent film technique
because the director literally talks the actor through the scene while the
camera is running. The actors were completely reliant on Lucas to direct
their attitudes, emotional states, and physicality toward the action and
reactions to the characters and environments they could not see. The per-
formances could only be as good as Lucas's ability to communicate and
the actors' instincts in applying their imaginations.
The definition of acting took on a new dimension in Episode II. Many
more characters were digitally created after Episode I, including Yoda, who
had previously been a hand puppet manipulated by Frank Oz (The Mup-
pet Movie, The Dark Crystal, The Stepford Wives [2004]), who also was the
voice of the Jedi master. The casting process involved approving draw-
ings and sculpted models. Once selected, often by combining elements
from several models in a sort of mix-and-match process, the computer an-
imators would scan in the figure and begin to animate. Every expression,
gesture, and piece of body language was analyzed and created to Lucas's
specifications. Lucas's comments ranged from the movement of hairs on
Yoda's ears to the speed of the walk of a digital alien in a crowd scene.
All traditional films are not only as good as just their director's ability
to judge acting, photography, design, editing, music, and sound; the col-
laborators always make a substantial contribution and in many cases may
be responsible for a major stylistic aspect that is defined as part of the vi-
sion of the film. Take as example Conrad Hall's cinematography on
American Beauty and Road to Perdition for director Sam Mendes. Lucas's
control is absolute. He functions as the only one who truly knows, and is
treated as such by everyone who works with him.
An overview of what was accomplished digitally on Episode II includes
putting the actual face of Christopher Lee portraying Count Dooku on a
human double for many of the shots during the climactic light saber duel,
creating the battle sequence by filming and editing one fighter, either
human or virtual, at a time and layering them to get the desired chore-
Digital Filmmaking • 303
digital tennis game was primitive but gave access to many imaginations
and discoveries. Star Wars is also part of the global pop culture. George
Lucas has used it to complete his vision; others are thankful and will
travel many different roads. Without Edison, Porter or Melies, we would
not have had Griffith or Eisenstein. Film history is organized by the vi-
sion of filmmakers, those who supply the tools, and the progression of
art as one artist is inspired and led by those that have gone before. The
biggest challenge to the future of cinema is whether the ideas can match
and surpass the tools—that is true innovation.
Note
1. The color green can also be used for the composite process.
Of Further Interest
Screen
The Anniversary Party
Bamboozled
Final Fantasy
Full Frontal
Time Code
Read
Digital Moviemaking by Scott Billups
$30 Film School: Write, Finance, Direct, Produce, Shoot, Edit, Distribute, Tour With,
and Sell Your Own No-Budget Digital Movie by Michael W. Dean
Visual Effect in a Digital World: A Comprehensive Glossary of over 7,000 Visual Ef-
fects Terms by Karen E. Goulekas
Digital Filmmaking 101: An Essential Guide to Producing Low Budget Movies by
Dale Newton and John Gaspard
Industrial Light + Magic: Into the Digital Realm by Mark Cotta Vaz and Patricia
Rose Duignan
46
Errol Morris transformed the nonfiction film with The Thin Blue Line
(1988). The story comprised hard documentary fact. Randall Adams was
accused and convicted of murdering a police officer in Texas. Teenager
David Harris was also a suspect, but law enforcement and the Texas jus-
tice system wanted to convict twenty-eight-year-old Adams so that they
could execute him in the electric chair. To do so they cut a deal with the
underage Harris who could deliver the ultimate punishment through his
false testimony. This case was not about justice but retribution at any cost.
Under any circumstances this would have made an intriguing docu-
mentary, but Morris did not use the standard process of the form. The Thin
Blue Line incorporates talking head interviews, docudrama, recreation,
fictional and avant-garde film techniques, a postmodern sensibility, and
illustrative images that range from inserts to stock footage. The hypnotic,
repetitive, and cosmic score by Philip Glass (Mishima: A Life in Four Chap-
ters, Koyannisqatsi, The Hours) transcends the traditional informative or
dramatic purpose of a documentary film score to impart a point of view
toward American justice as an impenetrable force. Errol Morris is not an
objective filmmaker; he is out to find the truth and to cinematically pro-
claim that the unbalanced scales of justice continue to tip in the direction
of abusive power. Morris does not achieve his political goals with in-your-
face guerilla tactics as in Michael Moore's Roger & Me and Bowling for
Columbine; rather, he employs a series of complex artistic strategies.
306 • Becoming Film Literate
On set of The Thin Blue Line as a recreation of the murder of a police officer is
filmed by director Errol Morris and his crew. The recreation is shown from
many different vantage points throughout the film—stylized talking head in-
terviews, post-modern inserts, and a hypnotic score by composer Philip
Glass, transform this true-life story into a radically new form of documentary
film. Courtesy Photofest.
The Thin Blue Line deconstructs the facts. Time cannot be stopped, but
it can be reconfigured until reality begins to emerge through the lies and
distortions, and almost mathematically, an answer appears.
The structure of The Thin Blue Line parallels the progression of the mur-
der, investigation, trial, and outcome. The story is told by Adams, Har-
ris, attorneys, the judge, witnesses, policemen, and detectives. Morris tells
the story from a posttrial vantage point. Adams was convicted and sen-
tenced to death, and the case was then overturned and manipulated by
Texas authorities to a life sentence. Adams and Harris are interviewed in
jail, the younger man incarcerated for another murder he committed. The
others are in their offices, homes, and other nondescript locations re-
Birth of a Nonfiction Film Style • 307
counting the story. Morris carefully questioned all the subjects so the story
could be told in chronological order. Through the editing process the story
unfolds in a nonlinear storytelling structure with all the twists and turns
and points of view that are presented through word, image, and an ever-
changing series of recreations of the policeman's murder.
The talking heads are interviewed skillfully, so they freely tell the story
as they know and understand it with personal views intact. Morris gets
them to speak and reveal themselves without a hint of directorial point
of view. The interview subjects trust Morris, so they gladly tell their
truths. They are not being overly manipulated by the interviewer's ques-
tions or altered by tough questioning that might put them on the defen-
sive.
The photography of the interview subjects is also nontraditional. The
art of the talking head interview has limitations, but many variations. The
size of the image, close medium, the subjects' relationship to setting and
environment, the coverage, camera movement, attention to body lan-
guage, and lighting are all components. Morris and cinematographers
Robert Chappell (In Our Water, Robert Wilson and the Civil Wars, Jakarta)
and Stefan Czapsky (Last Exit to Brooklyn, Edward Scissorhands, Batman Re-
turns) stylized the way the interviews were photographed as part of the
postmodern approach to the nonfiction film. Locations are simplified to
their essence. Adams's lawyer is seated, shelved law books on the left,
table and lamp on the right. Adams is in prison whites with the cage of
a cell in the background. Harris is in prison orange with a large tile wall
behind him. Shots appear to be locked off with no overt interpretation by
application of lens choice, composition, or movement. Of course, there is
always some interpretation. No film can be truly objective, including doc-
umentaries. Morris seeks the truth in his own idiosyncratic manner. The
relationship between subject and frame is established by the individual's
persona and Morris's view of their truth. Adams's attorney is pho-
tographed from a slightly low angle looking up to give her authority.
Adams is often in the center of the frame to represent his stability. Har-
ris is framed off-center, positioned to the right of frame where the use of
space is challenging his authority. The judge is photographed at a slight
up-tilt and on an angle to give him distinction, but his words reveal a
close-minded man looking for easy justice.
Color is used to transform the interview subjects from reality to an al-
tered atmosphere that comments on the surreal absurdity of the Texas
system of jurisprudence. The colors are all cool, like the blue car used in
the crime. The backgrounds include pink, red, blue, and purple. The
color scheme of the film is tied together by this palette and connects all
308 • Becoming Film Literate
These recreations and multiple viewpoints are not shot and edited in a
conventional docudrama format. They are never labeled, and they play
as if they are B art movie accounts of the murder. The style is closer to
neonoir. These sequences either play for the viewer's chance to deduce
or are revelations, as when two different models of a blue car are inter-
cut to demonstrate inconsistencies, or to place the officer eating inside the
car where she would have been unable to see or get involved. A slow-
motion shot of a milkshake cup flying through the air graphically but po-
etically illustrates the woman's response to hearing the gunshot from
inside the police car.
The repetition and slight variations in the music and the repeated
showings of the crime create the sense that nothing will ever be re-
solved—that somewhere in cyberspace this moment in time plays end-
lessly.
Errol Morris's dogged investigation into the Randall Adams case re-
sulted in the filmmaker actually solving the crime. At the conclusion of
The Thin Blue Line, Morris interviews David Harris one last time. This time
no camera was present. During a montage of a microcassette tape
recorder playing the interview, Harris clearly suggests his guilt and gives
his motive for allowing and contributing to Adams taking the fall for a
murder Harris committed.
The Academy of Arts and Sciences did not nominate The Thin Blue Line
for best feature documentary. The Thin Blue Line is a nonfiction film and
an experiment into the outer reaches of reality to find the truth. They say
truth is stranger than fiction; the Randall Adams case proves that thesis,
but Errol Morris showed the way that fiction—at least fictional artifacts—
could lead to the truth. Randall Adams was eventually released as a free
man because of a movie and an uncompromising and very idiosyncratic
filmmaker.
Of Further Interest
Screen
Bowling for Columbine
Capturing the Friedmans
Crumb
Mr. Death: The Rise and Fall of Fred A. Leuchter
Sherman's March
Birth of a Nonfiction Film Style • 311
Read
Making Documentary Films and Reality Videos: A Practical Guide to Planning, Film-
ing, and Editing Documentaries of Real Events by Barry Hampe
Directing the Documentary by Michael Rabiger
Experimental Enthnography: The Work of Film in the Age of Video by Catherine
Russell
Documentary Filmmakers Speak by Liz Stubb
The Search for "Reality": The Art of Documentary Filmmaking, edited by Michael
Tobias
m
Experimental Narrative
Stanley Kubrick's 2001: A Space Odyssey (1968) is a landmark film less for
its pioneering contribution to the science fiction genre than for its impact
on cinematic storytelling method and structure. From the inception of his
career, Stanley Kubrick (1928-1999) strove to explode the traditional na-
ture of film narratives. The catalyst was to transform the standard con-
ventions of a genre such as film noir in The Killing, the war film with Paths
of Glory, the political thriller in Dr. Strangelove, and the sex comedy in
Lolita into a radical new form to express his iconoclastic vision toward the
subject.
The first step toward narrative discovery in creating 2001 was in
Kubrick's choice of collaborator and the manner in which they arrived at
a shooting script. Kubrick's strategy was to first work together with noted
science fiction/science fact author Arthur C. Clarke, a man internation-
ally recognized as one of the finest minds in the field, to write a novel
loosely based on Clarke's short story "The Sentinel" and then to adapt
the novel into a screenplay. This process allowed Kubrick to create an
original screen story in which literary prose and thematic elements were
invented for the purpose of translation to a film grammar that would re-
sult in a cinematic experience for the viewer rather than a literary plot-
driven Hollywood movie story.
Of course even an experimental process is still only a process. Ideas
propel innovation, and those developed for 2001 reflected philosophical
thought, science, religiosity, man's relationship to the universe, and the
Experimental Narrative • 313
American officials survey a monolith that has been excavated on the moon.
Stanley Kubrick's landmark science fiction film accomplished the director's
career-long mission to "explode" the traditional cinematic narrative. Courtesy
Photofest.
telligence. This black monolith is aligned with the sun and moon now
shown from the earth's point of view. The great ape Moonwatcher (Daniel
Richter) makes an important discovery in a bone, which he first imple-
ments as a weapon, then victoriously throws into the air where it transi-
tions in a single edit to a tool—a spacecraft traveling in outer space.
The segment continues in the year 2001 and now concerns itself with
Dr. Heywood Floyd (William Sylvester), who takes flights to a space sta-
tion and then to Clavius, a region of the moon. Once there he boards a
hover craft to an excavation where the United States has discovered a
black monolith that emits a powerful, recordable energy that was delib-
erately buried four million years ago. When Floyd and his team inspect
the momentous find, it emits a deafening high pitch and is shown from
the perspective of the moon in its alignment with the sun and earth. The
beings responsible for the markers link the sun and the moon, which
serve the earth with light and life.
Eighteen months later, Astronauts Dave Bowman (Keir Dullea) and
Frank Poole (Gary Lockwood) are traveling to Jupiter on the Discovery
spacecraft. Three members of the crew are in hibernation until they reach
their destination. Hal, a supercomputer (the voice of Douglas Rain), is
fully responsible and in control of all on-board operations. After Hal
openly becomes concerned with the mysterious mission, the computer
uncovers an upcoming malfunction in one of the units. When it is deter-
mined by mission control that Hal is in error, Bowman and Poole try to
discuss the situation in private but the all-seeing machine reads their lips
to learn of his possible disconnection. Hal terminates the lives of Poole
and the three astronauts in hibernation. After a battle of wits and wills,
Bowman is able to regain command of the Discovery by, in effect, put-
ting Hal to death. With his last surge of energy, Hal triggers a videotaped
message from Dr. Floyd that was to be played when the entire crew was
revived and ready to receive their mission assignment. Floyd reveals that
the first sign of intelligent life outside of the Earth had been discovered
on the moon. The origin and purpose of the monolith is a total mystery.
The object is inert but emits a strong signal aimed at Jupiter.
In the next segment, a monolith moves through space and is part of an
alignment of the sun, earth, moon, and Jupiter viewed from outer space.
Bowman sets out in a space pod. The monolith disappears from its posi-
tion in the galactic order and Bowman is propelled through a star gate
into another universe. He lands in a Victorian room that is historically ac-
curate except for a futuristic floor composed of large white illuminated
squares. Bowman looks on as he ages toward death and then, through
Experimental Narrative • 3 1 5
Alcott (Barry Lyndon; The Shining; Greystoke: The Legend of Tarzan, Lord of
the Apes), and the entire art and visual effects departments made it pos-
sible for the meditative aspects of the narrative (some would say non-
narrative) to transport viewers into an unprecedented experience of the
senses that allows them to enter the world and mind-space of the film.
The critical point here is that 2001: A Space Odyssey is not about space
travel—it is space travel. This notion has been attested by real astronauts
who have seen the film and by the millions who go along for the ride
once they leave behind the resistant baggage of what a story and a film
should or should not be.
This innovative benchmark film comes largely from the mind and vi-
sion of Stanley Kubrick, but no work of art comes out of a vacuum. The
pristine, centered compositional style evolved from Kubrick's previous
six feature films, as did the analytical point of view toward the various
subjects he investigated. For a filmmaker who is often categorized as cold
and detached, Kubrick was able to arouse the passions of the intellect,
body, and spirit. The only director to have made a major stylistic impact
on Kubrick was Max Ophiils (La Ronde [see chapter 38], Letter from an Un-
known Woman, Lola Montes), mostly for the use of camera movement. On
2002 there were three specific cinematic inspirations that led to aspects of
Kubrick's approach to the project. Universe, a black-and-white short film
produced for the Canadian Film Board, astonished Kubrick with its de-
piction of heavenly imagery and pointed to possible technical solutions
unavailable from the Hollywood school. The work of experimental film-
maker Jordan Belson, a West Coast Zen master and cinematic abstrac-
tionist, is reflected in the "Star Gate" sequence. Belson is acclaimed for
his use of the optical printer to conjure up spiritual images of a cosmic
origin. John Whitney, the pioneer of computer graphics on film, opened
up a panorama of possibilities concerning consciousness-expanding vi-
sions that led Kubrick out of the conventional box of cinema-think.
2002 has made such an impression on film culture that Richard
Strauss's majestic Thus Spake Zarathustra, composed in 1896, is commonly
known as the 2002 theme. The concept of marrying music from the past
with the visions of the future is one of the film's grand accomplishments.
Kubrick understood that context was everything. The old-world grace of
the Blue Danube waltz humanized space flight and turned science into
pure poetry. Stanley Kubrick may have set out to just make "a really good
sci-fi movie," but 2002; A Space Odyssey is so much more than that. Stan-
ley Kubrick did not live to see the first year of the new millennium, but
that is okay—he had already filmed it for posterity.
318 • Becoming Film Literate
Of Further Interest
Screen
Baraka
Koyannisqatsi
Nagoyqatsi
Powaqqatsi
Privilege (1990)
Read
The Making of Kubrick's 2001, edited by Jerome Agel
2002: Filming the Future by Piers Bizony
Kubrick's Cinema Odyssey by Michel Chion
Moonwatcher's Memoir: A Diary of 2001: A Space Odyssey by Dan Richter
The Making of 2001: A Space Odyssey, edited by Martin Scorsese, selected by
Stephanie Schwam
48
Weekend
Radicals tote guns and play rock and roll in the woods during Jean-Luc Go-
dard's Weekend, an essay on the corruption of the bourgeoisie, destruction,
class decay, revolution, and the end of cinema. Courtesy Photofest.
was able to get in the rhetoric of many radical points of view, usually sup-
porting the workers over the oppressors, so that the audience could lis-
ten to the words while confronted by another character looking right at
them to make sure they were listening.
The color scheme of Weekend is as controlled as Dick Sylbert's Oscar-
winning production design consisting of primary colors for Warren
Beatty's Dick Tracy. The color palette here is limited to red, yellow, blue,
and green. Red is the color of revolution, Mao, and blood. The blood in
this film looks deliberately fake and is poured onto actors and locations
to symbolize the blood spilled by capitalists and revolutionaries. The ar-
tifice is part of a continual effort to remind viewers they are watching a
movie. We never see a camera, but characters refer to the cinema in gen-
eral or to the movie that we are watching. Red, white, and blue are em-
phasized to evoke the flags of France and America, two countries that
contain young radicals trying to undermine the capitalist credo. Green
represents the earth. Sequences take place outside the city in the coun-
tryside where there is always a road, a sign of modern life. Green is also
carried over into the dress of the revolutionary characters to link them to
the purity of the environment.
Godard comments on the use of score in classical Hollywood cinema
by positioning the music cues written by Antoine Duhumel (Stolen Kisses,
Belle Epoque, Ridicule) so that they are not invisible but deliberately in-
trusive. A traditional dramatic musical theme is employed in the scene
when the woman is interrogated about a forced sexual encounter, but the
music cue starts abruptly and concludes in what seems like random po-
sitioning. If that is not enough to call attention to a cinematic element, the
music is mixed to rise so loudly, it competes with the audibility of her
voice.
Theatrical and literary devices are brazenly applied to Godard's mise-
en-scene. Characters portraying Emily Bronte (Blandine Jeanson), Tom
Thumb (Yves Afonso) and Saint-Just (Jean-Pierre Leaud) walk into scenes
in period costume while proselytizing social and political views. Go-
dard's staging nods to the Theaters of the Absurd and Revolt.2 When Cor-
rine's mother is murdered, a close-up of an animal's head fills the screen
as quarts of stage blood are poured over it. Corrine and Roland keep
going on their road trek by taking turns carrying the other in piggyback
fashion as the laborer counts to a proscribed number signaling the switch.
As a ploy to stop cars for a ride, Roland encourages Corrine to lie on the
road with her legs spread open in the direction of the oncoming traffic.
These theatrical strategies draw attention to the heightened polemics Go-
dard is espousing. For example, Corrine is obsessed with finding designer
The Essay Film • 323
Notes
1. Bertold Brecht (1898-1956) was a poet and playwright whose stage work in-
cludes Mother Courage and Her Children, Galileo, The Good Woman of Szechwan and
The Caucasian Chalk Circle. Brecht was opposed to the idea of Aristotelian drama
in which the audience identified with the characters. He wanted the audience to
think, not to feel. He created an epic theater designed with an "alienation effect"—
techniques that encouraged audiences to remain in control of their critical facul-
ties. Brecht achieved this sense of detachment in his theatrical work by applying
techniques such as having the characters directly address the audience, a device
widely applied in Weekend.
2. The Theater of the Absurd is a tendency developed in Paris, France, in the
late 1940s through the early 1950s with the work of playwrights Samuel Beckett,
Jean Genet, Eugene Ionesco, and Fernando Arrabal. The term is traced to exis-
tentialists Albert Camus and Jean Paul Sartre, who both believed that the only ra-
tional explanation of the universe was beyond humanity and must be viewed as
absurd. The plays project bewilderment, anxiety, and wonder toward the world.
Poetic metaphors represent the inner state of the mind. Fantasy, dreams, and
nightmares are applied to the playwright's perception of reality.
The Theater of Revolt is a critical classification created by Robert Brustein in
his book The Theatre of Revolt: An Approach to Modern Drama, which studies the
work of playwrights Henrik Ibsen, August Strindberg, Anton Chekov, George
Bernard Shaw, Bertolt Brecht, Luigi Pirandello, Eugene O'Neill, and Jean Genet.
Brustein's thesis concerned the shift of Western drama from "theater of com-
munion," which reinforces society's belief system, to a "theatre of revolt," in
which social and political norms were critiqued and protested through drama.
3. Mao Tse-tung led China's communist revolution and served as chairman of
the People's Republic of China from 1949-1959. His book Quotations from Chair-
man Mao Tse-tung expressed his Marxist-Leninist political beliefs. The little book
with the red cover was widely read by campus and political radicals of the 1960s
The Essay Film • 325
Of Further Interest
Screen
The Director and His Actor Look at Footage Showing Preparations for an Unmade
Film
Fast, Cheap & Out of Control
A Personal Journey with Martin Scorsese through American Movies
Sans Soleil
Thirty Two Short Films about Glenn Gould
Read
Godard: A Portrait of the Artist at Seventy by Colin MacCabe
Godard on Godard, translation and commentary by Tom Milne
Godard by Richard Roud
Speaking about Godard by Kaja Silverman and Harun Farocki
The Films of Jean-Luc Godard: Seeing The Invisible by David Sterritt
49
The Wild Bunch was released in July of 1969 when the Vietnam War was
raging. America was swept up in a social and political upheaval, and
"sex, drugs, and rock & roll" was the mantra for the under-thirty gener-
ation. The American Western movie had ceased to dominate the country's
imagination. Director Sam Peckinpah (1925-1984) was about to change
the way we looked at movies.
The Wild Bunch challenged America's values and the very veracity of
our history. This was accomplished by a film that was reviled for its con-
tent and action by the tastemakers of the time who placed a stigma on it
and the director. A decade after Peckinpah's death, the times finally
caught up with this brilliant maverick and The Wild Bunch was anointed
a certified classic of U.S. cinema. It took revisionist film historians to look
back and acknowledge a masterpiece of Western genre revisionism not
fully appreciated in its time.
The narrative of The Wild Bunch is familiar. It is the story of a gang of
desperados who rob a bank and are hunted down by a posse. On the run,
they pull off one last score that leads to their total destruction in a cli-
mactic shoot-out. On the surface this seems a prototypical American
Western, but Peckinpah turned the tables on all the conventions. A white
or black hat or horse does not identify the morality of a character. The
composition of the posse includes a former member of the Bunch and two
vile, amoral men, and they are paid by a ruthless corporate agent. The
majority of the Bunch are loyal men of honor who view society as cor-
Screen Violence as Metaphor • 327
Robert Ryan (left) as Deke Thornton, a former Bunch member now part of a
posse, looks on after a massacre between the Bunch and the army of a Mexi-
can general at the dead bodies of Pike Bishop (William Holden, with his hand
on the machine gun) and Dutch Engstrom (Ernest Borgnine) at the conclu-
sion of Sam Peckinpah's The Wild Bunch. For the maverick director the exces-
sive screen violence was both a cathartic experience for the audience as well
as an in-your-face reminder of man's violent nature. Courtesy Photofest.
rupt. The law serves the interests of the rich and powerful. The outlaws
respect the unwritten code of the land and live off the wealth of the
greedy. There are no clear-cut good guys or bad guys, so justice is not
served at the conclusion. Peckinpah is a romantic but not in the manner
demonstrated by the purveyors of the genre during the studio era. Be-
havior and values are not romanticized, but male bonding is, along with
nostalgia for the unruly past.
Stylistic and aesthetic conventions are radically altered in The Wild
Bunch. The opening and closing gunfights erupt suddenly on bright
sunny days of pictorial beauty rather than in the murky clouded and
stormy conditions of an artificial dramatic atmosphere. The generalized
pristine architecture and costumes common to the genre are replaced with
authentic, aged buildings. The materials are textured and weather-beaten.
Clothes are dusty and torn, not tailored to fit. Peckinpah breaks axis (see
328 • Becoming Film Literate
inpah visualized his scenes in units of action and content and shot them
with as many as eight cameras running concurrently to cover the sweep
and detail of his intent. Film editor Lou Lombardo (McCabe and Mrs.
Miller, The Long Goodbye, Moonstruck), working on a Moviola without the
corrective bubble that converted the squeezed widescreen image on the
film to its proper shape (because it got in his way), cut a final total of
3,642 edits (a record number at the time) into the fabric of The Wild Bunch.
Although the montage style developed by Peckinpah and Lombardo for
The Wild Bunch was a radical departure for American film at the time, it
became a major force in contemporary filmmaking and can be seen in the
work of Martin Scorsese, John Woo, Oliver Stone, Walter Hill, and
Quentin Tarantino and in action movies and music video inspired fea-
tures such as Flashdance and Top Gun—they all owe a debt to Peckinpah
and Lombardo.
The editing of The Wild Bunch accomplishes many significant objectives.
In action sequences, it integrates slow motion, extensive coverage, and
points of view into the presentation of several events happening simul-
taneously through intricate crosscutting techniques. Rather than com-
pressing time and action, Peckinpah and Lombardo more often extend it.
This technique emphasizes the massive damage done during human de-
struction as well as triggering a range of emotions and reactions in the
viewer. By connecting the Bunch's verbal and nonverbal interactions, the
editing probes their relationships to each other and to their ever-changing
universe. Intercutting the posse's pursuit of the Bunch creates a sense of
inevitability; the desperados are playing out their string to the very end.
The corporate culture that takes over the country at the beginning of the
American century will put an end to the individual's ability to roam free.
Men dominate the world of The Wild Bunch. Women are tormented and
murdered by machismo aggression. They are representatives of a civi-
lized minority or exist for man's carnal cravings. In this film the Mexican
women betray the honor of men. True, complete, and faithful love is only
shared and experienced by males—not a romantic love but an unequiv-
ocal bond. Pike Bishop (William Holden), the leader of the Bunch, shares
this with two men. Dutch Engstrom (Ernest Borgnine) is a longtime mem-
ber who is loyal to the end. He respects, understands, supports, and coun-
sels Pike, who knows he can count on him even when he shouts, "C'mon
you lazy bastards." A more complex relationship connects Pike and Deke
Thornton (Robert Ryan), who is pressured to hunt down and capture the
Bunch to escape a prison sentence. Pike and Deke once ran together. Al-
though they are now apart and on what society defines as different sides
330 • Becoming Film Literate
of the law, they accept each other for who they are and have been in the
past. Each knows how the other man thinks and what he will and will
not do. They both mourn a time when they were allowed to be free with-
out federal rule.
Loss of independence and an elegy for the past is a recurring theme of
The Wild Bunch. The Bunch represents a fading America of open spaces
without boundaries, where a man could live by an unspoken law. Politi-
cal, military, and corporate power embodied in Generalissmo Mapache
(Emilio Fernandez) and Harrigan (Albert Dekker) threatens this way of
life and signifies a future of repression and classism. The Bunch expresses
longing in word and deed, and in the toll the present has taken on the
body and mind. Flashbacks show past events and the memory sense that
never leaves the men. These recollections are triggered during action or
dialogue that reminds them of the way their lives once were. These scenes
serve as backstory. They occur while we hear the voices and sounds of
the present and are visually transitioned by long overlapping dissolves
that for a time superimpose (see superimposition in glossary) the two
time frames; they serve to reflect held memories. Some of these moments
are wistful while others are full of regret.
The men ride horses and wear cowboy attire but are surrounded by
symbols of an industrialized nation. The car threatens man's relationship
to the horse and to the open plains. Mapache uses his ornate red auto-
mobile, a sign of affluence, to drag and torture Angel (Jamie Sanchez), a
Mexican member of the Bunch. The train is a vehicle to transport goods,
but it also is defended by the military and owned by the corporate enemy
of the drifters. World War I is referenced, as is the existence of the air-
plane. The machine gun represents a mechanization that makes wide-
spread warfare possible. The power of this weapon is linked to an
unleashed expression of manhood and is ultimately responsible for the
demise of the Bunch.
Mexico is a microcosm of the evolving landscape and culture of Amer-
ica. The traditional life is preserved but under constant threat. Life is
leisurely, full of laughter and physical pleasures. The society is at war
with itself. The power of the people is being taken away by regimes
crazed by self-interest. To the Bunch, Mexico is the last outpost where
men can live and die by their own hand. Now national, international, and
internal powers vie for jurisdiction and rule.
The most forceful argument supporting Peckinpah's argument that
man is born with violent attributes is illustrated in the way children are
portrayed in The Wild Bunch. The gun battle that introduces the film is
Screen Violence as Metaphor • 331
bookended by a group of young boys and girls at the edge of town who
watch and play with glee as a deadly scorpion is devoured by hundreds
of ants. They torture and destroy the insects with sticks and fire as a force-
ful metaphor that we are all born with the capacity to harm. Children in
the midst of disorder are ambivalent about the shooting all around them.
Children follow Angel as he is dragged through the street by Mapache's
car as if they are chasing an ice cream wagon. For all of its polemic and
didactic purpose, The Wild Bunch manages to entertain by presenting col-
orful characters, dramatic tension and release, as well as several breath-
taking action set pieces. There is a classic train robbery pushed to
extremes by involving the Bunch, the posse, and the military in a hu-
morous and thrilling chase. Later the dynamiting of a bridge is a specta-
cle that sends the posse on their horses into a treacherous river below.
The end of The Wild Bunch comes full circle. Although the gang's nu-
cleus is dead, Thornton sits outside as the bodies are carried off by the
posse. Freddie Sykes (Edmond O'Brien), an old mule-skinner who helped
the Bunch with their business, rides in with some members of Angel's vil-
lage. They go off and form a new Bunch. The faces of the departed Bunch
laugh with them in spirit, dissolving in and out while the reorganized
gang vows to continue as long as they can in their vanishing universe.
Their image freezes then and recedes into the background until it trans-
forms into the words "The End." The background is a soft-focus leafy cos-
mos where the Wild Bunch can take their place.
Peckinpah drew inspiration from the bible, Shakespeare, and John Ford
to create The Wild Bunch. He took the sanitized histories of Western film
and replaced them with life as he understood it, both in the past and pres-
ent. They say all art is autobiographical and film directors identify with
their characters. The truth of this statement is revealed in the opening
credits when Pike, who is the director's on-screen persona, says, "If they
move . . . kill 'em!" The color image turns to black and white and freezes
as it heralds, "Directed by Sam Peckinpah."
Of Further Interest
Screen
A Clockwork Orange
Natural Born Killers
Pat Garrett and Billy the Kid
Salo
Straw Dogs
332 • Becoming Film Literate
Read
Bloody Sam: The Life and Films of Sam Peckinpah by Marshall Fine
Violent Screen: A Critic's 13 Years on the Frontlines of Movie Mayhem by Stephen
Hunter
Sam Peckinpah's The Wild Bunch, edited by Stephen Prince
Peckinpah: A Portrait in Montage by Garner Simmons
"If They Move .. . Kill 'Em!": The Life and Times of Sam Peckinpah by David Wed-
dle
50
Independent Filmmaking
Gena Rowlands and Peter Falk as Mabel and Nick Longhetti in the John Cas-
savetes film A Woman Under the Influence. Cassavetes, considered to be the fa-
ther of the independent film movement, had one narrative theme—love. His
cinematic approach was to defy and destroy all the conventions of traditional
Hollywood moviemaking. Courtesy Photofest.
ments. Nick (Peter Falk) and Mabel (Gena Rowlands) Longhetti have
three children and live in a California suburb. Nick is a laborer in public
works construction; Mabel, a stay-at-home mom. When a city emergency
keeps Nick from a promise of a night alone with his wife, Mabel begins
to unravel emotionally. With the children at her mother's and anxieties
over her roles as wife and mother whelming within her, Mabel heads out
to a bar, gets drunk, and wakes up the next day in her bed with a strange
man in the house. Mabel's behavior continues to spiral out of control. She
is disoriented, acts inappropriately when Nick and his crew arrive for a
spaghetti breakfast, and loses control over a child's birthday party dur-
ing which the kids run around the house in various states of undress.
Nick, pressured by his demanding mother, decides to institutionalize his
wife when his limited understanding of how to communicate with her
leaves him frustrated, angry, and without choice.
Is Mabel Longhetti mentally ill or, as her family and friends put it, crazy
Independent Filmmaking • 335
or cuckoo? Her behavior, which began well before the inciting incident,
seems unstable by most standards, but clearly she has the director's full
support. It is when Mabel is forced into constricting gender and adult
roles or is bombarded with extreme angry emotions from her husband
and mother-in-law that she begins to decompensate. The people around
her are loud, crude, and programmed into society's notion of proper be-
havior. Mabel's way of coping in this environment is to sing, dance, have
fun, and to try to make a party out of every situation. Nick loves her.
When he finally comes to terms with who Mabel really is, there is peace
within the Longhetti household. Nick also has difficulty with the macho
gender role and the restrictions of adult behavior legislated by society.
His emotional range is limited and erratic but acceptable to those around
him. His anger toward Mabel, and at times directed toward his family
and friends, is fueled by frustration and embarrassment but remains
within the acceptable definition of the adult male role. Mabel's childish
exhibitions are unacceptable to all the adults. They all love her but can
not tolerate her nonconformity.
In A Woman Under the Influence, the actions and behaviors of the char-
acters are not dramatized by a traditional screenplay. There is little nar-
rative sense of a plot and the events are not structured, so each element
has a purpose and stays on screen just long enough for the audience to
comprehend it. The method by which Cassavetes created a screenplay
and then directed his actors in front of the camera has largely been mis-
understood. A Woman Under the Influence and most of Cassavetes's later
films were not wholly improvised while the camera rolled as is generally
believed. A script was written with dialogue and action containing the
basic story situation. This script went through an intensive rehearsal
process during which the actors were encouraged to improvise dialogue,
behavior, and action. This improvisation was recorded on audio tape. The
tape was then transcribed word for word and fashioned into the shoot-
ing script used during production. The actors adhered to that written
word. This is not improvisation but a work process in which discovery
and experimentation became part of the final text used to create a film.
The acting method and style is also responsible for the emotionally
honest results. The cast did not act in the manner of Hollywood studio
films. There was no emphasis on proper elocution, "correct" line read-
ings, and theatrical blocking. The actors, some professional, others not,
were directed to be—to live in the situations in which their characters find
themselves.
The script and acting procedures created a real life drama closer to
cinema verite than a fictional film built out of traditional dramaturgy. The
336 • Becoming Film Literate
family's anxieties toward her actions are contrasted in a manner that cre-
ates a palpable stress.
The editing by Tom Cornwell (Husbands, The Killing of a Chinese Bookie,
Opening Night) preserves the real-time feeling and the extended time
agony of this family dilemma. The sequence in which the family doctor
arrives to assist Nick and his mother in committing Mabel to a mental in-
stitution by eventually giving her a sedative after all methods to "calm"
her fail is one of the most agonizing and emotionally fatiguing in Amer-
ican film. Relationships and character development are allowed to
progress with a minimum of editorial intervention. Often a shot plays on
well past the time it seems needed to achieve its purpose until a gesture,
expression, dialogue, or action brings a revelation that would have been
disturbed by editorial compression or montage. Many times a character
will just appear or turn away from the camera. Again, Cassavetes defies
conventions and uses the power of body language or physical presence
to resonate.
John Cassavetes did not believe in the artifice of production design. The
Longhetti home is the Cassavetes household where the director and his
muse, Gena Rowlands, lived and raised their children. The physicality
and character of this real space is the reality Cassavetes and Rowlands
lived in. The double doors that divide the space are used by the charac-
ters to hide, contain, shelter, and expose. The home looks like a working-
class family residence. Hollywood decor was usually upscaled to
glamorize the film, but it was a false notion. A family such as the
Longhetti's would not have had an interior decorator. These are simple
hard-working people who have created a family environment, a func-
tional place to live and raise a family. The landscape where Nick and his
crew are involved in heavy construction utilizing earthmovers in dan-
gerous physical conditions was shot on location. The men and the action
are naturalistic and not embellished for purposes of exploiting action for
its own sake. When one of the workers takes a serious fall during an ar-
gument with Nick over Mabel's sanity, the scene is staged, photographed,
and edited for its relevance to the emotional life and relationships of the
characters. Nick feels enormous guilt that he caused serious injury to one
of his workers, and the worker feels guilty that he involved himself in
another man's personal business and is conflicted toward Mabel and her
state of mind. Action is the result of emotional confrontation, not as an
impetus to dramatize or to artificially move the story forward.
The formal qualities of A Woman Under the Influence reject the gloss and
movie trickery in the films John Cassavetes grew up with and worked on
338 • Becoming Film Literate
as an actor as he was learning his craft and later earning money to sup-
port his independent filmmaking. A Woman Under the Influence has more
in common with the qualities of the home movie. The natural color, grain
pattern, exposure, and simple, artless approach to the frame trigger mem-
ory responses in the viewer's mind. We are watching life unfold, not a
movie that manipulates reactions through overt cinematic means. This
Kodachrome reality made it difficult at best for many to enter the world
of a John Cassavetes film. With few exceptions, critics derided Cassavetes
as an amateur, undisciplined, excessive, and pointless. Audiences had
their problems with this unruly artist, but the truth in the content, per-
formances, and aesthetic presentation moved many and influenced a gen-
eration of filmmakers who followed the Cassavetes credo of a cinema that
embraced the entanglements of life.
The music by Bo Harwood (Minnie and Moskowitz, Happy Birthday to
Me, Love Streams) utilizes Italian opera and songs sung on camera and as
score. There is an extensive piano score performed and played on an up-
right piano that sounds like a nonprofessional musician playing from his
heart. Often there is wordless singing. This approach contributes to eth-
nic and personal qualities of the characters and story while serving as an
alternate means for providing movie music.
Gena Rowlands gives one of the most electrifying female performances
in American film. Rowlands is emotionally raw, playing every thought
and feeling with abandon and honesty. Her physical beauty, earthiness,
vulnerability, childlike nature, and explosive anxieties are riveting to ob-
serve. Using gestures and body choreography to communicate when a
flood of emotion blocks her speech, Rowlands projects a woman under
the influence of a life that disallows the freedom to express herself.
Peter Falk gives his finest performance as a man who loves his wife but
can not reject the rules imposed on him. Through his confusion and rage,
he learns that the unconditional love he feels for his wife is pure and finds
happiness by rejecting the judgmental forces pressuring him. Falk cap-
tures the sincerity of a decent man in conflict with his mother and con-
cerned over what others think, but who ultimately trusts his own feelings.
Peter Falk is forceful and tender and expresses the process of being lost
and then found through Nick's chaotic life experience.
A Woman Under the Influence is not an entertainment film. Cassavetes's
brave work is a venue to observe and learn about life one-on-one with
the film in front of you. The old Hollywood dream factory packed up and
left town. A Woman Under the Influence is a roadway where filmmakers
and audiences travel not to escape but to seek. That process is not always
pretty but is always worth the struggle.
Independent Filmmaking • 339
Of Further Interest
Screen
Jazz on a Summer's Day
Little Fugitive
The Return of the Secaucus Seven
The Savage Eye
sex, lies, and videotape
Shadows
Read
American Dreaming: The Films of John Cassavetes and the American Experience by
Raymond Carney
Cassavetes on Cassavetes, edited by Ray Carney
The Films of John Cassavetes: Pragmatism, Modernism, and the Movies by Ray Car-
ney
John Cassavetes: Lifeworks by Tom Charity
Cinema of Outsiders: The Rise of American Independent Film by Emanuel Levy
This page intentionally left blank
GLOSSARY
anamorphic wide-screen format: Camera lens that squeezes the horizontal plane of
an image to approximately half size so it can fit into the width of 35mm
film. A deanamorphizing projection lens restores the image to full size on
the screen.
anthropological film: Nonfiction form that joins anthropologists and filmmakers
who utilize film and video to record the environmental, cultural, racial, and
social aspects of human beings.
antihero: A sympathetic character who presents a social, moral, or political point
of view indifferent to the world he or she inhabits. James Dean in Rebel
without a Cause, Paul Newman in Hud, and Jack Nicholson in Five Easy
Pieces all portray characters with the qualities associated with the antihero.
aspect ratio: A measurement of the camera film frame or the projected image, stated
as ratio of horizontal to vertical. The most common ratios are 1.85:1 (nor-
mal wide-screen) and 2.35:1 (anamorphic).
aural perspective: The volume and tonal qualities of a sound in relation to its dis-
tance from the camera.
auteur theory: Theoretical concept formulated in the pages of Cahier du Cinema in
the 1950s by French New Wave filmmakers and critics and later in the
United States by Andrew Sarris in the magazine Film Culture and the Village
Voice. The theory states that the film director is the author of a film.
avant-garde film: Early term used to describe the movement of filmmakers who re-
belled against the Hollywood product in content, theme, style, and ap-
proach by creating films whose prime goal is art and not commercial
narrative storytelling.
342 • Glossary
background plate: Film, video, digital or photographic slide with a still or moving
image of a setting to be used as a background for rear- or front-screen pro-
jection.
backstory: Previous events that have occurred in the past of a character prior to
the start of a film narrative.
blue-screen shot: Process whereby actors are photographed in front of a blue or
green background so that a second image with a background and possibly
other actors or created characters can be composited together in a labora-
tory or through digital means.
breaking axis: Any shot taken from the opposite side of the imaginary line running
horizontally through a screen. Also called crossing the line, the 180-degree
rule, or direct reverse.
canted angle: An unusual composition that expresses a unique point of view and
personal interpretation. Also known as a dutch angle.
cinema verite: A documentary film form developed in France during the 1950s and
1960s that attempts to film life as it really is without cinematic manipula-
tion or interference.
color palette: A series of related colors used by the production designer to create
the mood and atmosphere of a film.
composite shot: When more than one visual element is combined to create an image
at the laboratory stage or through manipulation by digital software.
compression: An editing technique that compresses an event into a shorter space
of time than it would take in real time. Although the basis of most editing
is to compress time, the editor can drastically alter real time when it is dra-
matically necessary for a scene.
coverage: Footage that duplicates or complements the master shot from a differ-
ent angle or size, thus allowing the editor to make a match or move the
film forward editorially.
crane: Device used to raise the camera and operator high above a scene while
shooting. The movement of a camera crane is similar to a cherry picker.
Many current cranes are operated remotely from a video console.
crosscutting: Editing technique whereby shots or scenes are cut together in alter-
nate sequence to create a dramatic relationship. Also called intercutting.
deep-focus photography: Style of cinematography that utilizes a depth of field so the
fore, middle, and background are all in sharp focus.
desaturation: Process employed either before, during, or after shooting that drains
color out of the image to a desired degree.
diegetic sound: Sounds that occur within the screen space.
digital postproduction: Process that includes editing picture and sound and visual
effects utilizing computer software such as Photoshop, Maya, and After Ef-
fects and nonlinear platforms such as Avid, Final Cut Pro, and ProTools.
Glossary • 343
direct cinema: The American interpretation of cinema verite, in which the camera
is nonobjective and as invisible as possible in the manner of the French
school but in which films are tightly structured during the editing process.
direct cut: An end-to-end cut without any optical or digital transitions.
dissolve: Optical process whereby one shot fades out as the next shot fades in.
docudrama: A staged recreation of a real event.
documentary: A nonfiction film dealing with facts that attempts to present reality
as it is.
dramedy: A film narrative that employs elements of both comedy and drama.
dutch angle: An unusual composition that expresses a unique point of view and
personal interpretation. Also known as a canted angle.
ethnographic film: The study and systematic recording of human cultures on film.
experimental film: Nonnarrative filmmaking created in opposition to the commer-
cial nature of the Hollywood studio film. A term used in the 1960s and
1970s to identify individual, nontraditional filmmakers with artistic inten-
tions often employing abstract concepts and techniques.
exposition: Establishing the principal story action and the general circumstances
of the characters.
eye-line match: When the direction and angle of a character's gaze is staged and
photographed by the camera so it will connect with same of another char-
acter in the previous or following shot.
fade in: Optical effect or digital transition in which an image appears from black
or a solid color field.
fade out: Optical effect or digital transition in which an image disappears into black
or a solid color field. Also known as a fade to black.
film noir: A Hollywood film style in the post-World War II era of the 1940s and
early 1950s identified by French film critics. These black-and-white films
took place in the criminal underworld. The characters were cynical and
disillusioned. Most scenes took place at night and the atmosphere was
doom-laden. The visual style of film noir, which translates literally to
"black film," featured squalid settings and deep shadows.
filtration: The use of transparent colored glass or gelatin positioned in front of the
lens or lighting instruments to reduce and control light.
flashback: A scene that takes place earlier in time than the one that precedes it.
flashforward: A scene that jumps ahead out of relation to the time frame that has
been established.
focal length: Distance from the optical center of a lens to where it brings an object
at an infinite distance into critical focus.
forced perspective: Technique used to create depth by foreshortening the back-
ground.
344 • Glossary
freeze frame: A single frame of a motion picture image repeated for a desired length
of time.
genre: The organization of films according to type. The musical, crime, Western,
action, film noir, and science fiction film are all examples of genres.
glass shot: Special effects technique in which photographs or a painted scene are
on a sheet of glass. When the camera shoots through the glass, the images
are added to the action in the background.
guerrilla filmmaking: Low-budget, independent films made quickly without per-
mits for locations, a union crew, or elaborate equipment. Filmmaking on
the fly, on the cheap, a bare-bones production.
handheld camera: Technique in which the camera is held and operated by the op-
erator without a tripod or dolly
high-key lighting: An even application of bright light with little or no shadows.
insert: A short shot, usually filmed separately and cut into a scene. An insert can
be a shot of a clock, a newspaper headline, or a detail that helps to explain
the action or meaning of a scene.
intercutting: Editing technique whereby shots or scenes are cut together in alter-
nate sequence to create a dramatic relationship. Also called crosscutting.
interscene editing: The cuts or edits taking place within a scene.
inter-titles: Text inserted into the body of a film. Utilized in silent films to present
dialogue and background information and to establish time and place. In
sound films inter-titles provide information or comment on the content of
the film.
iris shot: A shot associated with silent filmmaking that is masked, most often in a
circular shape, to open or close a scene by expanding or decreasing the
image shape to or from full screen, to bring attention to a character or ob-
ject, or to contrast the context between the isolated image and the full-
screen space.
Italian neorealism: A post-War World II film movement active in Italy from 1944
through 1953 with a moral and stylistic commitment to realism.
jump cut: A jump in action caused by removing part of a continuous shot or by
joining two shots that do not match in continuity
light source: Origin of light. A natural light source is the sun; practical light
sources are provided by on-screen lamps or bulbs. The moon is a natural
light source at night, and a streetlamp is a practical source. Film lighting
is based on the nature and direction of the sources. Lighting instruments
are positioned to justify and create the proper mood based on the source
of light.
linear storytelling: A narrative that utilizes a consecutive time line without flash-
backs or flashforwards.
Glossary • 345
locked-off camera: A camera that is secured in position and composition after a shot
is completed. Cameras are often locked off so that another shot with dif-
ferent action can be photographed and later edited together with the for-
mer shot to give the illusion of a continuous take. Any shot without camera
or lens movement can also be referred to as being locked off.
low-key lighting: Film lighting that achieves a dark scale with a low level of illu-
mination, where shadows are prevalent and pools of bright light empha-
size the contrast with the overall darkness.
master shot: Continuous shot that includes the entire action of a scene.
match-back: Process in which a final version of a motion picture photographed on
film and edited on a nonlinear computer system is matched to the original
film negative to produce a release print.
match cut: Two shots that link or match a related action.
material: Term that refers to the film or videotape available in a raw unedited state
for postproduction of a motion picture.
matte painting: A background image painted on glass or on a board or made into
a photographic slide, combined with a foreground shot to create a com-
posite image.
miniature: An identical but small-scale model of a set, object, or location.
mise-en-scene: French theater term applied to a film director's use of composition,
staging, movement, design, costumes, and lighting as an expressive nar-
rative and stylistic tool.
montage: The French word for editing. The early Russian cinema style in which a
collision effect was achieved between shots designed for their graphic, nar-
rative, social, and political purpose. In the classical Hollywood studio
model, a series of shots that established the passage of time or compressed
an action or event. A contemporary filmmaking style that employs a mul-
titude of individual shot details as the main communication source of sto-
rytelling.
morphing: Digital technique in which two or more images are blended together to
create a new or interpolated result over a period of screen time.
multiple exposure: When the same section of a film negative is exposed more than
twice to superimpose a series of images into one shot.
mythopoetic film: A critical classification termed by avant-garde film historian P.
Adams Sitney for films that present the ventures of gods, heroes, organic
elements, and animals as they impact the order of the universe through a
visual language that governs the filmmaker's expression of thematic con-
tent.
narration: Words spoken by an off-screen voice, either an unidentified speaker or
one of the characters in a film. Theorists have classified the text of a nar-
rator as being reliable or unreliable as part of a narrative strategy.
346 • Glossary
split screen: When the screen is divided into two or more separate fields that each
present their own image.
stock footage: Pre-existing film, purchased from a stock footage library or archive.
Also known as archival footage.
stop-motion photography: An animation technique by which images are exposed a
frame at a time to create the illusion of movement by puppets, models, and
inanimate objects.
storyboard: Drawings that depict the action of a scene, used to plan the shooting.
superimposition: When one or more images are layered on top of each other in a
transparent fashion.
swish pan: A rapid panning of the camera that produces a quick, often blurred ac-
tion, then settles on its point of destination.
sync-sound: When sound and picture run side by side in direct relationship to each
other.
third-person angle: Objective camera position that represents the audience's point
of view, not one of the characters in the film.
third-person narration: Objective narrative voice that does not represent the point
of view of any of the characters in the film.
time cut: A cut between two shots, which represents a compression of the narra-
tive timeline.
top shot: A camera angle from high above a scene, looking directly down. Also
known as God's POV or bird's-eye view.
tracking shot: When the camera is mounted on tracks laid down on the set or lo-
cation so that it can be moved forward, backward, right to left, or left to
right.
visualist: A director or filmmaker who presents a cinematic narrative in expres-
sive or interpretive visual terms by using the camera and design elements.
voice-over: A spoken voice that is not directly connected to any characters on
screen. Narration can also be considered voice-over.
walla: A sound effect for the murmur of a crowd in the background.
wipe: An optical effect or digital transition in which one image wipes another
image off the screen. Wipes can be made in almost any shape or direction.
zoom lens: A lens that produces a range of focal lengths, giving the ability to move
from far to close or close to far within a shot, or to offer an array of frame
sizes without moving the camera. Sometimes called a varifocal lens.
BIBLIOGRAPHY
Aranda, Francisco. Luis Bunuel: A Critical Biography. New York: Da Capo Press,
1976.
Armes, Roy. Third World Film Making and the West. Berkeley: University of Cali-
fornia Press, 1987.
Arrowsmith, William. Antonioni: The Poet of Image. Edited with an introduction
and notes by Ted Perry. New York: Oxford University Press, 1995.
Atkinson, Michael. Blue Velvet. London: BFI Publishing, 1997.
Auiler, Dan. Hitchcock's Notebooks: An Authorized and Illustrated Look Inside the Cre-
ative Mind of Alfred Hitchcock. New York: Avon, 1999.
Aumont, Jacques. Montage Eisenstein. Bloomington: Indiana University Press,
1987.
Baer, William, ed. Elia Kazan: Interviews. Jackson: University Press of Mississippi,
2000.
Balio, Tino. Grand Design: Hollywood as a Modern Business Enterprise, 1930-1939.
Volume 5 of History of the American Cinema. Berkeley: University of Cali-
fornia Press, 1996.
. United Artists: The Company That Changed the Film Industry. Madison: Uni-
versity of Wisconsin Press, 1987.
Ball, Philip. Bright Earth: Art and the Invention of Color. Chicago: University of
Chicago Press, 2003.
Barnouw, Erik. Documentary: A History of the Non-Fiction Film. New York: Oxford
University Press. Second revised edition, 1993.
Barsam, Richard. Looking at Movies: An Introduction to Film. New York: W. W. Nor-
ton & Company, 2004.
, ed. Nonfiction Film: Theory and Criticism. New York: Dutton, 1976.
Barson, Michael. The Illustrated Who's Who of Hollywood Directors: The Studio Sys-
tem in the Sound Era. New York: Noonday Press, 1995.
Batcher, Lutz. Max Ophuls in the Hollywood Studios. New Brunswick, NJ: Rutgers
University Press, 1996.
Battcock, Gregory, ed. The New American Cinema: A Critical Anthology. New York:
E. P. Dutton, 1967.
Bazelon, Irwin. Knowing the Score: Notes on Film Music. New York: Arco, 1975.
Bazin, Andre. Jean Renoir. New York: Dell, 1974.
Bazin, Andre, and Hugh Gray, eds. What Is Cinema? Vol. I. Berkeley: University
of California Press, 1967.
. What Is Cinema? Vol. II. Berkeley: University of California Press, 1971.
Beaver, Frank. Dictionary of Film Terms: The Aesthetic Companion to Film Analysis.
Rev. and exp. ed. New York: Twayne Publishers, 1994.
Beckerman, Howard. Animation: The Whole Story. New York: Allworth Press, 2003.
Begleiter, Marcie. From Word to Image: Storyboarding and the Filmmaking Process.
Studio City, CA: Michael Wiese Productions, 2001.
Behlmer, Rudy, ed. Inside Warner Bros. (1935-1951). New York: Simon & Schuster,
1985.
. Memo from David O. Selznick. New York: Viking Press, 1972.
Bibliography • 351
Belton, John. Widescreen Cinema. Cambridge, MA: Harvard University Press, 1992.
Berg, Chuck, and Tom Erskine. The Encyclopedia of Orson Welles. With John C. Tib-
betts and James M. Welsh, series eds. New York: Checkmark Books, 2003.
Bergan, Ronald. Sergei Eisenstein: A Life in Conflict. Woodstock, NY: Overlook
Press, 1999.
Bergman, Ingmar. Images: My Life in Film. New York: Arcade Publishing, 1990.
. The Magic Lantern: An Autobiography by Ingmar Bergman. London: Pen-
guin Books, 1988.
Billups, Scott. Digital Filmmaking. Studio City, CA: Michael Wiese Productions, 2000.
Biskind, Peter. Easy Riders, Raging Bulls: How the Sex-Drugs-and-Rock-'n '-Roll Gen-
eration Saved Hollywood. New York: Simon & Schuster, 1998.
. Seeing Is Believing: How Hollywood Taught Us to Stop Worrying and Love the
Fifties. New York: Pantheon Books, 1983.
Bitzer, Billy. Billy Bitzer; His Story. New York: Farrar, Straus & Giroux, 1973.
Bizony, Piers. 2001: Filming the Future. London: Aurum Press, 1994.
Bjorkman, Stig, Torsten Manns, and Jonas Sima. Bergman on Bergman. New York:
Da Capo Press, 1993.
Blacker, Irwin R. The Elements of Screenwriting: A Guide for Film and Television Writ-
ing. New York: MacMillan, 1986.
Blesh, Rudi. Keaton. New York: Macmillan, 1966.
Block, Bruce. The Visual Story: Seeing the Structure of Film, TV, and New Media.
Woburn, MA: Focal Press, 2001.
Bluestone, George. Novels into Film: The Metamorphosis of Fiction into Cinema.
Berkeley: University of California Press, 1957.
Bogdanovich, Peter. Who the Devil Made It. New York: Knopf, 1997.
Bondanella, Peter. Italian Cinema: From Neorealism to the Present. New York: Fred-
erick Ungar, 1984.
Boorman, John, and Walter Donohue. Projections 41/2 in Association with Positif:
Film-makers on Film-making. London: Faber and Faber, 1995.
. Projections 5: Film-makers on Film-making. London: Faber and Faber, 1996.
. Projections 6: Film-makers on Film-making. London: Faber and Faber, 1996.
. Projections 7 in Association with Cahiers du Cinema: Film-makers on Film-
making. London: Faber and Faber, 1997.
. Projections 8: Film-makers on Film-making. London: Faber and Faber, 1998.
. Projections 9: French Film-makers on Film-making. London: Faber and Faber,
1999.
Boorman, John, and Walter Donohue, eds. Projections: A Forum for Film Makers.
London: Faber and Faber, 1992.
. Projections 2: A Forum for Film Makers. London: Faber and Faber, 1993.
. Projections 3: Film-makers on Film-making. London: Faber and Faber, 1994.
Boorman, John, Walter Donohue, and Fraser MacDonald, eds. Projections 12: New
York Film-makers on Film Schools. London: Faber and Faber, 2002.
Boorman, John, Walter Donohue, and Mike Figgs, eds. Projections 10: Hollywood
Film-makers on Film-making. London: Faber and Faber, 2000.
352 • Bibliography
Boorman, John, Walter Donohue, and Tod Lippy, eds. Projections 11: New York Film-
makers on New York Film-making. London: Faber and Faber, 2000.
Boorman, John, Walter Donohue, Tom Luddy, and David Thomson, eds. Project-
ions 4: Film-makers on Film-making. London: Faber and Faber, 1995.
Boorstin, Jon. The Hollywood Eye: What Makes Movies Work. New York: Cornelia &
Michael Bessie Books, 1990.
Bordwell, David. The Films of Carl Theodor Dreyer. Berkeley: University of Cali-
fornia Press, 1981.
Bordwell, David, Janet Staiger, and Kristin Thompson. The Classical Hollywood Cin-
ema: Film Style & Mode of Production to 1960. New York: Columbia Univer-
sity Press, 1985.
Bourzereau, Laurent. The Cutting Room Floor: Movie Scenes Which Never Made it to
the Screen. New York: Carol Publishing Group, 1994.
Bowser, Eileen. The Transformation of Cinema 1907-1915. Volume 2 of History of the
American Film. Berkeley: University of California Press, 1990.
Brady, Frank. Citizen Welles: A Biography of Orson Welles. New York: Charles Scrib-
ner's Sons, 1989.
Bragg, Melvyn. The Seventh Seal. London: BFI Publishing, 1993.
Brakhage, Stan. The Brakhage Lectures: Georges Melies, David Wark Griffith, Carl
Theodore Dreyer, Sergei Eisenstein. Chicago: GoodLion, 1972.
. Brakhage Scrapbook: Collected Writings 1964-1980. New York: Docu-
mentext, 1982.
. Essential Brakhage: Selected Writings on Filmmaking. Kingston, NY: Docu-
mentext, 2001.
. Film at Wit's End: Eight Avant-Garde Filmmakers. Kingston, NY: Docu-
mentext, 1989.
. "Metaphors on Vision." Film Culture, no. 30 (Fall 1963).
. A Moving Picture Giving and Taking Book. West Newbury, MA: Frontier
Press, 1971.
Brenton, Andre. What is Surrealism? New York: Pathfinder, 1978.
Breskin, David. Inner Views: Filmmakers in Conversation. Boston: Faber and Faber,
1992.
Brooks, Peter. Reading for the Plot: Design and Intention in Narrative. New York: Vin-
tage Books, 1984.
Brosnan, John. Movie Magic; the Story of Special Effects in the Cinema. New York: St.
Martin's Press, 1974.
Broughton, James. Making Light of It. 2nd ed. San Francisco: City Lights Books,
1992.
Brouwer, Alexandra, and Thomas Lee Wright. Working in Hollywood: 64 Film Pro-
fessionals Talk about Moviemaking. New York: Crown, 1990.
Brown, Royal S. Overtones and Undertones: Reading Film Music. Berkeley: Univer-
sity of California Press, 1994.
Brownlow, Kevin. David Lean: A Biography. New York: St. Martin's Press, 1996.
. The Parade's Gone By ... . New York: Knopf, 1968.
Bibliography • 353
Brunette, Peter, ed. Martin Scorsese: Interviews. Jackson: University Press of Mis-
sissippi, 1999.
Bukatman, Scott. Blade Runner. London: BFI Publishing, 1997.
Bunuel, Luis. My Last Sigh: The Autobiography of Luis Bunuel. New York: Knopf,
1983.
. An Unspeakable Betrayal: Selected Writings of Luis Bunuel. Berkeley: Uni-
versity of California Press, 2000.
Burke, Frank. Fellini's Films. New York: Twayne, 1996.
Buscombe, Edward. The Searchers. London: BFI Publishing, 2000.
Canton, Steven C Lawrence of Arabia: A Film's Anthropology. Berkeley: University
of California Press, 1999.
Card, James. Seductive Cinema: The Art of Silent Film. New York: Knopf, 1994.
Cardiff, Jack. Magic Hour: The Life of a Cameraman. London: Faber and Faber, 1996.
Cardullo, Bert. Vittorio De Sica: Director, Actor, Screenwriter. Jefferson, NC: McFar-
land, 2002.
Carney, Raymond. American Dreaming: The Films of John Cassavetes and the Ameri-
can Experience. Berkeley: University of California Press, 1985.
. Cassavetes on Cassavetes. London: Faber and Faber, 2001.
. The Films of John Cassavetes: Pragmatism, Modernism, and the Movies. Cam-
bridge: Cambridge University Press, 1994.
. Speaking the Language of Desire: The Films of Carl Dreyer. Cambridge: Cam-
bridge University Press, 1989.
Carr, Jay, ed. The A List: The National Society of Film Critics' 100 Essential Films. New
York: Da Capo Press, 2002.
Carringer, Robert L. The Making of Citizen Kane. Berkeley: University of California
Press, 1985.
Champlin, Charles. John Frankenheimer: A Conversation with Charles Champlin. Bur-
bank, CA: Riverwood Press, 1995.
Chandler, Charlotte. /, Fellini. New York: Random House, 1995.
Charity, Tom. John Cassavetes: Lifeworks. London: Omnibus Press, 2001.
Chatman, Seymour. Antonioni or, the Surface of the World. Berkeley: University of
California Press, 1985.
. Story and Discourse: Narrative Structure in Fiction and Film. Ithaca, NY: Cor-
nell University Press, 1978.
Chell, David. Moviemakers at Work. Redmond, WA: Microsoft Press, 1997.
Chierchetti, David. Edith Head: The Life and Times of Hollywood's Celebrated Costume
Designer. New York: HarperCollins, 2003.
Chion, Michel. Audio-Vision: Sound on Screen. New York: Columbia University
Press, 1994.
. David Lynch. London: BFI Publishers, 1995.
. Kubrick's Cinema Odyssey. London: BFI Publishing, 2001.
Christopher, Nicholas. Somewhere in the Night: Film Noir and the American City.
New York: Henry Holt, 1997.
Ciment, Michel. Kazan on Kazan. New York: Viking Press, 1974.
354 • Bibliography
. Kubrick: The Definitive Edition. New York: Faber and Faber, 1999.
Clagett, Thomas D. William Friedkin: Films of Aberration, Obsession, and Reality. Los
Angeles: Silman-James Press, 2003, expanded and updated second edition.
Clarens, Carlos. An Illustrated History of the Horror Film. New York: Capricorn
Books, 1967.
Clarke, James. Ridley Scott. London: Virgin Books Ltd., 2002.
Clooney, Nick. The Movies That Changed Us: Reflections on the Screen. New York:
Atria Books, 2002.
Cohan, Steven, ed. Hollywood Musicals: The Film Reader. New York: Routledge,
2002.
Cole, Janis, and Holly Dale. Calling the Shots: Profiles of Women Filmmakers.
Kingston, Ontario: Quarry Press, 1993.
Cook, David A. Lost Illusions: American Cinema in the Shadow of Watergate and Viet-
nam, 1970-1979. Volume 9 of History of the American Cinema. Berkeley: Uni-
versity of California Press, 2000.
Coppola, Eleanor. Notes. New York: Simon and Schuster, 1979.
Corman, Roger. How I Made a Hundred Movies in Hollywood and Never Lost a Dime.
With Jim Jerome. New York: Random House, 1990.
Cowie, Peter. Annie Hall. London: BFI Publishing, 1996.
. The Apocalypse Now Book. New York: Da Capo Press, 2001.
Crafton, Donald. The Talkies: American Cinema's Transition to Sound, 1926-1931. Vol-
ume 4 of History of the American Cinema. Berkeley: University of California
Press, 1999.
Culhane, Shamus. Animation: From Script to Screen. New York: St. Martin's Press,
1988.
Curtis, David. Experimental Cinema: A Fifty-Year Evolution. New York: Universe
Books, 1971.
Dabashi, Hamid. Close Up: Iranian Cinema Past, Present, and Future. London: Verso,
2001.
Dardis, Tom. Keaton: The Man Who Wouldn't Lie Down. New York: Penguin Books,
1980.
Davis, Brian. The Thriller: The Suspense Film from 1946. London: Studio Vista,
1973.
De Baecque, Antoine, and Serge Toubiana. Truffant: A Biography. New York: Knopf,
1999.
de Navacelle, Thierry Woody Allen on Location. New York: William Morrow, 1987.
De Sica, Vittorio. Miracle in Milan. Screenplay by Cesare Zavattini and Vitorrio De
Sica. New York: Orion Press, 1969.
Dean, Michael W $30 Film School. Boston: Premier Press, 2003.
Derry, Charles. The Suspense Thriller: Films in the Shadow of Alfred Hitchcock. Jef-
ferson, NC: McFarland, 1988.
Dick, Phillip, K. Do Androids Dream of Electric Sheep? London: Granada Publish-
ing, 1972.
Dixon, Wheeler Winston. The Exploding Eye: A Re-Visionary History of the 1960s
Bibliography • 355
Gabler, Neal. An Empire of Their Own: How the Jews Invented Hollywood. New York:
Crown Publishers, 1988.
Gado, Frank. The Passion of Ingmar Bergman. Durham: Duke University Press, 1986.
Galbraith, Stuart, IV. The Emperor and the Wolf: The Lives and Films of Akira Kuro-
sawa and Toshiro Mifune. New York: Faber and Faber, 2001.
Gallagher, John Andrew. Film Directors on Directors. New York: Praeger, 1989.
Gallagher, Tag. John Ford: The Man and his Films. Berkeley: University of Califor-
nia Press, 1986.
Gelmis, Joseph. The Film Director as Superstar. Garden City, NY: Doubleday, 1970.
Georgakas, Dan, and Lenny Rubenstein, eds. The Cineaste Interviews: On the Art
and Politics of the Cinema. Chicago: Lake View Press, 1983.
Gibbs, John. Mise-en-Scene: Film Style and Interpretation. London: Wallflower, 2002.
Ginsberg, Milton Moses. Coming Apart. New York: Lancer Books, 1969.
Goodwin, James. Akira Kurosawa and Intertextural Cinema. Baltimore, MD: Johns
Hopkins University Press, 1994.
Gorbman, Claudia. Unheard Melodies: Narrative Film Music. Bloomington: Indiana
University Press, 1987.
Gottesman, Ronald, ed. Focus on Citizen Kane. Englewood Cliffs, NJ: Prentice-Hall,
1971.
Gottlieb, Sidney, ed. Hitchcock on Hitchcock: Selected Writings and Interviews. Berke-
ley: University of California Press, 1995.
Goulekas, Karen E. Visual Effects in a Digital World: A Comprehensive Glossary of over
7,000 Visual Effects Terms. San Diego: Morgan Kaufmann, 2001.
Grant, Barry Keith, ed. Film Genre Reader. Austin: University of Texas Press, 1986.
Gray, Beverly. Roger Gorman: An Unauthorized Biography of the Godfather of Indie
Filmmaking. Los Angeles: Renaissance Books, 2000.
Green, Shelly. Radical Juxtaposition: The Films of Yvonne Rainer. Metuchen, NJ:
Scarecrow Press, 1994.
Griffith, Richard. The World of Robert Flaherty. New York: Da Capo Press, 1972.
Guerrero, Ed. Do the Right Thing. London: BFI Publishing, 2001.
Haller, Robert A., ed. Jim Davis: The Flow of Energy. New York: Anthology Film
Archives, 1992.
Hardy, Phil. Sam Fuller. New York: Praeger, 1970.
Harmetz, Aljean. The Making of Casablanca: Bogart, Bergman, and World War II. New
York: Hyperion, 1992.
Hart, John. The Art of the Storyboard: Storyboarding for Film, TV, and Animation.
Boston: Focal Press, 1999.
Harvey, James. Movie Love in the Fifties. New York: Knopf, 2001.
Hay, James. Popular Film Culture in Fascist Italy: The Passing of the Hex. Blooming-
ton: Indiana University Press, 1987.
Heisner, Beverly. Hollywood Art: Art Direction in the Days of the Great Studios. Jef-
ferson, NC: McFarland, 1990.
Hickenlooper, George. Reel Conversations: Candid Interviews with Film's Foremost Di-
rectors and Critics. New York: Citadel Press, 1991.
358 • Bibliography
Jones, John Bush. Our Musicals, Ourselves: A Social History of the American Musical
Theater. Hanover: Brandeis University Press, 2003.
Jung, Carl Gustav. Memories, Dreams, Reflections. New York: Vintage Books, 1989.
Jung, Uli and Walter Schatzberg. Beyond Caligari: The Films of Robert Wiene. New
York: Berghahn Books, 1999.
Kael, Pauline. The Citizen Kane Book: Raising Kane. Boston: Little, Brown, 1971.
Katz, Steven D. Film Directing Shot by Shot: Visualizing from Concept to Screen. Stu-
dio City, CA: Michael Wiese Productions, 1991.
Kaufman, Lloyd, and James Gunn. All I Need to Know about Filmmaking I Learned
from The Toxic Avenger. New York: Berkley Boulevard Books, 1998.
Kazan, Elia. A Life. New York: Knopf, 1988.
Keaton, Buster with Charles Samuels. My Wonderful World of Slapstick. London:
Allen Unwin, 1968.
Keaton, Eleanor, and Jeffrey Vance. Buster Keaton Remembered. New York: Harry
N. Abrams, 2001.
Kelly, Mary Pat. Martin Scorsese: The First Decade. Pleasantville, NY: Redgrave Pub-
lishing Company, 1980.
Kelly, Richard. The Name of this Book is Dogme95. London: Faber and Faber, 2000.
Kieslowski, Krzysztof and Krzysztof Piesiewicz. Decalogue: The Ten Command-
ments. London: Faber and Faber, 1991.
King, Stephen. On Writing: A Memoir of the Craft. New York: Pocket Books, 2000.
Kline, Sally, ed. George Lucas: Interviews. Jackson: University Press of Mississippi,
1999.
Kline, T. Jefferson. Screening the Text: Intertexuality in New Wave French Cinema. Bal-
timore: Johns Hopkins University Press, 1992.
Knight, Arthur. The Liveliest Art: A Panoramic History of the Movies. New York:
MacMillan, 1957.
Konigsberg, Ira. The Complete Film Dictionary. 2nd ed. New York: Penguin, 1997.
Koszarski, Richard. An Evening's Entertainment: The Age of the Silent Feature Pic-
ture, 1915-1928. Volume 3 of History of the American Cinema. Berkeley: Uni-
versity of California Press, 1994.
Kozloff, Sarah. Invisible Storytellers: Voice-Over Narration in American Fiction Film.
Berkeley: University of California Press, 1998.
Kracauer, Siegfried. From Caligari to Hitler: A Psychological History of the German
Film. Princeton, NJ: Princeton University Press, 1947.
. Theory of Film: The Redemption of Physical Reality. London: Oxford Uni-
versity Press, 1960.
Kreimeier, Klaus. The UFA Story: A History of Germany's Greatest Film Company,
1918-1945. New York: Hill and Wang, 1996.
Krohn, Bill. Hitchcock at Work. London: Phaidon, 2000.
Kuenzli, Rudolf E. Dada and Surrealist Film. Cambridge, MA: The MIT Press, 1996.
Kurosawa, Akira. Something Like an Autobiography. New York: Vintage Books, 1983.
La Motta, Jake, with Joseph Carter and Peter Savage. Raging Bull: My Story. En-
glewood Cliffs, NJ: Prentice Hall, 1970.
360 • Bibliography
wood System: An Anthology of Film History and Criticism. New York: E. P. Dut-
ton, 1975.
McDonough, Tom. Light Years: Confessions of a Cinematographer. New York: Grove
Press, 1987.
McGee, Mark Thomas, and R. J. Robertson. The J. D. Films: Juvenile Delinquency in
the Movies. Jefferson, NC: McFarland, 1982.
McGilligan, Patrick. Alfred Hitchcock: A Life in Darkness and Light. New York: Regan
Books, 2003.
. Backstory: Interviews with Screenwriters of Hollywood's Golden Age. Berke-
ley: University of California Press, 1986.
. Backstory 2: Interviews with Screenwriters of the 1940s and 1950s. Berkeley:
University of California Press, 1991.
. Backstory 3: Interviews with Screenwriters of the 1960s. Berkeley: University
of California Press, 1991.
. Backstory 4: Interviews with Screenwriters of the 1970s and 1980s. Berkeley:
University of California Press, 2004.
. Fritz Lang: The Nature of the Beast. New York: St. Martin's Press, 1997.
. Robert Altman: Jumping Off the Cliff: A Biography of the Great American Di-
rector. New York: St. Martin's Press, 1989.
McGrath, Declan. Screencraft: Editing & Post-Production. Boston: Focal Press, 2001.
McKee, Robert. Story: Substance, Structure, Style, and the Principles of Screenwriting.
New York: HarperCollins, 1997.
Meade, Marion. Buster Keaton: Cut to the Chase. New York: Da Capo Press, 1997.
. The Unruly Life of Woody Allen: A Biography. New York: Scribner, 2000.
Mekas, Jonas. Movie Journal: The Rise of a New American Cinema, 1959-1971. New
York: Collier Books, 1971.
Merritt, Greg. Celluloid Mavericks: A History of American Independent Film. New
York: Thunder's Mouth Press, 2000.
Michelson, Annette, ed. Kino-Eye: The Writings of Dziga Vertov. Berkeley: Univer-
sity of California Press, 1984.
Miller, Don. B Movies. New York: Ballantine Books, 1987.
Milne, Tom, translation and commentary. Godard on Godard. New York: The Viking
Press, 1972.
Monoco, James. The New Wave: Truffaut, Godard, Chabrol, Rohmer, Rivette. New
York: Oxford University Press, 1976.
Monaco, Paul. The Sixties: 1960-1969. Volume 8 of History of the American Cinema.
Berkeley: University of California Press, 2003.
Mordden, Ethan. Medium Cool: The Movies of the 1960s. New York: Knopf,
1990.
Morris, L. Robert, and Lawrence Raskin. Lawrence of Arabia: The 30th Anniversary
Pictorial History. New York: Anchor Books, 1992.
Muller, Eddie. Dark City: The Lost World of Film Noir. New York: St. Martin's Grif-
fin, 1998.
Murch, Walter. In the Blink of an Eye: A Perspective on Film Editing. 2nd ed. Los An-
geles, Silman-James, 2001.
Bibliography • 363
Musser, Charles. The Emergence of Cinema: The American Screen to 1907. Volume 1
of History of the American Cinema. Berkeley: University of California Press,
1990.
Narboni, Jean, and Tom Milne, eds. Godard on Godard. New York: Viking Press,
1972.
Naremore, James. More Than Night: Film Noir in its Contexts. Berkeley: University
of California Press, 1998.
Nelson, Al P., and Mel R. Jones. A Silent Siren Song: The Aitken Brothers' Hollywood
Odyssey, 1905-1926. New York: Cooper Square Press, 2000.
Netzley, Patricia D. Encyclopedia of Movie Special Effects. Phoenix, AZ: Oryx Press,
2000.
Neumann, Dietrich, ed. Film Architecture: Set Designs from Metropolis to Blade Run-
ner. Munich, Germany: Prestel, 1999.
Neupert, Richard. A History of the French New Wave Cinema. Madison: University
of Wisconsin Press, 2002.
Newton, Dale, and John Gaspard. Digital Filmmaking 101: An Essential Guide to
Producing Low Budget Movies. Studio City, CA: Michael Wiese Productions,
2001.
Nichols, Bill, ed. Maya Deren and the American Avant-Garde. Berkeley: University
of California Press, 2001.
Nochimson, Martha. The Passion of David Lynch: Wild at Heart in Hollywood. Austin:
University of Texas Press, 1997.
O'Connell, P. J. Robert Drew and the Development of Cinema Verite in America. Car-
bondale: Southern Illinois University Press, 1992.
Ondaatje, Michael. The Conversations: Walter Murch and the Art of Editing Film. New
York: Knopf, 2002.
Osborne. Richard E. The Casablanca Companion: The Movie Classic and its Place in
History. Indianapolis, IN: Riebel-Roque, 1997.
O'Steen, Sam. Cut to the Chase: Forty-Five Years of Editing American's Favorite Movies.
As told to Bobbie O'Steen. Studio City, CA: Michael Wiese Productions,
2001.
Oumano, Ellen. Film Forum: Thirty-Five Top Filmmakers Discuss Their Craft. New
York: St. Martin's Press, 1985.
Peary, Gerald, ed. John Ford: Interviews. Jackson: University Press of Mississippi,
2001.
Pecktal, Lynn. Costume Design: Techniques of Modern Masters. New York: Back Stage
Books, 1993.
Penz, Francois, Maureen Thomas, eds. Cinema & Architecture: Melies, Mallet-
Stevens Multimedia. London: British Film Institute, 1997.
Phillips, Gene D., ed. Stanley Kubrick: Interviews. Jackson: University Press of Mis-
sissippi, 2001.
Phillips, Gene D., and Rodney Hill. The Encyclopedia of Stanley Kubrick. With John
C Tibbets, James M. Welsh, series eds. New York: Checkmark Books, 2002.
Pierson, John. Spike, Mike, Slackers, & Dykes: A Guided Tour across a Decade of Amer-
ican Independent Cinema. New York: Miramax Books, 1995.
364 • Bibliography
Sargeant, Jack, ed. The Naked Lens: An Illustrated History of Beat Cinema. London:
Creation Books, 1997.
Sarris, Andrew. The American Cinema: Directors and Directions 1929-1968. New
York: Da Capo Press, 1996.
, ed. Interviews with Film Directors. New York: Avon Books, 1967.
, ed. The St. James Film Directors Encyclopedia. Detroit, MI: Visible Ink, 1998.
Savini, Tom. Bizarro. New York: Harmony Books, 1983.
Schaefer, Dennis, and Larry Salvato. Masters of Light: Conversations with Contem-
porary Cinematographers. Berkeley: University of California Press, 1984.
Schaefer, Eric. Bold! Daring! Shocking! True!: A History of Exploitation Films,
1919-1959. Durham, NC: Duke University Press, 1999.
Schatz, Thomas. Boom and Bust: American Cinema in the 1940s. Volume 6 of History
of the American Cinema. Berkeley: University of California Press, 1999.
. The Genius of the System: Hollywood Filmmaking in the Studio Era. New
York: Pantheon Books, 1988.
Schickel, Richard. D. W. Griffith: An American Life. New York: Limelight Editions,
1996.
. Woody Allen: A Life in Film. Chicago: Ivan R. Dee, 2003.
Schrader, Paul. Transcendental Style in Film: Ozu, Bresson, Dreyer. New York: Da
Capo Press, 1972.
Schulberg, Budd. On the Waterfront: The Final Shooting Script. Hollywood: Samuel
French, 1988.
Schwam, Stephanie, ed. The Making of 2001: A Space Odyssey. With Martin Scor-
sese, series ed. New York: Modern Library, 2000.
Scorsese, Martin, ed. The Making of 2001: A Space Odyssey. Selected by Stephanie
Schwam. New York: The Modern Library, 2000.
Scorsese, Martin, and Michael Henry Wilson. A Personal Journey with Martin Scor-
sese through American Movies. New York: Miramax Books, 1997.
Segaloff, Nat. Hurricane Billy: The Stormy Life and Films of William Friedkin. New
York: William Morrow and Company, Inc., 1990.
Seger, Linda. Making a Good Script Great. New York: Dodd, Mead & Company,
1987.
Self, Robert T. Robert Altman's Subliminal Reality. Minneapolis: University of Min-
nesota Press, 2002.
Sennett, Robert S. Setting the Scene: The Great Hollywood Art Directors. New York:
Abrams, 1994.
Server, Lee. Sam Fuller: Film is a Battleground: A Critical Study with Interviews, a Film-
ography and a Bibliography. Jefferson, NC: McFarland, 1994.
Shepard, Rowena. 1000 Symbols: What Shapes Mean in Art and Myth. London:
Thames & Hudson, 2002.
Sherman, Eric. Directing the Film: Film Directors on Their Art. Los Angeles: Acro-
bat Books, 1976.
Shipman, David. The Story of Cinema: A Complete Narrative History from the Begin-
nings to the Present. New York: St. Martin's Press, 1982.
Bibliography • 367
Shorris, Sylvia, and Marion Abbott Bundy. Talking Pictures with the People Who
Made Them. New York: New Press, 1994.
Silver, Alain, and Elizabeth Ward. Film Noir: An Encyclopedic Reference to the Amer-
ican Style. 3rd ed. Woodstock, NY: Overlook Press, 1992.
Silverman, Kaja and Harun Farocki. Speaking about Godard. New York: New York
University Press, 1998.
Simmons, Garner. Peckinpah: A Portrait in Montage. Austin: University of Texas
Press, Austin, 1976.
Simon, Mark. Storyboards: Motion in Art. 2nd ed. Boston: Focal Press, 2000.
Singleton, Ralph S., James A. Conrad, and Janna Wong Healy, eds. Filmmaker's
Dictionary. 2nd ed. Hollywood, CA: Lone Eagle, 2000.
Sitney, P. Adams. Visionary Film: The American Avant-Garde, 1943-2000. 3rd ed. Ox-
ford: Oxford University Press, 2001.
, ed. Film Culture Reader. New York: Cooper Square Press, 2000.
Skoller, Donald, ed. Dreyer in Double Reflection: Translation of Carl Th. Dreyer's Writ-
ings about the Film. New York: E. P. Dutton, 1973.
Smith, Geoffrey Nowell. L'Avventura. London: BFI Publishing, 1997.
Smith, Harry. Think of the Self Speaking: Harry Smith—Selected Interviews. Seattle,
WA: Elbow/Cityful Press, 1999.
Smith, Steven C. At Heart at Fire's Center: The Life and Music of Bernard Herrmann.
Berkeley: University of California Press, 1991.
Solnit, Rebecca. River of Shadows: Eadweard Muybridge and the Technological Wild
West. New York: Viking, 2003.
Spoto, Donald. The Dark Side of Genius: The Life of Alfred Hitchcock. New York: Bal-
lantine Books, 1983.
Stanislavsky, Konstantin. An Actor Prepares. New York: Theatre Arts, Inc., 1936.
Stempel, Tom. FrameWork: A History of Screenwriting in the American Film. New
York: Continuum, 1988.
Sterling, Anna Kate. Cinematographers on the Art and Craft of Cinematography.
Metuchen, NJ: Scarecrow Press, 1987.
Sterritt, David. The Films of Jean-Luc Godard: Seeing the Invisible. New York: Cam-
bridge University Press, 1999.
Sterrit, David, ed. Robert Altman: Interviews. Jackson: University Press of Missis-
sippi, 2000.
Stok, Danusia, ed. Kieslowski on Kieslowski. London: Faber and Faber, 1993.
Stone, Judy. Eye on the World: Conversations with International Filmmakers. Los An-
geles: Silman-James, 1997.
Stuart, Jan. The Nashville Chronicles: The Making of Robert Altman's Masterpiece. New
York: Simon and Schuster, 2000.
Stubbs, Liz. Documentary Filmmakers Speak. New York: Allworth Press, 2002.
Sutin, Lawrence. Divine Invasions: A Life of Philip K. Dick. New York: Harmony
Books, 1989.
Swallow, James. Dark Eye: The Films of David Fincher. London: Reynolds & Hearn
Ltd., 2003.
368 • Bibliography
Tashiro, C. S. Pretty Pictures: Production Design and the History Film. Austin: Uni-
versity of Texas Press, 1998.
Thomas, Bob. King Cohn: The Life and Times of Harry Cohn. New York: G. P. Put-
nam's Sons, 1967.
Thomas, Tony. Film Score: The Art & Craft of Movie Music. Burbank, CA: River-
wood Press, 1991.
Thompson, David, and Ian Christie, eds. Scorsese on Scorsese. London: Faber and
Faber, 1989.
Thompson, Kristin, and David Bordwell. Film History: An Introduction. New York:
McGraw-Hill, 1994.
Tirard, Laurent. Moviemakers' Master Class: Private Lessons from the World's Foremost
Directors. New York: Faber and Faber, 2002.
Tobias, Michael, ed. The Search for Reality: The Art of Documentary Filmmaking. Stu-
dio City, CA: Michael Wiese Productions, 1997.
Treherne, John E. The Strange History of Bonnie and Clyde. New York: Cooper Square
Press, 2000.
Truffaut, Francois. Hitchcock. New York: Touchstone, 1985. First published in 1966
by Simon and Schuster.
Turim, Maureen. Flashbacks in Film: Memory & History. New York: Rouledge, 1989.
Tyler, Parker. Underground Film: A Critical History. New York: Grove Press, 1969.
Unterburger, Amy L., ed. The St. James Women Filmmakers Encyclopedia: Women on
the Other Side of the Camera. Detroit, MI: Visible Ink, 1999.
Usai, Paolo Cherchi. Silent Cinema: An Introduction. London: BFI Publishing, 2000.
Vachon, Christine. Shooting to Kill: How an Independent Producer Blasts through the
Barriers to Make Movies That Matter. With David Edelstein. New York: Avon
Books, 1998.
Vaughan, Dai. For Documentary: Twelve Essays. Berkeley: University of California
Press, 1999.
. Portrait of an Invisible Man: The Working Life of Steward McAllister, Film Ed-
itor. London: BFI Publishing, 1983.
Vaz, Mark Cotta, and Patricia Rose Duignan. Industrial Light + Magic: Into the Dig-
ital Realm. New York: Ballantine Books, 1996.
Vidor, King. On Film Making. New York: David McKay, 1972.
. A Tree is a Tree: An Autobiography. Hollywood: Samuel French, 1981.
Wake, Sandra, and Nicola Hayden, eds. The Bonnie and Clyde Book. New York:
Simon and Schuster, 1972.
Walker, Alexander. Hollywood, England: The British Film Industry in the Sixties. Lon-
don: Harrap, 1986.
. National Heroes: British Cinema in the Seventies and Eighties. London: Har-
rap, 1985.
. The Shattered Silents: How the Talkies Came to Stay. New York: William Mor-
row, 1979.
Walker, Joseph, and Juanita Walker. The Light on Her Face. Hollywood, CA: ASC
Press, 1984.
Bibliography • 369
Wayne, Mike. Political Film: The Dialectics of Third Cinema. London: Pluto Press,
2001.
Weddle, David. "If They Move. .. Kill 'Em!": The Life and Times of Sam Peckinpah.
New York: Grove Press, 1994.
Wees, William C. Light Moving in Time: Studies in the Visual Aesthetics of Avant-
Garde Film. Berkeley: University of California Press, 1992.
Weinberg, Herman G. Saint Cinema: Writings on Film, 1929-1970. Rev. ed. New
York: Dover, 1970.
Weis, Elisabeth, and John Belton, eds. Film Sound: Theory and Practice. New York:
Columbia University Press, 1985.
Wells, Lynn. Allegories of Telling: Self-Referential Narrative in Contemporary British
Fiction. Amsterdam; New York: Rodopi, 2003.
Wiegand, Christopher. Federico Fellini. Los Angeles: TACHEN America, 2003.
Williams, Alan Larson. Max Ophuls and the Cinema of Desire: Style and Spectacle in
Four Films 1948-1955. New York: Arno Press, 1980.
Williams, Richard. The Animator's Survival Kit. London: Faber and Faber, 2001.
Winters, Ralph E. Some Cutting Remarks: Seventy Years a Film Editor. Lanham, MD:
Scarecrow Press, 2001.
Wood, Robin. Arthur Penn. London: Studio Vista, 1969.
Yacowar, Maurice. Method in Madness: The Art of Mel Brooks. New York: St. Mar-
tins Press, 1981.
Young, Freddie. Seventy Light Years: A Life in the Movies. London: Faber and Faber,
1999.
Youngblood, Gene. Expanded Cinema. New York: E. P. Dutton, 1970.
Zavattini, Ceasare. Sequences from a Cinematic Life. Englewood Cliffs, NJ: Prentice-
Hall, 1970.
Zaza, Tony. Audio Design: Sound Recording Techniques for Film and Video. Englewood
Cliffs, NJ: Prentice-Hall, 1991.
. Mechanics of Sound Recording. Englewood Cliffs, NJ: Prentice-Hall, 1991.
Zizek, Slavoj. The Fright of Real Tears: Krzysztof Kieslowski Between Theory and Post-
Theory. London: BFI Publishing, 2001.
Zucker, Carole. Figures of Light: Actors and Directors Illuminate the Art of Film Act-
ing. New York: Plenum Press, 1995.
This page intentionally left blank
INDEX